NOR: lpc2000 Add support for LPC84x devices
[openocd.git] / doc / openocd.texi
1 \input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
2 @c %**start of header
3 @setfilename openocd.info
4 @settitle OpenOCD User's Guide
5 @dircategory Development
6 @direntry
7 * OpenOCD: (openocd). OpenOCD User's Guide
8 @end direntry
9 @paragraphindent 0
10 @c %**end of header
11
12 @include version.texi
13
14 @copying
15
16 This User's Guide documents
17 release @value{VERSION},
18 dated @value{UPDATED},
19 of the Open On-Chip Debugger (OpenOCD).
20
21 @itemize @bullet
22 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2008 The OpenOCD Project
23 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2007-2008 Spencer Oliver @email{spen@@spen-soft.co.uk}
24 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2008-2010 Oyvind Harboe @email{oyvind.harboe@@zylin.com}
25 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2008 Duane Ellis @email{openocd@@duaneellis.com}
26 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2009-2010 David Brownell
27 @end itemize
28
29 @quotation
30 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
31 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.2 or
32 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with no
33 Invariant Sections, with no Front-Cover Texts, and with no Back-Cover
34 Texts. A copy of the license is included in the section entitled ``GNU
35 Free Documentation License''.
36 @end quotation
37 @end copying
38
39 @titlepage
40 @titlefont{@emph{Open On-Chip Debugger:}}
41 @sp 1
42 @title OpenOCD User's Guide
43 @subtitle for release @value{VERSION}
44 @subtitle @value{UPDATED}
45
46 @page
47 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
48 @insertcopying
49 @end titlepage
50
51 @summarycontents
52 @contents
53
54 @ifnottex
55 @node Top
56 @top OpenOCD User's Guide
57
58 @insertcopying
59 @end ifnottex
60
61 @menu
62 * About:: About OpenOCD
63 * Developers:: OpenOCD Developer Resources
64 * Debug Adapter Hardware:: Debug Adapter Hardware
65 * About Jim-Tcl:: About Jim-Tcl
66 * Running:: Running OpenOCD
67 * OpenOCD Project Setup:: OpenOCD Project Setup
68 * Config File Guidelines:: Config File Guidelines
69 * Server Configuration:: Server Configuration
70 * Debug Adapter Configuration:: Debug Adapter Configuration
71 * Reset Configuration:: Reset Configuration
72 * TAP Declaration:: TAP Declaration
73 * CPU Configuration:: CPU Configuration
74 * Flash Commands:: Flash Commands
75 * Flash Programming:: Flash Programming
76 * PLD/FPGA Commands:: PLD/FPGA Commands
77 * General Commands:: General Commands
78 * Architecture and Core Commands:: Architecture and Core Commands
79 * JTAG Commands:: JTAG Commands
80 * Boundary Scan Commands:: Boundary Scan Commands
81 * Utility Commands:: Utility Commands
82 * TFTP:: TFTP
83 * GDB and OpenOCD:: Using GDB and OpenOCD
84 * Tcl Scripting API:: Tcl Scripting API
85 * FAQ:: Frequently Asked Questions
86 * Tcl Crash Course:: Tcl Crash Course
87 * License:: GNU Free Documentation License
88
89 @comment DO NOT use the plain word ``Index'', reason: CYGWIN filename
90 @comment case issue with ``Index.html'' and ``index.html''
91 @comment Occurs when creating ``--html --no-split'' output
92 @comment This fix is based on: http://sourceware.org/ml/binutils/2006-05/msg00215.html
93 * OpenOCD Concept Index:: Concept Index
94 * Command and Driver Index:: Command and Driver Index
95 @end menu
96
97 @node About
98 @unnumbered About
99 @cindex about
100
101 OpenOCD was created by Dominic Rath as part of a 2005 diploma thesis written
102 at the University of Applied Sciences Augsburg (@uref{http://www.hs-augsburg.de}).
103 Since that time, the project has grown into an active open-source project,
104 supported by a diverse community of software and hardware developers from
105 around the world.
106
107 @section What is OpenOCD?
108 @cindex TAP
109 @cindex JTAG
110
111 The Open On-Chip Debugger (OpenOCD) aims to provide debugging,
112 in-system programming and boundary-scan testing for embedded target
113 devices.
114
115 It does so with the assistance of a @dfn{debug adapter}, which is
116 a small hardware module which helps provide the right kind of
117 electrical signaling to the target being debugged. These are
118 required since the debug host (on which OpenOCD runs) won't
119 usually have native support for such signaling, or the connector
120 needed to hook up to the target.
121
122 Such debug adapters support one or more @dfn{transport} protocols,
123 each of which involves different electrical signaling (and uses
124 different messaging protocols on top of that signaling). There
125 are many types of debug adapter, and little uniformity in what
126 they are called. (There are also product naming differences.)
127
128 These adapters are sometimes packaged as discrete dongles, which
129 may generically be called @dfn{hardware interface dongles}.
130 Some development boards also integrate them directly, which may
131 let the development board connect directly to the debug
132 host over USB (and sometimes also to power it over USB).
133
134 For example, a @dfn{JTAG Adapter} supports JTAG
135 signaling, and is used to communicate
136 with JTAG (IEEE 1149.1) compliant TAPs on your target board.
137 A @dfn{TAP} is a ``Test Access Port'', a module which processes
138 special instructions and data. TAPs are daisy-chained within and
139 between chips and boards. JTAG supports debugging and boundary
140 scan operations.
141
142 There are also @dfn{SWD Adapters} that support Serial Wire Debug (SWD)
143 signaling to communicate with some newer ARM cores, as well as debug
144 adapters which support both JTAG and SWD transports. SWD supports only
145 debugging, whereas JTAG also supports boundary scan operations.
146
147 For some chips, there are also @dfn{Programming Adapters} supporting
148 special transports used only to write code to flash memory, without
149 support for on-chip debugging or boundary scan.
150 (At this writing, OpenOCD does not support such non-debug adapters.)
151
152
153 @b{Dongles:} OpenOCD currently supports many types of hardware dongles:
154 USB-based, parallel port-based, and other standalone boxes that run
155 OpenOCD internally. @xref{Debug Adapter Hardware}.
156
157 @b{GDB Debug:} It allows ARM7 (ARM7TDMI and ARM720t), ARM9 (ARM920T,
158 ARM922T, ARM926EJ--S, ARM966E--S), XScale (PXA25x, IXP42x), Cortex-M3
159 (Stellaris LM3, STMicroelectronics STM32 and Energy Micro EFM32) and
160 Intel Quark (x10xx) based cores to be debugged via the GDB protocol.
161
162 @b{Flash Programming:} Flash writing is supported for external
163 CFI-compatible NOR flashes (Intel and AMD/Spansion command set) and several
164 internal flashes (LPC1700, LPC1800, LPC2000, LPC4300, AT91SAM7, AT91SAM3U,
165 STR7x, STR9x, LM3, STM32x and EFM32). Preliminary support for various NAND flash
166 controllers (LPC3180, Orion, S3C24xx, more) is included.
167
168 @section OpenOCD Web Site
169
170 The OpenOCD web site provides the latest public news from the community:
171
172 @uref{http://openocd.org/}
173
174 @section Latest User's Guide:
175
176 The user's guide you are now reading may not be the latest one
177 available. A version for more recent code may be available.
178 Its HTML form is published regularly at:
179
180 @uref{http://openocd.org/doc/html/index.html}
181
182 PDF form is likewise published at:
183
184 @uref{http://openocd.org/doc/pdf/openocd.pdf}
185
186 @section OpenOCD User's Forum
187
188 There is an OpenOCD forum (phpBB) hosted by SparkFun,
189 which might be helpful to you. Note that if you want
190 anything to come to the attention of developers, you
191 should post it to the OpenOCD Developer Mailing List
192 instead of this forum.
193
194 @uref{http://forum.sparkfun.com/viewforum.php?f=18}
195
196 @section OpenOCD User's Mailing List
197
198 The OpenOCD User Mailing List provides the primary means of
199 communication between users:
200
201 @uref{https://lists.sourceforge.net/mailman/listinfo/openocd-user}
202
203 @section OpenOCD IRC
204
205 Support can also be found on irc:
206 @uref{irc://irc.freenode.net/openocd}
207
208 @node Developers
209 @chapter OpenOCD Developer Resources
210 @cindex developers
211
212 If you are interested in improving the state of OpenOCD's debugging and
213 testing support, new contributions will be welcome. Motivated developers
214 can produce new target, flash or interface drivers, improve the
215 documentation, as well as more conventional bug fixes and enhancements.
216
217 The resources in this chapter are available for developers wishing to explore
218 or expand the OpenOCD source code.
219
220 @section OpenOCD Git Repository
221
222 During the 0.3.x release cycle, OpenOCD switched from Subversion to
223 a Git repository hosted at SourceForge. The repository URL is:
224
225 @uref{git://git.code.sf.net/p/openocd/code}
226
227 or via http
228
229 @uref{http://git.code.sf.net/p/openocd/code}
230
231 You may prefer to use a mirror and the HTTP protocol:
232
233 @uref{http://repo.or.cz/r/openocd.git}
234
235 With standard Git tools, use @command{git clone} to initialize
236 a local repository, and @command{git pull} to update it.
237 There are also gitweb pages letting you browse the repository
238 with a web browser, or download arbitrary snapshots without
239 needing a Git client:
240
241 @uref{http://repo.or.cz/w/openocd.git}
242
243 The @file{README} file contains the instructions for building the project
244 from the repository or a snapshot.
245
246 Developers that want to contribute patches to the OpenOCD system are
247 @b{strongly} encouraged to work against mainline.
248 Patches created against older versions may require additional
249 work from their submitter in order to be updated for newer releases.
250
251 @section Doxygen Developer Manual
252
253 During the 0.2.x release cycle, the OpenOCD project began
254 providing a Doxygen reference manual. This document contains more
255 technical information about the software internals, development
256 processes, and similar documentation:
257
258 @uref{http://openocd.org/doc/doxygen/html/index.html}
259
260 This document is a work-in-progress, but contributions would be welcome
261 to fill in the gaps. All of the source files are provided in-tree,
262 listed in the Doxyfile configuration at the top of the source tree.
263
264 @section Gerrit Review System
265
266 All changes in the OpenOCD Git repository go through the web-based Gerrit
267 Code Review System:
268
269 @uref{http://openocd.zylin.com/}
270
271 After a one-time registration and repository setup, anyone can push commits
272 from their local Git repository directly into Gerrit.
273 All users and developers are encouraged to review, test, discuss and vote
274 for changes in Gerrit. The feedback provides the basis for a maintainer to
275 eventually submit the change to the main Git repository.
276
277 The @file{HACKING} file, also available as the Patch Guide in the Doxygen
278 Developer Manual, contains basic information about how to connect a
279 repository to Gerrit, prepare and push patches. Patch authors are expected to
280 maintain their changes while they're in Gerrit, respond to feedback and if
281 necessary rework and push improved versions of the change.
282
283 @section OpenOCD Developer Mailing List
284
285 The OpenOCD Developer Mailing List provides the primary means of
286 communication between developers:
287
288 @uref{https://lists.sourceforge.net/mailman/listinfo/openocd-devel}
289
290 @section OpenOCD Bug Tracker
291
292 The OpenOCD Bug Tracker is hosted on SourceForge:
293
294 @uref{http://bugs.openocd.org/}
295
296
297 @node Debug Adapter Hardware
298 @chapter Debug Adapter Hardware
299 @cindex dongles
300 @cindex FTDI
301 @cindex wiggler
302 @cindex zy1000
303 @cindex printer port
304 @cindex USB Adapter
305 @cindex RTCK
306
307 Defined: @b{dongle}: A small device that plugs into a computer and serves as
308 an adapter .... [snip]
309
310 In the OpenOCD case, this generally refers to @b{a small adapter} that
311 attaches to your computer via USB or the parallel port. One
312 exception is the Ultimate Solutions ZY1000, packaged as a small box you
313 attach via an ethernet cable. The ZY1000 has the advantage that it does not
314 require any drivers to be installed on the developer PC. It also has
315 a built in web interface. It supports RTCK/RCLK or adaptive clocking
316 and has a built-in relay to power cycle targets remotely.
317
318
319 @section Choosing a Dongle
320
321 There are several things you should keep in mind when choosing a dongle.
322
323 @enumerate
324 @item @b{Transport} Does it support the kind of communication that you need?
325 OpenOCD focusses mostly on JTAG. Your version may also support
326 other ways to communicate with target devices.
327 @item @b{Voltage} What voltage is your target - 1.8, 2.8, 3.3, or 5V?
328 Does your dongle support it? You might need a level converter.
329 @item @b{Pinout} What pinout does your target board use?
330 Does your dongle support it? You may be able to use jumper
331 wires, or an "octopus" connector, to convert pinouts.
332 @item @b{Connection} Does your computer have the USB, parallel, or
333 Ethernet port needed?
334 @item @b{RTCK} Do you expect to use it with ARM chips and boards with
335 RTCK support (also known as ``adaptive clocking'')?
336 @end enumerate
337
338 @section Stand-alone JTAG Probe
339
340 The ZY1000 from Ultimate Solutions is technically not a dongle but a
341 stand-alone JTAG probe that, unlike most dongles, doesn't require any drivers
342 running on the developer's host computer.
343 Once installed on a network using DHCP or a static IP assignment, users can
344 access the ZY1000 probe locally or remotely from any host with access to the
345 IP address assigned to the probe.
346 The ZY1000 provides an intuitive web interface with direct access to the
347 OpenOCD debugger.
348 Users may also run a GDBSERVER directly on the ZY1000 to take full advantage
349 of GCC & GDB to debug any distribution of embedded Linux or NetBSD running on
350 the target.
351 The ZY1000 supports RTCK & RCLK or adaptive clocking and has a built-in relay
352 to power cycle the target remotely.
353
354 For more information, visit:
355
356 @b{ZY1000} See: @url{http://www.ultsol.com/index.php/component/content/article/8/210-zylin-zy1000-main}
357
358 @section USB FT2232 Based
359
360 There are many USB JTAG dongles on the market, many of them based
361 on a chip from ``Future Technology Devices International'' (FTDI)
362 known as the FTDI FT2232; this is a USB full speed (12 Mbps) chip.
363 See: @url{http://www.ftdichip.com} for more information.
364 In summer 2009, USB high speed (480 Mbps) versions of these FTDI
365 chips started to become available in JTAG adapters. Around 2012, a new
366 variant appeared - FT232H - this is a single-channel version of FT2232H.
367 (Adapters using those high speed FT2232H or FT232H chips may support adaptive
368 clocking.)
369
370 The FT2232 chips are flexible enough to support some other
371 transport options, such as SWD or the SPI variants used to
372 program some chips. They have two communications channels,
373 and one can be used for a UART adapter at the same time the
374 other one is used to provide a debug adapter.
375
376 Also, some development boards integrate an FT2232 chip to serve as
377 a built-in low-cost debug adapter and USB-to-serial solution.
378
379 @itemize @bullet
380 @item @b{usbjtag}
381 @* Link @url{http://elk.informatik.fh-augsburg.de/hhweb/doc/openocd/usbjtag/usbjtag.html}
382 @item @b{jtagkey}
383 @* See: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtagkey.shtml}
384 @item @b{jtagkey2}
385 @* See: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtagkey2.shtml}
386 @item @b{oocdlink}
387 @* See: @url{http://www.oocdlink.com} By Joern Kaipf
388 @item @b{signalyzer}
389 @* See: @url{http://www.signalyzer.com}
390 @item @b{Stellaris Eval Boards}
391 @* See: @url{http://www.ti.com} - The Stellaris eval boards
392 bundle FT2232-based JTAG and SWD support, which can be used to debug
393 the Stellaris chips. Using separate JTAG adapters is optional.
394 These boards can also be used in a "pass through" mode as JTAG adapters
395 to other target boards, disabling the Stellaris chip.
396 @item @b{TI/Luminary ICDI}
397 @* See: @url{http://www.ti.com} - TI/Luminary In-Circuit Debug
398 Interface (ICDI) Boards are included in Stellaris LM3S9B9x
399 Evaluation Kits. Like the non-detachable FT2232 support on the other
400 Stellaris eval boards, they can be used to debug other target boards.
401 @item @b{olimex-jtag}
402 @* See: @url{http://www.olimex.com}
403 @item @b{Flyswatter/Flyswatter2}
404 @* See: @url{http://www.tincantools.com}
405 @item @b{turtelizer2}
406 @* See:
407 @uref{http://www.ethernut.de/en/hardware/turtelizer/index.html, Turtelizer 2}, or
408 @url{http://www.ethernut.de}
409 @item @b{comstick}
410 @* Link: @url{http://www.hitex.com/index.php?id=383}
411 @item @b{stm32stick}
412 @* Link @url{http://www.hitex.com/stm32-stick}
413 @item @b{axm0432_jtag}
414 @* Axiom AXM-0432 Link @url{http://www.axman.com} - NOTE: This JTAG does not appear
415 to be available anymore as of April 2012.
416 @item @b{cortino}
417 @* Link @url{http://www.hitex.com/index.php?id=cortino}
418 @item @b{dlp-usb1232h}
419 @* Link @url{http://www.dlpdesign.com/usb/usb1232h.shtml}
420 @item @b{digilent-hs1}
421 @* Link @url{http://www.digilentinc.com/Products/Detail.cfm?Prod=JTAG-HS1}
422 @item @b{opendous}
423 @* Link @url{http://code.google.com/p/opendous/wiki/JTAG} FT2232H-based
424 (OpenHardware).
425 @item @b{JTAG-lock-pick Tiny 2}
426 @* Link @url{http://www.distortec.com/jtag-lock-pick-tiny-2} FT232H-based
427
428 @item @b{GW16042}
429 @* Link: @url{http://shop.gateworks.com/index.php?route=product/product&path=70_80&product_id=64}
430 FT2232H-based
431
432 @end itemize
433 @section USB-JTAG / Altera USB-Blaster compatibles
434
435 These devices also show up as FTDI devices, but are not
436 protocol-compatible with the FT2232 devices. They are, however,
437 protocol-compatible among themselves. USB-JTAG devices typically consist
438 of a FT245 followed by a CPLD that understands a particular protocol,
439 or emulates this protocol using some other hardware.
440
441 They may appear under different USB VID/PID depending on the particular
442 product. The driver can be configured to search for any VID/PID pair
443 (see the section on driver commands).
444
445 @itemize
446 @item @b{USB-JTAG} Kolja Waschk's USB Blaster-compatible adapter
447 @* Link: @url{http://ixo-jtag.sourceforge.net/}
448 @item @b{Altera USB-Blaster}
449 @* Link: @url{http://www.altera.com/literature/ug/ug_usb_blstr.pdf}
450 @end itemize
451
452 @section USB J-Link based
453 There are several OEM versions of the SEGGER @b{J-Link} adapter. It is
454 an example of a microcontroller based JTAG adapter, it uses an
455 AT91SAM764 internally.
456
457 @itemize @bullet
458 @item @b{SEGGER J-Link}
459 @* Link: @url{http://www.segger.com/jlink.html}
460 @item @b{Atmel SAM-ICE} (Only works with Atmel chips!)
461 @* Link: @url{http://www.atmel.com/tools/atmelsam-ice.aspx}
462 @item @b{IAR J-Link}
463 @end itemize
464
465 @section USB RLINK based
466 Raisonance has an adapter called @b{RLink}. It exists in a stripped-down form on the STM32 Primer,
467 permanently attached to the JTAG lines. It also exists on the STM32 Primer2, but that is wired for
468 SWD and not JTAG, thus not supported.
469
470 @itemize @bullet
471 @item @b{Raisonance RLink}
472 @* Link: @url{http://www.mcu-raisonance.com/~rlink-debugger-programmer__@/microcontrollers__tool~tool__T018:4cn9ziz4bnx6.html}
473 @item @b{STM32 Primer}
474 @* Link: @url{http://www.stm32circle.com/resources/stm32primer.php}
475 @item @b{STM32 Primer2}
476 @* Link: @url{http://www.stm32circle.com/resources/stm32primer2.php}
477 @end itemize
478
479 @section USB ST-LINK based
480 STMicroelectronics has an adapter called @b{ST-LINK}.
481 They only work with STMicroelectronics chips, notably STM32 and STM8.
482
483 @itemize @bullet
484 @item @b{ST-LINK}
485 @* This is available standalone and as part of some kits, eg. STM32VLDISCOVERY.
486 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/evalboard/product/219866.jsp}
487 @item @b{ST-LINK/V2}
488 @* This is available standalone and as part of some kits, eg. STM32F4DISCOVERY.
489 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/evalboard/product/251168.jsp}
490 @item @b{STLINK-V3}
491 @* This is available standalone and as part of some kits.
492 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/stlink-v3}
493 @end itemize
494
495 For info the original ST-LINK enumerates using the mass storage usb class; however,
496 its implementation is completely broken. The result is this causes issues under Linux.
497 The simplest solution is to get Linux to ignore the ST-LINK using one of the following methods:
498 @itemize @bullet
499 @item modprobe -r usb-storage && modprobe usb-storage quirks=483:3744:i
500 @item add "options usb-storage quirks=483:3744:i" to /etc/modprobe.conf
501 @end itemize
502
503 @section USB TI/Stellaris ICDI based
504 Texas Instruments has an adapter called @b{ICDI}.
505 It is not to be confused with the FTDI based adapters that were originally fitted to their
506 evaluation boards. This is the adapter fitted to the Stellaris LaunchPad.
507
508 @section USB CMSIS-DAP based
509 ARM has released a interface standard called CMSIS-DAP that simplifies connecting
510 debuggers to ARM Cortex based targets @url{http://www.keil.com/support/man/docs/dapdebug/dapdebug_introduction.htm}.
511
512 @section USB Other
513 @itemize @bullet
514 @item @b{USBprog}
515 @* Link: @url{http://shop.embedded-projects.net/} - which uses an Atmel MEGA32 and a UBN9604
516
517 @item @b{USB - Presto}
518 @* Link: @url{http://tools.asix.net/prg_presto.htm}
519
520 @item @b{Versaloon-Link}
521 @* Link: @url{http://www.versaloon.com}
522
523 @item @b{ARM-JTAG-EW}
524 @* Link: @url{http://www.olimex.com/dev/arm-jtag-ew.html}
525
526 @item @b{Buspirate}
527 @* Link: @url{http://dangerousprototypes.com/bus-pirate-manual/}
528
529 @item @b{opendous}
530 @* Link: @url{http://code.google.com/p/opendous-jtag/} - which uses an AT90USB162
531
532 @item @b{estick}
533 @* Link: @url{http://code.google.com/p/estick-jtag/}
534
535 @item @b{Keil ULINK v1}
536 @* Link: @url{http://www.keil.com/ulink1/}
537
538 @item @b{TI XDS110 Debug Probe}
539 @* The XDS110 is included as the embedded debug probe on many Texas Instruments
540 LaunchPad evaluation boards.
541 @* Link: @url{http://processors.wiki.ti.com/index.php/XDS110}
542 @* Link: @url{http://processors.wiki.ti.com/index.php/XDS_Emulation_Software_Package#XDS110_Support_Utilities}
543 @end itemize
544
545 @section IBM PC Parallel Printer Port Based
546
547 The two well-known ``JTAG Parallel Ports'' cables are the Xilinx DLC5
548 and the Macraigor Wiggler. There are many clones and variations of
549 these on the market.
550
551 Note that parallel ports are becoming much less common, so if you
552 have the choice you should probably avoid these adapters in favor
553 of USB-based ones.
554
555 @itemize @bullet
556
557 @item @b{Wiggler} - There are many clones of this.
558 @* Link: @url{http://www.macraigor.com/wiggler.htm}
559
560 @item @b{DLC5} - From XILINX - There are many clones of this
561 @* Link: Search the web for: ``XILINX DLC5'' - it is no longer
562 produced, PDF schematics are easily found and it is easy to make.
563
564 @item @b{Amontec - JTAG Accelerator}
565 @* Link: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtag_accelerator.shtml}
566
567 @item @b{Wiggler2}
568 @* Link: @url{http://www.ccac.rwth-aachen.de/~michaels/index.php/hardware/armjtag}
569
570 @item @b{Wiggler_ntrst_inverted}
571 @* Yet another variation - See the source code, src/jtag/parport.c
572
573 @item @b{old_amt_wiggler}
574 @* Unknown - probably not on the market today
575
576 @item @b{arm-jtag}
577 @* Link: Most likely @url{http://www.olimex.com/dev/arm-jtag.html} [another wiggler clone]
578
579 @item @b{chameleon}
580 @* Link: @url{http://www.amontec.com/chameleon.shtml}
581
582 @item @b{Triton}
583 @* Unknown.
584
585 @item @b{Lattice}
586 @* ispDownload from Lattice Semiconductor
587 @url{http://www.latticesemi.com/lit/docs/@/devtools/dlcable.pdf}
588
589 @item @b{flashlink}
590 @* From STMicroelectronics;
591 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/com/TECHNICAL_RESOURCES/TECHNICAL_LITERATURE/DATA_BRIEF/DM00039500.pdf}
592
593 @end itemize
594
595 @section Other...
596 @itemize @bullet
597
598 @item @b{ep93xx}
599 @* An EP93xx based Linux machine using the GPIO pins directly.
600
601 @item @b{at91rm9200}
602 @* Like the EP93xx - but an ATMEL AT91RM9200 based solution using the GPIO pins on the chip.
603
604 @item @b{bcm2835gpio}
605 @* A BCM2835-based board (e.g. Raspberry Pi) using the GPIO pins of the expansion header.
606
607 @item @b{imx_gpio}
608 @* A NXP i.MX-based board (e.g. Wandboard) using the GPIO pins (should work on any i.MX processor).
609
610 @item @b{jtag_vpi}
611 @* A JTAG driver acting as a client for the JTAG VPI server interface.
612 @* Link: @url{http://github.com/fjullien/jtag_vpi}
613
614 @end itemize
615
616 @node About Jim-Tcl
617 @chapter About Jim-Tcl
618 @cindex Jim-Tcl
619 @cindex tcl
620
621 OpenOCD uses a small ``Tcl Interpreter'' known as Jim-Tcl.
622 This programming language provides a simple and extensible
623 command interpreter.
624
625 All commands presented in this Guide are extensions to Jim-Tcl.
626 You can use them as simple commands, without needing to learn
627 much of anything about Tcl.
628 Alternatively, you can write Tcl programs with them.
629
630 You can learn more about Jim at its website, @url{http://jim.tcl.tk}.
631 There is an active and responsive community, get on the mailing list
632 if you have any questions. Jim-Tcl maintainers also lurk on the
633 OpenOCD mailing list.
634
635 @itemize @bullet
636 @item @b{Jim vs. Tcl}
637 @* Jim-Tcl is a stripped down version of the well known Tcl language,
638 which can be found here: @url{http://www.tcl.tk}. Jim-Tcl has far
639 fewer features. Jim-Tcl is several dozens of .C files and .H files and
640 implements the basic Tcl command set. In contrast: Tcl 8.6 is a
641 4.2 MB .zip file containing 1540 files.
642
643 @item @b{Missing Features}
644 @* Our practice has been: Add/clone the real Tcl feature if/when
645 needed. We welcome Jim-Tcl improvements, not bloat. Also there
646 are a large number of optional Jim-Tcl features that are not
647 enabled in OpenOCD.
648
649 @item @b{Scripts}
650 @* OpenOCD configuration scripts are Jim-Tcl Scripts. OpenOCD's
651 command interpreter today is a mixture of (newer)
652 Jim-Tcl commands, and the (older) original command interpreter.
653
654 @item @b{Commands}
655 @* At the OpenOCD telnet command line (or via the GDB monitor command) one
656 can type a Tcl for() loop, set variables, etc.
657 Some of the commands documented in this guide are implemented
658 as Tcl scripts, from a @file{startup.tcl} file internal to the server.
659
660 @item @b{Historical Note}
661 @* Jim-Tcl was introduced to OpenOCD in spring 2008. Fall 2010,
662 before OpenOCD 0.5 release, OpenOCD switched to using Jim-Tcl
663 as a Git submodule, which greatly simplified upgrading Jim-Tcl
664 to benefit from new features and bugfixes in Jim-Tcl.
665
666 @item @b{Need a crash course in Tcl?}
667 @*@xref{Tcl Crash Course}.
668 @end itemize
669
670 @node Running
671 @chapter Running
672 @cindex command line options
673 @cindex logfile
674 @cindex directory search
675
676 Properly installing OpenOCD sets up your operating system to grant it access
677 to the debug adapters. On Linux, this usually involves installing a file
678 in @file{/etc/udev/rules.d,} so OpenOCD has permissions. An example rules file
679 that works for many common adapters is shipped with OpenOCD in the
680 @file{contrib} directory. MS-Windows needs
681 complex and confusing driver configuration for every peripheral. Such issues
682 are unique to each operating system, and are not detailed in this User's Guide.
683
684 Then later you will invoke the OpenOCD server, with various options to
685 tell it how each debug session should work.
686 The @option{--help} option shows:
687 @verbatim
688 bash$ openocd --help
689
690 --help | -h display this help
691 --version | -v display OpenOCD version
692 --file | -f use configuration file <name>
693 --search | -s dir to search for config files and scripts
694 --debug | -d set debug level to 3
695 | -d<n> set debug level to <level>
696 --log_output | -l redirect log output to file <name>
697 --command | -c run <command>
698 @end verbatim
699
700 If you don't give any @option{-f} or @option{-c} options,
701 OpenOCD tries to read the configuration file @file{openocd.cfg}.
702 To specify one or more different
703 configuration files, use @option{-f} options. For example:
704
705 @example
706 openocd -f config1.cfg -f config2.cfg -f config3.cfg
707 @end example
708
709 Configuration files and scripts are searched for in
710 @enumerate
711 @item the current directory,
712 @item any search dir specified on the command line using the @option{-s} option,
713 @item any search dir specified using the @command{add_script_search_dir} command,
714 @item @file{$HOME/.openocd} (not on Windows),
715 @item a directory in the @env{OPENOCD_SCRIPTS} environment variable (if set),
716 @item the site wide script library @file{$pkgdatadir/site} and
717 @item the OpenOCD-supplied script library @file{$pkgdatadir/scripts}.
718 @end enumerate
719 The first found file with a matching file name will be used.
720
721 @quotation Note
722 Don't try to use configuration script names or paths which
723 include the "#" character. That character begins Tcl comments.
724 @end quotation
725
726 @section Simple setup, no customization
727
728 In the best case, you can use two scripts from one of the script
729 libraries, hook up your JTAG adapter, and start the server ... and
730 your JTAG setup will just work "out of the box". Always try to
731 start by reusing those scripts, but assume you'll need more
732 customization even if this works. @xref{OpenOCD Project Setup}.
733
734 If you find a script for your JTAG adapter, and for your board or
735 target, you may be able to hook up your JTAG adapter then start
736 the server with some variation of one of the following:
737
738 @example
739 openocd -f interface/ADAPTER.cfg -f board/MYBOARD.cfg
740 openocd -f interface/ftdi/ADAPTER.cfg -f board/MYBOARD.cfg
741 @end example
742
743 You might also need to configure which reset signals are present,
744 using @option{-c 'reset_config trst_and_srst'} or something similar.
745 If all goes well you'll see output something like
746
747 @example
748 Open On-Chip Debugger 0.4.0 (2010-01-14-15:06)
749 For bug reports, read
750 http://openocd.org/doc/doxygen/bugs.html
751 Info : JTAG tap: lm3s.cpu tap/device found: 0x3ba00477
752 (mfg: 0x23b, part: 0xba00, ver: 0x3)
753 @end example
754
755 Seeing that "tap/device found" message, and no warnings, means
756 the JTAG communication is working. That's a key milestone, but
757 you'll probably need more project-specific setup.
758
759 @section What OpenOCD does as it starts
760
761 OpenOCD starts by processing the configuration commands provided
762 on the command line or, if there were no @option{-c command} or
763 @option{-f file.cfg} options given, in @file{openocd.cfg}.
764 @xref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage}.
765 At the end of the configuration stage it verifies the JTAG scan
766 chain defined using those commands; your configuration should
767 ensure that this always succeeds.
768 Normally, OpenOCD then starts running as a server.
769 Alternatively, commands may be used to terminate the configuration
770 stage early, perform work (such as updating some flash memory),
771 and then shut down without acting as a server.
772
773 Once OpenOCD starts running as a server, it waits for connections from
774 clients (Telnet, GDB, RPC) and processes the commands issued through
775 those channels.
776
777 If you are having problems, you can enable internal debug messages via
778 the @option{-d} option.
779
780 Also it is possible to interleave Jim-Tcl commands w/config scripts using the
781 @option{-c} command line switch.
782
783 To enable debug output (when reporting problems or working on OpenOCD
784 itself), use the @option{-d} command line switch. This sets the
785 @option{debug_level} to "3", outputting the most information,
786 including debug messages. The default setting is "2", outputting only
787 informational messages, warnings and errors. You can also change this
788 setting from within a telnet or gdb session using @command{debug_level<n>}
789 (@pxref{debuglevel,,debug_level}).
790
791 You can redirect all output from the server to a file using the
792 @option{-l <logfile>} switch.
793
794 Note! OpenOCD will launch the GDB & telnet server even if it can not
795 establish a connection with the target. In general, it is possible for
796 the JTAG controller to be unresponsive until the target is set up
797 correctly via e.g. GDB monitor commands in a GDB init script.
798
799 @node OpenOCD Project Setup
800 @chapter OpenOCD Project Setup
801
802 To use OpenOCD with your development projects, you need to do more than
803 just connect the JTAG adapter hardware (dongle) to your development board
804 and start the OpenOCD server.
805 You also need to configure your OpenOCD server so that it knows
806 about your adapter and board, and helps your work.
807 You may also want to connect OpenOCD to GDB, possibly
808 using Eclipse or some other GUI.
809
810 @section Hooking up the JTAG Adapter
811
812 Today's most common case is a dongle with a JTAG cable on one side
813 (such as a ribbon cable with a 10-pin or 20-pin IDC connector)
814 and a USB cable on the other.
815 Instead of USB, some cables use Ethernet;
816 older ones may use a PC parallel port, or even a serial port.
817
818 @enumerate
819 @item @emph{Start with power to your target board turned off},
820 and nothing connected to your JTAG adapter.
821 If you're particularly paranoid, unplug power to the board.
822 It's important to have the ground signal properly set up,
823 unless you are using a JTAG adapter which provides
824 galvanic isolation between the target board and the
825 debugging host.
826
827 @item @emph{Be sure it's the right kind of JTAG connector.}
828 If your dongle has a 20-pin ARM connector, you need some kind
829 of adapter (or octopus, see below) to hook it up to
830 boards using 14-pin or 10-pin connectors ... or to 20-pin
831 connectors which don't use ARM's pinout.
832
833 In the same vein, make sure the voltage levels are compatible.
834 Not all JTAG adapters have the level shifters needed to work
835 with 1.2 Volt boards.
836
837 @item @emph{Be certain the cable is properly oriented} or you might
838 damage your board. In most cases there are only two possible
839 ways to connect the cable.
840 Connect the JTAG cable from your adapter to the board.
841 Be sure it's firmly connected.
842
843 In the best case, the connector is keyed to physically
844 prevent you from inserting it wrong.
845 This is most often done using a slot on the board's male connector
846 housing, which must match a key on the JTAG cable's female connector.
847 If there's no housing, then you must look carefully and
848 make sure pin 1 on the cable hooks up to pin 1 on the board.
849 Ribbon cables are frequently all grey except for a wire on one
850 edge, which is red. The red wire is pin 1.
851
852 Sometimes dongles provide cables where one end is an ``octopus'' of
853 color coded single-wire connectors, instead of a connector block.
854 These are great when converting from one JTAG pinout to another,
855 but are tedious to set up.
856 Use these with connector pinout diagrams to help you match up the
857 adapter signals to the right board pins.
858
859 @item @emph{Connect the adapter's other end} once the JTAG cable is connected.
860 A USB, parallel, or serial port connector will go to the host which
861 you are using to run OpenOCD.
862 For Ethernet, consult the documentation and your network administrator.
863
864 For USB-based JTAG adapters you have an easy sanity check at this point:
865 does the host operating system see the JTAG adapter? If you're running
866 Linux, try the @command{lsusb} command. If that host is an
867 MS-Windows host, you'll need to install a driver before OpenOCD works.
868
869 @item @emph{Connect the adapter's power supply, if needed.}
870 This step is primarily for non-USB adapters,
871 but sometimes USB adapters need extra power.
872
873 @item @emph{Power up the target board.}
874 Unless you just let the magic smoke escape,
875 you're now ready to set up the OpenOCD server
876 so you can use JTAG to work with that board.
877
878 @end enumerate
879
880 Talk with the OpenOCD server using
881 telnet (@code{telnet localhost 4444} on many systems) or GDB.
882 @xref{GDB and OpenOCD}.
883
884 @section Project Directory
885
886 There are many ways you can configure OpenOCD and start it up.
887
888 A simple way to organize them all involves keeping a
889 single directory for your work with a given board.
890 When you start OpenOCD from that directory,
891 it searches there first for configuration files, scripts,
892 files accessed through semihosting,
893 and for code you upload to the target board.
894 It is also the natural place to write files,
895 such as log files and data you download from the board.
896
897 @section Configuration Basics
898
899 There are two basic ways of configuring OpenOCD, and
900 a variety of ways you can mix them.
901 Think of the difference as just being how you start the server:
902
903 @itemize
904 @item Many @option{-f file} or @option{-c command} options on the command line
905 @item No options, but a @dfn{user config file}
906 in the current directory named @file{openocd.cfg}
907 @end itemize
908
909 Here is an example @file{openocd.cfg} file for a setup
910 using a Signalyzer FT2232-based JTAG adapter to talk to
911 a board with an Atmel AT91SAM7X256 microcontroller:
912
913 @example
914 source [find interface/ftdi/signalyzer.cfg]
915
916 # GDB can also flash my flash!
917 gdb_memory_map enable
918 gdb_flash_program enable
919
920 source [find target/sam7x256.cfg]
921 @end example
922
923 Here is the command line equivalent of that configuration:
924
925 @example
926 openocd -f interface/ftdi/signalyzer.cfg \
927 -c "gdb_memory_map enable" \
928 -c "gdb_flash_program enable" \
929 -f target/sam7x256.cfg
930 @end example
931
932 You could wrap such long command lines in shell scripts,
933 each supporting a different development task.
934 One might re-flash the board with a specific firmware version.
935 Another might set up a particular debugging or run-time environment.
936
937 @quotation Important
938 At this writing (October 2009) the command line method has
939 problems with how it treats variables.
940 For example, after @option{-c "set VAR value"}, or doing the
941 same in a script, the variable @var{VAR} will have no value
942 that can be tested in a later script.
943 @end quotation
944
945 Here we will focus on the simpler solution: one user config
946 file, including basic configuration plus any TCL procedures
947 to simplify your work.
948
949 @section User Config Files
950 @cindex config file, user
951 @cindex user config file
952 @cindex config file, overview
953
954 A user configuration file ties together all the parts of a project
955 in one place.
956 One of the following will match your situation best:
957
958 @itemize
959 @item Ideally almost everything comes from configuration files
960 provided by someone else.
961 For example, OpenOCD distributes a @file{scripts} directory
962 (probably in @file{/usr/share/openocd/scripts} on Linux).
963 Board and tool vendors can provide these too, as can individual
964 user sites; the @option{-s} command line option lets you say
965 where to find these files. (@xref{Running}.)
966 The AT91SAM7X256 example above works this way.
967
968 Three main types of non-user configuration file each have their
969 own subdirectory in the @file{scripts} directory:
970
971 @enumerate
972 @item @b{interface} -- one for each different debug adapter;
973 @item @b{board} -- one for each different board
974 @item @b{target} -- the chips which integrate CPUs and other JTAG TAPs
975 @end enumerate
976
977 Best case: include just two files, and they handle everything else.
978 The first is an interface config file.
979 The second is board-specific, and it sets up the JTAG TAPs and
980 their GDB targets (by deferring to some @file{target.cfg} file),
981 declares all flash memory, and leaves you nothing to do except
982 meet your deadline:
983
984 @example
985 source [find interface/olimex-jtag-tiny.cfg]
986 source [find board/csb337.cfg]
987 @end example
988
989 Boards with a single microcontroller often won't need more
990 than the target config file, as in the AT91SAM7X256 example.
991 That's because there is no external memory (flash, DDR RAM), and
992 the board differences are encapsulated by application code.
993
994 @item Maybe you don't know yet what your board looks like to JTAG.
995 Once you know the @file{interface.cfg} file to use, you may
996 need help from OpenOCD to discover what's on the board.
997 Once you find the JTAG TAPs, you can just search for appropriate
998 target and board
999 configuration files ... or write your own, from the bottom up.
1000 @xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
1001
1002 @item You can often reuse some standard config files but
1003 need to write a few new ones, probably a @file{board.cfg} file.
1004 You will be using commands described later in this User's Guide,
1005 and working with the guidelines in the next chapter.
1006
1007 For example, there may be configuration files for your JTAG adapter
1008 and target chip, but you need a new board-specific config file
1009 giving access to your particular flash chips.
1010 Or you might need to write another target chip configuration file
1011 for a new chip built around the Cortex-M3 core.
1012
1013 @quotation Note
1014 When you write new configuration files, please submit
1015 them for inclusion in the next OpenOCD release.
1016 For example, a @file{board/newboard.cfg} file will help the
1017 next users of that board, and a @file{target/newcpu.cfg}
1018 will help support users of any board using that chip.
1019 @end quotation
1020
1021 @item
1022 You may may need to write some C code.
1023 It may be as simple as supporting a new FT2232 or parport
1024 based adapter; a bit more involved, like a NAND or NOR flash
1025 controller driver; or a big piece of work like supporting
1026 a new chip architecture.
1027 @end itemize
1028
1029 Reuse the existing config files when you can.
1030 Look first in the @file{scripts/boards} area, then @file{scripts/targets}.
1031 You may find a board configuration that's a good example to follow.
1032
1033 When you write config files, separate the reusable parts
1034 (things every user of that interface, chip, or board needs)
1035 from ones specific to your environment and debugging approach.
1036 @itemize
1037
1038 @item
1039 For example, a @code{gdb-attach} event handler that invokes
1040 the @command{reset init} command will interfere with debugging
1041 early boot code, which performs some of the same actions
1042 that the @code{reset-init} event handler does.
1043
1044 @item
1045 Likewise, the @command{arm9 vector_catch} command (or
1046 @cindex vector_catch
1047 its siblings @command{xscale vector_catch}
1048 and @command{cortex_m vector_catch}) can be a time-saver
1049 during some debug sessions, but don't make everyone use that either.
1050 Keep those kinds of debugging aids in your user config file,
1051 along with messaging and tracing setup.
1052 (@xref{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing,,Software Debug Messages and Tracing}.)
1053
1054 @item
1055 You might need to override some defaults.
1056 For example, you might need to move, shrink, or back up the target's
1057 work area if your application needs much SRAM.
1058
1059 @item
1060 TCP/IP port configuration is another example of something which
1061 is environment-specific, and should only appear in
1062 a user config file. @xref{tcpipports,,TCP/IP Ports}.
1063 @end itemize
1064
1065 @section Project-Specific Utilities
1066
1067 A few project-specific utility
1068 routines may well speed up your work.
1069 Write them, and keep them in your project's user config file.
1070
1071 For example, if you are making a boot loader work on a
1072 board, it's nice to be able to debug the ``after it's
1073 loaded to RAM'' parts separately from the finicky early
1074 code which sets up the DDR RAM controller and clocks.
1075 A script like this one, or a more GDB-aware sibling,
1076 may help:
1077
1078 @example
1079 proc ramboot @{ @} @{
1080 # Reset, running the target's "reset-init" scripts
1081 # to initialize clocks and the DDR RAM controller.
1082 # Leave the CPU halted.
1083 reset init
1084
1085 # Load CONFIG_SKIP_LOWLEVEL_INIT version into DDR RAM.
1086 load_image u-boot.bin 0x20000000
1087
1088 # Start running.
1089 resume 0x20000000
1090 @}
1091 @end example
1092
1093 Then once that code is working you will need to make it
1094 boot from NOR flash; a different utility would help.
1095 Alternatively, some developers write to flash using GDB.
1096 (You might use a similar script if you're working with a flash
1097 based microcontroller application instead of a boot loader.)
1098
1099 @example
1100 proc newboot @{ @} @{
1101 # Reset, leaving the CPU halted. The "reset-init" event
1102 # proc gives faster access to the CPU and to NOR flash;
1103 # "reset halt" would be slower.
1104 reset init
1105
1106 # Write standard version of U-Boot into the first two
1107 # sectors of NOR flash ... the standard version should
1108 # do the same lowlevel init as "reset-init".
1109 flash protect 0 0 1 off
1110 flash erase_sector 0 0 1
1111 flash write_bank 0 u-boot.bin 0x0
1112 flash protect 0 0 1 on
1113
1114 # Reboot from scratch using that new boot loader.
1115 reset run
1116 @}
1117 @end example
1118
1119 You may need more complicated utility procedures when booting
1120 from NAND.
1121 That often involves an extra bootloader stage,
1122 running from on-chip SRAM to perform DDR RAM setup so it can load
1123 the main bootloader code (which won't fit into that SRAM).
1124
1125 Other helper scripts might be used to write production system images,
1126 involving considerably more than just a three stage bootloader.
1127
1128 @section Target Software Changes
1129
1130 Sometimes you may want to make some small changes to the software
1131 you're developing, to help make JTAG debugging work better.
1132 For example, in C or assembly language code you might
1133 use @code{#ifdef JTAG_DEBUG} (or its converse) around code
1134 handling issues like:
1135
1136 @itemize @bullet
1137
1138 @item @b{Watchdog Timers}...
1139 Watchdog timers are typically used to automatically reset systems if
1140 some application task doesn't periodically reset the timer. (The
1141 assumption is that the system has locked up if the task can't run.)
1142 When a JTAG debugger halts the system, that task won't be able to run
1143 and reset the timer ... potentially causing resets in the middle of
1144 your debug sessions.
1145
1146 It's rarely a good idea to disable such watchdogs, since their usage
1147 needs to be debugged just like all other parts of your firmware.
1148 That might however be your only option.
1149
1150 Look instead for chip-specific ways to stop the watchdog from counting
1151 while the system is in a debug halt state. It may be simplest to set
1152 that non-counting mode in your debugger startup scripts. You may however
1153 need a different approach when, for example, a motor could be physically
1154 damaged by firmware remaining inactive in a debug halt state. That might
1155 involve a type of firmware mode where that "non-counting" mode is disabled
1156 at the beginning then re-enabled at the end; a watchdog reset might fire
1157 and complicate the debug session, but hardware (or people) would be
1158 protected.@footnote{Note that many systems support a "monitor mode" debug
1159 that is a somewhat cleaner way to address such issues. You can think of
1160 it as only halting part of the system, maybe just one task,
1161 instead of the whole thing.
1162 At this writing, January 2010, OpenOCD based debugging does not support
1163 monitor mode debug, only "halt mode" debug.}
1164
1165 @item @b{ARM Semihosting}...
1166 @cindex ARM semihosting
1167 When linked with a special runtime library provided with many
1168 toolchains@footnote{See chapter 8 "Semihosting" in
1169 @uref{http://infocenter.arm.com/help/topic/com.arm.doc.dui0203i/DUI0203I_rvct_developer_guide.pdf,
1170 ARM DUI 0203I}, the "RealView Compilation Tools Developer Guide".
1171 The CodeSourcery EABI toolchain also includes a semihosting library.},
1172 your target code can use I/O facilities on the debug host. That library
1173 provides a small set of system calls which are handled by OpenOCD.
1174 It can let the debugger provide your system console and a file system,
1175 helping with early debugging or providing a more capable environment
1176 for sometimes-complex tasks like installing system firmware onto
1177 NAND or SPI flash.
1178
1179 @item @b{ARM Wait-For-Interrupt}...
1180 Many ARM chips synchronize the JTAG clock using the core clock.
1181 Low power states which stop that core clock thus prevent JTAG access.
1182 Idle loops in tasking environments often enter those low power states
1183 via the @code{WFI} instruction (or its coprocessor equivalent, before ARMv7).
1184
1185 You may want to @emph{disable that instruction} in source code,
1186 or otherwise prevent using that state,
1187 to ensure you can get JTAG access at any time.@footnote{As a more
1188 polite alternative, some processors have special debug-oriented
1189 registers which can be used to change various features including
1190 how the low power states are clocked while debugging.
1191 The STM32 DBGMCU_CR register is an example; at the cost of extra
1192 power consumption, JTAG can be used during low power states.}
1193 For example, the OpenOCD @command{halt} command may not
1194 work for an idle processor otherwise.
1195
1196 @item @b{Delay after reset}...
1197 Not all chips have good support for debugger access
1198 right after reset; many LPC2xxx chips have issues here.
1199 Similarly, applications that reconfigure pins used for
1200 JTAG access as they start will also block debugger access.
1201
1202 To work with boards like this, @emph{enable a short delay loop}
1203 the first thing after reset, before "real" startup activities.
1204 For example, one second's delay is usually more than enough
1205 time for a JTAG debugger to attach, so that
1206 early code execution can be debugged
1207 or firmware can be replaced.
1208
1209 @item @b{Debug Communications Channel (DCC)}...
1210 Some processors include mechanisms to send messages over JTAG.
1211 Many ARM cores support these, as do some cores from other vendors.
1212 (OpenOCD may be able to use this DCC internally, speeding up some
1213 operations like writing to memory.)
1214
1215 Your application may want to deliver various debugging messages
1216 over JTAG, by @emph{linking with a small library of code}
1217 provided with OpenOCD and using the utilities there to send
1218 various kinds of message.
1219 @xref{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing,,Software Debug Messages and Tracing}.
1220
1221 @end itemize
1222
1223 @section Target Hardware Setup
1224
1225 Chip vendors often provide software development boards which
1226 are highly configurable, so that they can support all options
1227 that product boards may require. @emph{Make sure that any
1228 jumpers or switches match the system configuration you are
1229 working with.}
1230
1231 Common issues include:
1232
1233 @itemize @bullet
1234
1235 @item @b{JTAG setup} ...
1236 Boards may support more than one JTAG configuration.
1237 Examples include jumpers controlling pullups versus pulldowns
1238 on the nTRST and/or nSRST signals, and choice of connectors
1239 (e.g. which of two headers on the base board,
1240 or one from a daughtercard).
1241 For some Texas Instruments boards, you may need to jumper the
1242 EMU0 and EMU1 signals (which OpenOCD won't currently control).
1243
1244 @item @b{Boot Modes} ...
1245 Complex chips often support multiple boot modes, controlled
1246 by external jumpers. Make sure this is set up correctly.
1247 For example many i.MX boards from NXP need to be jumpered
1248 to "ATX mode" to start booting using the on-chip ROM, when
1249 using second stage bootloader code stored in a NAND flash chip.
1250
1251 Such explicit configuration is common, and not limited to
1252 booting from NAND. You might also need to set jumpers to
1253 start booting using code loaded from an MMC/SD card; external
1254 SPI flash; Ethernet, UART, or USB links; NOR flash; OneNAND
1255 flash; some external host; or various other sources.
1256
1257
1258 @item @b{Memory Addressing} ...
1259 Boards which support multiple boot modes may also have jumpers
1260 to configure memory addressing. One board, for example, jumpers
1261 external chipselect 0 (used for booting) to address either
1262 a large SRAM (which must be pre-loaded via JTAG), NOR flash,
1263 or NAND flash. When it's jumpered to address NAND flash, that
1264 board must also be told to start booting from on-chip ROM.
1265
1266 Your @file{board.cfg} file may also need to be told this jumper
1267 configuration, so that it can know whether to declare NOR flash
1268 using @command{flash bank} or instead declare NAND flash with
1269 @command{nand device}; and likewise which probe to perform in
1270 its @code{reset-init} handler.
1271
1272 A closely related issue is bus width. Jumpers might need to
1273 distinguish between 8 bit or 16 bit bus access for the flash
1274 used to start booting.
1275
1276 @item @b{Peripheral Access} ...
1277 Development boards generally provide access to every peripheral
1278 on the chip, sometimes in multiple modes (such as by providing
1279 multiple audio codec chips).
1280 This interacts with software
1281 configuration of pin multiplexing, where for example a
1282 given pin may be routed either to the MMC/SD controller
1283 or the GPIO controller. It also often interacts with
1284 configuration jumpers. One jumper may be used to route
1285 signals to an MMC/SD card slot or an expansion bus (which
1286 might in turn affect booting); others might control which
1287 audio or video codecs are used.
1288
1289 @end itemize
1290
1291 Plus you should of course have @code{reset-init} event handlers
1292 which set up the hardware to match that jumper configuration.
1293 That includes in particular any oscillator or PLL used to clock
1294 the CPU, and any memory controllers needed to access external
1295 memory and peripherals. Without such handlers, you won't be
1296 able to access those resources without working target firmware
1297 which can do that setup ... this can be awkward when you're
1298 trying to debug that target firmware. Even if there's a ROM
1299 bootloader which handles a few issues, it rarely provides full
1300 access to all board-specific capabilities.
1301
1302
1303 @node Config File Guidelines
1304 @chapter Config File Guidelines
1305
1306 This chapter is aimed at any user who needs to write a config file,
1307 including developers and integrators of OpenOCD and any user who
1308 needs to get a new board working smoothly.
1309 It provides guidelines for creating those files.
1310
1311 You should find the following directories under
1312 @t{$(INSTALLDIR)/scripts}, with config files maintained upstream. Use
1313 them as-is where you can; or as models for new files.
1314 @itemize @bullet
1315 @item @file{interface} ...
1316 These are for debug adapters. Files that specify configuration to use
1317 specific JTAG, SWD and other adapters go here.
1318 @item @file{board} ...
1319 Think Circuit Board, PWA, PCB, they go by many names. Board files
1320 contain initialization items that are specific to a board.
1321
1322 They reuse target configuration files, since the same
1323 microprocessor chips are used on many boards,
1324 but support for external parts varies widely. For
1325 example, the SDRAM initialization sequence for the board, or the type
1326 of external flash and what address it uses. Any initialization
1327 sequence to enable that external flash or SDRAM should be found in the
1328 board file. Boards may also contain multiple targets: two CPUs; or
1329 a CPU and an FPGA.
1330 @item @file{target} ...
1331 Think chip. The ``target'' directory represents the JTAG TAPs
1332 on a chip
1333 which OpenOCD should control, not a board. Two common types of targets
1334 are ARM chips and FPGA or CPLD chips.
1335 When a chip has multiple TAPs (maybe it has both ARM and DSP cores),
1336 the target config file defines all of them.
1337 @item @emph{more} ... browse for other library files which may be useful.
1338 For example, there are various generic and CPU-specific utilities.
1339 @end itemize
1340
1341 The @file{openocd.cfg} user config
1342 file may override features in any of the above files by
1343 setting variables before sourcing the target file, or by adding
1344 commands specific to their situation.
1345
1346 @section Interface Config Files
1347
1348 The user config file
1349 should be able to source one of these files with a command like this:
1350
1351 @example
1352 source [find interface/FOOBAR.cfg]
1353 @end example
1354
1355 A preconfigured interface file should exist for every debug adapter
1356 in use today with OpenOCD.
1357 That said, perhaps some of these config files
1358 have only been used by the developer who created it.
1359
1360 A separate chapter gives information about how to set these up.
1361 @xref{Debug Adapter Configuration}.
1362 Read the OpenOCD source code (and Developer's Guide)
1363 if you have a new kind of hardware interface
1364 and need to provide a driver for it.
1365
1366 @section Board Config Files
1367 @cindex config file, board
1368 @cindex board config file
1369
1370 The user config file
1371 should be able to source one of these files with a command like this:
1372
1373 @example
1374 source [find board/FOOBAR.cfg]
1375 @end example
1376
1377 The point of a board config file is to package everything
1378 about a given board that user config files need to know.
1379 In summary the board files should contain (if present)
1380
1381 @enumerate
1382 @item One or more @command{source [find target/...cfg]} statements
1383 @item NOR flash configuration (@pxref{norconfiguration,,NOR Configuration})
1384 @item NAND flash configuration (@pxref{nandconfiguration,,NAND Configuration})
1385 @item Target @code{reset} handlers for SDRAM and I/O configuration
1386 @item JTAG adapter reset configuration (@pxref{Reset Configuration})
1387 @item All things that are not ``inside a chip''
1388 @end enumerate
1389
1390 Generic things inside target chips belong in target config files,
1391 not board config files. So for example a @code{reset-init} event
1392 handler should know board-specific oscillator and PLL parameters,
1393 which it passes to target-specific utility code.
1394
1395 The most complex task of a board config file is creating such a
1396 @code{reset-init} event handler.
1397 Define those handlers last, after you verify the rest of the board
1398 configuration works.
1399
1400 @subsection Communication Between Config files
1401
1402 In addition to target-specific utility code, another way that
1403 board and target config files communicate is by following a
1404 convention on how to use certain variables.
1405
1406 The full Tcl/Tk language supports ``namespaces'', but Jim-Tcl does not.
1407 Thus the rule we follow in OpenOCD is this: Variables that begin with
1408 a leading underscore are temporary in nature, and can be modified and
1409 used at will within a target configuration file.
1410
1411 Complex board config files can do the things like this,
1412 for a board with three chips:
1413
1414 @example
1415 # Chip #1: PXA270 for network side, big endian
1416 set CHIPNAME network
1417 set ENDIAN big
1418 source [find target/pxa270.cfg]
1419 # on return: _TARGETNAME = network.cpu
1420 # other commands can refer to the "network.cpu" target.
1421 $_TARGETNAME configure .... events for this CPU..
1422
1423 # Chip #2: PXA270 for video side, little endian
1424 set CHIPNAME video
1425 set ENDIAN little
1426 source [find target/pxa270.cfg]
1427 # on return: _TARGETNAME = video.cpu
1428 # other commands can refer to the "video.cpu" target.
1429 $_TARGETNAME configure .... events for this CPU..
1430
1431 # Chip #3: Xilinx FPGA for glue logic
1432 set CHIPNAME xilinx
1433 unset ENDIAN
1434 source [find target/spartan3.cfg]
1435 @end example
1436
1437 That example is oversimplified because it doesn't show any flash memory,
1438 or the @code{reset-init} event handlers to initialize external DRAM
1439 or (assuming it needs it) load a configuration into the FPGA.
1440 Such features are usually needed for low-level work with many boards,
1441 where ``low level'' implies that the board initialization software may
1442 not be working. (That's a common reason to need JTAG tools. Another
1443 is to enable working with microcontroller-based systems, which often
1444 have no debugging support except a JTAG connector.)
1445
1446 Target config files may also export utility functions to board and user
1447 config files. Such functions should use name prefixes, to help avoid
1448 naming collisions.
1449
1450 Board files could also accept input variables from user config files.
1451 For example, there might be a @code{J4_JUMPER} setting used to identify
1452 what kind of flash memory a development board is using, or how to set
1453 up other clocks and peripherals.
1454
1455 @subsection Variable Naming Convention
1456 @cindex variable names
1457
1458 Most boards have only one instance of a chip.
1459 However, it should be easy to create a board with more than
1460 one such chip (as shown above).
1461 Accordingly, we encourage these conventions for naming
1462 variables associated with different @file{target.cfg} files,
1463 to promote consistency and
1464 so that board files can override target defaults.
1465
1466 Inputs to target config files include:
1467
1468 @itemize @bullet
1469 @item @code{CHIPNAME} ...
1470 This gives a name to the overall chip, and is used as part of
1471 tap identifier dotted names.
1472 While the default is normally provided by the chip manufacturer,
1473 board files may need to distinguish between instances of a chip.
1474 @item @code{ENDIAN} ...
1475 By default @option{little} - although chips may hard-wire @option{big}.
1476 Chips that can't change endianess don't need to use this variable.
1477 @item @code{CPUTAPID} ...
1478 When OpenOCD examines the JTAG chain, it can be told verify the
1479 chips against the JTAG IDCODE register.
1480 The target file will hold one or more defaults, but sometimes the
1481 chip in a board will use a different ID (perhaps a newer revision).
1482 @end itemize
1483
1484 Outputs from target config files include:
1485
1486 @itemize @bullet
1487 @item @code{_TARGETNAME} ...
1488 By convention, this variable is created by the target configuration
1489 script. The board configuration file may make use of this variable to
1490 configure things like a ``reset init'' script, or other things
1491 specific to that board and that target.
1492 If the chip has 2 targets, the names are @code{_TARGETNAME0},
1493 @code{_TARGETNAME1}, ... etc.
1494 @end itemize
1495
1496 @subsection The reset-init Event Handler
1497 @cindex event, reset-init
1498 @cindex reset-init handler
1499
1500 Board config files run in the OpenOCD configuration stage;
1501 they can't use TAPs or targets, since they haven't been
1502 fully set up yet.
1503 This means you can't write memory or access chip registers;
1504 you can't even verify that a flash chip is present.
1505 That's done later in event handlers, of which the target @code{reset-init}
1506 handler is one of the most important.
1507
1508 Except on microcontrollers, the basic job of @code{reset-init} event
1509 handlers is setting up flash and DRAM, as normally handled by boot loaders.
1510 Microcontrollers rarely use boot loaders; they run right out of their
1511 on-chip flash and SRAM memory. But they may want to use one of these
1512 handlers too, if just for developer convenience.
1513
1514 @quotation Note
1515 Because this is so very board-specific, and chip-specific, no examples
1516 are included here.
1517 Instead, look at the board config files distributed with OpenOCD.
1518 If you have a boot loader, its source code will help; so will
1519 configuration files for other JTAG tools
1520 (@pxref{translatingconfigurationfiles,,Translating Configuration Files}).
1521 @end quotation
1522
1523 Some of this code could probably be shared between different boards.
1524 For example, setting up a DRAM controller often doesn't differ by
1525 much except the bus width (16 bits or 32?) and memory timings, so a
1526 reusable TCL procedure loaded by the @file{target.cfg} file might take
1527 those as parameters.
1528 Similarly with oscillator, PLL, and clock setup;
1529 and disabling the watchdog.
1530 Structure the code cleanly, and provide comments to help
1531 the next developer doing such work.
1532 (@emph{You might be that next person} trying to reuse init code!)
1533
1534 The last thing normally done in a @code{reset-init} handler is probing
1535 whatever flash memory was configured. For most chips that needs to be
1536 done while the associated target is halted, either because JTAG memory
1537 access uses the CPU or to prevent conflicting CPU access.
1538
1539 @subsection JTAG Clock Rate
1540
1541 Before your @code{reset-init} handler has set up
1542 the PLLs and clocking, you may need to run with
1543 a low JTAG clock rate.
1544 @xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.
1545 Then you'd increase that rate after your handler has
1546 made it possible to use the faster JTAG clock.
1547 When the initial low speed is board-specific, for example
1548 because it depends on a board-specific oscillator speed, then
1549 you should probably set it up in the board config file;
1550 if it's target-specific, it belongs in the target config file.
1551
1552 For most ARM-based processors the fastest JTAG clock@footnote{A FAQ
1553 @uref{http://www.arm.com/support/faqdev/4170.html} gives details.}
1554 is one sixth of the CPU clock; or one eighth for ARM11 cores.
1555 Consult chip documentation to determine the peak JTAG clock rate,
1556 which might be less than that.
1557
1558 @quotation Warning
1559 On most ARMs, JTAG clock detection is coupled to the core clock, so
1560 software using a @option{wait for interrupt} operation blocks JTAG access.
1561 Adaptive clocking provides a partial workaround, but a more complete
1562 solution just avoids using that instruction with JTAG debuggers.
1563 @end quotation
1564
1565 If both the chip and the board support adaptive clocking,
1566 use the @command{jtag_rclk}
1567 command, in case your board is used with JTAG adapter which
1568 also supports it. Otherwise use @command{adapter_khz}.
1569 Set the slow rate at the beginning of the reset sequence,
1570 and the faster rate as soon as the clocks are at full speed.
1571
1572 @anchor{theinitboardprocedure}
1573 @subsection The init_board procedure
1574 @cindex init_board procedure
1575
1576 The concept of @code{init_board} procedure is very similar to @code{init_targets}
1577 (@xref{theinittargetsprocedure,,The init_targets procedure}.) - it's a replacement of ``linear''
1578 configuration scripts. This procedure is meant to be executed when OpenOCD enters run stage
1579 (@xref{enteringtherunstage,,Entering the Run Stage},) after @code{init_targets}. The idea to have
1580 separate @code{init_targets} and @code{init_board} procedures is to allow the first one to configure
1581 everything target specific (internal flash, internal RAM, etc.) and the second one to configure
1582 everything board specific (reset signals, chip frequency, reset-init event handler, external memory, etc.).
1583 Additionally ``linear'' board config file will most likely fail when target config file uses
1584 @code{init_targets} scheme (``linear'' script is executed before @code{init} and @code{init_targets} - after),
1585 so separating these two configuration stages is very convenient, as the easiest way to overcome this
1586 problem is to convert board config file to use @code{init_board} procedure. Board config scripts don't
1587 need to override @code{init_targets} defined in target config files when they only need to add some specifics.
1588
1589 Just as @code{init_targets}, the @code{init_board} procedure can be overridden by ``next level'' script (which sources
1590 the original), allowing greater code reuse.
1591
1592 @example
1593 ### board_file.cfg ###
1594
1595 # source target file that does most of the config in init_targets
1596 source [find target/target.cfg]
1597
1598 proc enable_fast_clock @{@} @{
1599 # enables fast on-board clock source
1600 # configures the chip to use it
1601 @}
1602
1603 # initialize only board specifics - reset, clock, adapter frequency
1604 proc init_board @{@} @{
1605 reset_config trst_and_srst trst_pulls_srst
1606
1607 $_TARGETNAME configure -event reset-start @{
1608 adapter_khz 100
1609 @}
1610
1611 $_TARGETNAME configure -event reset-init @{
1612 enable_fast_clock
1613 adapter_khz 10000
1614 @}
1615 @}
1616 @end example
1617
1618 @section Target Config Files
1619 @cindex config file, target
1620 @cindex target config file
1621
1622 Board config files communicate with target config files using
1623 naming conventions as described above, and may source one or
1624 more target config files like this:
1625
1626 @example
1627 source [find target/FOOBAR.cfg]
1628 @end example
1629
1630 The point of a target config file is to package everything
1631 about a given chip that board config files need to know.
1632 In summary the target files should contain
1633
1634 @enumerate
1635 @item Set defaults
1636 @item Add TAPs to the scan chain
1637 @item Add CPU targets (includes GDB support)
1638 @item CPU/Chip/CPU-Core specific features
1639 @item On-Chip flash
1640 @end enumerate
1641
1642 As a rule of thumb, a target file sets up only one chip.
1643 For a microcontroller, that will often include a single TAP,
1644 which is a CPU needing a GDB target, and its on-chip flash.
1645
1646 More complex chips may include multiple TAPs, and the target
1647 config file may need to define them all before OpenOCD
1648 can talk to the chip.
1649 For example, some phone chips have JTAG scan chains that include
1650 an ARM core for operating system use, a DSP,
1651 another ARM core embedded in an image processing engine,
1652 and other processing engines.
1653
1654 @subsection Default Value Boiler Plate Code
1655
1656 All target configuration files should start with code like this,
1657 letting board config files express environment-specific
1658 differences in how things should be set up.
1659
1660 @example
1661 # Boards may override chip names, perhaps based on role,
1662 # but the default should match what the vendor uses
1663 if @{ [info exists CHIPNAME] @} @{
1664 set _CHIPNAME $CHIPNAME
1665 @} else @{
1666 set _CHIPNAME sam7x256
1667 @}
1668
1669 # ONLY use ENDIAN with targets that can change it.
1670 if @{ [info exists ENDIAN] @} @{
1671 set _ENDIAN $ENDIAN
1672 @} else @{
1673 set _ENDIAN little
1674 @}
1675
1676 # TAP identifiers may change as chips mature, for example with
1677 # new revision fields (the "3" here). Pick a good default; you
1678 # can pass several such identifiers to the "jtag newtap" command.
1679 if @{ [info exists CPUTAPID ] @} @{
1680 set _CPUTAPID $CPUTAPID
1681 @} else @{
1682 set _CPUTAPID 0x3f0f0f0f
1683 @}
1684 @end example
1685 @c but 0x3f0f0f0f is for an str73x part ...
1686
1687 @emph{Remember:} Board config files may include multiple target
1688 config files, or the same target file multiple times
1689 (changing at least @code{CHIPNAME}).
1690
1691 Likewise, the target configuration file should define
1692 @code{_TARGETNAME} (or @code{_TARGETNAME0} etc) and
1693 use it later on when defining debug targets:
1694
1695 @example
1696 set _TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.cpu
1697 target create $_TARGETNAME arm7tdmi -chain-position $_TARGETNAME
1698 @end example
1699
1700 @subsection Adding TAPs to the Scan Chain
1701 After the ``defaults'' are set up,
1702 add the TAPs on each chip to the JTAG scan chain.
1703 @xref{TAP Declaration}, and the naming convention
1704 for taps.
1705
1706 In the simplest case the chip has only one TAP,
1707 probably for a CPU or FPGA.
1708 The config file for the Atmel AT91SAM7X256
1709 looks (in part) like this:
1710
1711 @example
1712 jtag newtap $_CHIPNAME cpu -irlen 4 -expected-id $_CPUTAPID
1713 @end example
1714
1715 A board with two such at91sam7 chips would be able
1716 to source such a config file twice, with different
1717 values for @code{CHIPNAME}, so
1718 it adds a different TAP each time.
1719
1720 If there are nonzero @option{-expected-id} values,
1721 OpenOCD attempts to verify the actual tap id against those values.
1722 It will issue error messages if there is mismatch, which
1723 can help to pinpoint problems in OpenOCD configurations.
1724
1725 @example
1726 JTAG tap: sam7x256.cpu tap/device found: 0x3f0f0f0f
1727 (Manufacturer: 0x787, Part: 0xf0f0, Version: 0x3)
1728 ERROR: Tap: sam7x256.cpu - Expected id: 0x12345678, Got: 0x3f0f0f0f
1729 ERROR: expected: mfg: 0x33c, part: 0x2345, ver: 0x1
1730 ERROR: got: mfg: 0x787, part: 0xf0f0, ver: 0x3
1731 @end example
1732
1733 There are more complex examples too, with chips that have
1734 multiple TAPs. Ones worth looking at include:
1735
1736 @itemize
1737 @item @file{target/omap3530.cfg} -- with disabled ARM and DSP,
1738 plus a JRC to enable them
1739 @item @file{target/str912.cfg} -- with flash, CPU, and boundary scan
1740 @item @file{target/ti_dm355.cfg} -- with ETM, ARM, and JRC (this JRC
1741 is not currently used)
1742 @end itemize
1743
1744 @subsection Add CPU targets
1745
1746 After adding a TAP for a CPU, you should set it up so that
1747 GDB and other commands can use it.
1748 @xref{CPU Configuration}.
1749 For the at91sam7 example above, the command can look like this;
1750 note that @code{$_ENDIAN} is not needed, since OpenOCD defaults
1751 to little endian, and this chip doesn't support changing that.
1752
1753 @example
1754 set _TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.cpu
1755 target create $_TARGETNAME arm7tdmi -chain-position $_TARGETNAME
1756 @end example
1757
1758 Work areas are small RAM areas associated with CPU targets.
1759 They are used by OpenOCD to speed up downloads,
1760 and to download small snippets of code to program flash chips.
1761 If the chip includes a form of ``on-chip-ram'' - and many do - define
1762 a work area if you can.
1763 Again using the at91sam7 as an example, this can look like:
1764
1765 @example
1766 $_TARGETNAME configure -work-area-phys 0x00200000 \
1767 -work-area-size 0x4000 -work-area-backup 0
1768 @end example
1769
1770 @anchor{definecputargetsworkinginsmp}
1771 @subsection Define CPU targets working in SMP
1772 @cindex SMP
1773 After setting targets, you can define a list of targets working in SMP.
1774
1775 @example
1776 set _TARGETNAME_1 $_CHIPNAME.cpu1
1777 set _TARGETNAME_2 $_CHIPNAME.cpu2
1778 target create $_TARGETNAME_1 cortex_a -chain-position $_CHIPNAME.dap \
1779 -coreid 0 -dbgbase $_DAP_DBG1
1780 target create $_TARGETNAME_2 cortex_a -chain-position $_CHIPNAME.dap \
1781 -coreid 1 -dbgbase $_DAP_DBG2
1782 #define 2 targets working in smp.
1783 target smp $_CHIPNAME.cpu2 $_CHIPNAME.cpu1
1784 @end example
1785 In the above example on cortex_a, 2 cpus are working in SMP.
1786 In SMP only one GDB instance is created and :
1787 @itemize @bullet
1788 @item a set of hardware breakpoint sets the same breakpoint on all targets in the list.
1789 @item halt command triggers the halt of all targets in the list.
1790 @item resume command triggers the write context and the restart of all targets in the list.
1791 @item following a breakpoint: the target stopped by the breakpoint is displayed to the GDB session.
1792 @item dedicated GDB serial protocol packets are implemented for switching/retrieving the target
1793 displayed by the GDB session @pxref{usingopenocdsmpwithgdb,,Using OpenOCD SMP with GDB}.
1794 @end itemize
1795
1796 The SMP behaviour can be disabled/enabled dynamically. On cortex_a following
1797 command have been implemented.
1798 @itemize @bullet
1799 @item cortex_a smp_on : enable SMP mode, behaviour is as described above.
1800 @item cortex_a smp_off : disable SMP mode, the current target is the one
1801 displayed in the GDB session, only this target is now controlled by GDB
1802 session. This behaviour is useful during system boot up.
1803 @item cortex_a smp_gdb : display/fix the core id displayed in GDB session see
1804 following example.
1805 @end itemize
1806
1807 @example
1808 >cortex_a smp_gdb
1809 gdb coreid 0 -> -1
1810 #0 : coreid 0 is displayed to GDB ,
1811 #-> -1 : next resume triggers a real resume
1812 > cortex_a smp_gdb 1
1813 gdb coreid 0 -> 1
1814 #0 :coreid 0 is displayed to GDB ,
1815 #->1 : next resume displays coreid 1 to GDB
1816 > resume
1817 > cortex_a smp_gdb
1818 gdb coreid 1 -> 1
1819 #1 :coreid 1 is displayed to GDB ,
1820 #->1 : next resume displays coreid 1 to GDB
1821 > cortex_a smp_gdb -1
1822 gdb coreid 1 -> -1
1823 #1 :coreid 1 is displayed to GDB,
1824 #->-1 : next resume triggers a real resume
1825 @end example
1826
1827
1828 @subsection Chip Reset Setup
1829
1830 As a rule, you should put the @command{reset_config} command
1831 into the board file. Most things you think you know about a
1832 chip can be tweaked by the board.
1833
1834 Some chips have specific ways the TRST and SRST signals are
1835 managed. In the unusual case that these are @emph{chip specific}
1836 and can never be changed by board wiring, they could go here.
1837 For example, some chips can't support JTAG debugging without
1838 both signals.
1839
1840 Provide a @code{reset-assert} event handler if you can.
1841 Such a handler uses JTAG operations to reset the target,
1842 letting this target config be used in systems which don't
1843 provide the optional SRST signal, or on systems where you
1844 don't want to reset all targets at once.
1845 Such a handler might write to chip registers to force a reset,
1846 use a JRC to do that (preferable -- the target may be wedged!),
1847 or force a watchdog timer to trigger.
1848 (For Cortex-M targets, this is not necessary. The target
1849 driver knows how to use trigger an NVIC reset when SRST is
1850 not available.)
1851
1852 Some chips need special attention during reset handling if
1853 they're going to be used with JTAG.
1854 An example might be needing to send some commands right
1855 after the target's TAP has been reset, providing a
1856 @code{reset-deassert-post} event handler that writes a chip
1857 register to report that JTAG debugging is being done.
1858 Another would be reconfiguring the watchdog so that it stops
1859 counting while the core is halted in the debugger.
1860
1861 JTAG clocking constraints often change during reset, and in
1862 some cases target config files (rather than board config files)
1863 are the right places to handle some of those issues.
1864 For example, immediately after reset most chips run using a
1865 slower clock than they will use later.
1866 That means that after reset (and potentially, as OpenOCD
1867 first starts up) they must use a slower JTAG clock rate
1868 than they will use later.
1869 @xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.
1870
1871 @quotation Important
1872 When you are debugging code that runs right after chip
1873 reset, getting these issues right is critical.
1874 In particular, if you see intermittent failures when
1875 OpenOCD verifies the scan chain after reset,
1876 look at how you are setting up JTAG clocking.
1877 @end quotation
1878
1879 @anchor{theinittargetsprocedure}
1880 @subsection The init_targets procedure
1881 @cindex init_targets procedure
1882
1883 Target config files can either be ``linear'' (script executed line-by-line when parsed in
1884 configuration stage, @xref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage},) or they can contain a special
1885 procedure called @code{init_targets}, which will be executed when entering run stage
1886 (after parsing all config files or after @code{init} command, @xref{enteringtherunstage,,Entering the Run Stage}.)
1887 Such procedure can be overridden by ``next level'' script (which sources the original).
1888 This concept facilitates code reuse when basic target config files provide generic configuration
1889 procedures and @code{init_targets} procedure, which can then be sourced and enhanced or changed in
1890 a ``more specific'' target config file. This is not possible with ``linear'' config scripts,
1891 because sourcing them executes every initialization commands they provide.
1892
1893 @example
1894 ### generic_file.cfg ###
1895
1896 proc setup_my_chip @{chip_name flash_size ram_size@} @{
1897 # basic initialization procedure ...
1898 @}
1899
1900 proc init_targets @{@} @{
1901 # initializes generic chip with 4kB of flash and 1kB of RAM
1902 setup_my_chip MY_GENERIC_CHIP 4096 1024
1903 @}
1904
1905 ### specific_file.cfg ###
1906
1907 source [find target/generic_file.cfg]
1908
1909 proc init_targets @{@} @{
1910 # initializes specific chip with 128kB of flash and 64kB of RAM
1911 setup_my_chip MY_CHIP_WITH_128K_FLASH_64KB_RAM 131072 65536
1912 @}
1913 @end example
1914
1915 The easiest way to convert ``linear'' config files to @code{init_targets} version is to
1916 enclose every line of ``code'' (i.e. not @code{source} commands, procedures, etc.) in this procedure.
1917
1918 For an example of this scheme see LPC2000 target config files.
1919
1920 The @code{init_boards} procedure is a similar concept concerning board config files
1921 (@xref{theinitboardprocedure,,The init_board procedure}.)
1922
1923 @anchor{theinittargeteventsprocedure}
1924 @subsection The init_target_events procedure
1925 @cindex init_target_events procedure
1926
1927 A special procedure called @code{init_target_events} is run just after
1928 @code{init_targets} (@xref{theinittargetsprocedure,,The init_targets
1929 procedure}.) and before @code{init_board}
1930 (@xref{theinitboardprocedure,,The init_board procedure}.) It is used
1931 to set up default target events for the targets that do not have those
1932 events already assigned.
1933
1934 @subsection ARM Core Specific Hacks
1935
1936 If the chip has a DCC, enable it. If the chip is an ARM9 with some
1937 special high speed download features - enable it.
1938
1939 If present, the MMU, the MPU and the CACHE should be disabled.
1940
1941 Some ARM cores are equipped with trace support, which permits
1942 examination of the instruction and data bus activity. Trace
1943 activity is controlled through an ``Embedded Trace Module'' (ETM)
1944 on one of the core's scan chains. The ETM emits voluminous data
1945 through a ``trace port''. (@xref{armhardwaretracing,,ARM Hardware Tracing}.)
1946 If you are using an external trace port,
1947 configure it in your board config file.
1948 If you are using an on-chip ``Embedded Trace Buffer'' (ETB),
1949 configure it in your target config file.
1950
1951 @example
1952 etm config $_TARGETNAME 16 normal full etb
1953 etb config $_TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.etb
1954 @end example
1955
1956 @subsection Internal Flash Configuration
1957
1958 This applies @b{ONLY TO MICROCONTROLLERS} that have flash built in.
1959
1960 @b{Never ever} in the ``target configuration file'' define any type of
1961 flash that is external to the chip. (For example a BOOT flash on
1962 Chip Select 0.) Such flash information goes in a board file - not
1963 the TARGET (chip) file.
1964
1965 Examples:
1966 @itemize @bullet
1967 @item at91sam7x256 - has 256K flash YES enable it.
1968 @item str912 - has flash internal YES enable it.
1969 @item imx27 - uses boot flash on CS0 - it goes in the board file.
1970 @item pxa270 - again - CS0 flash - it goes in the board file.
1971 @end itemize
1972
1973 @anchor{translatingconfigurationfiles}
1974 @section Translating Configuration Files
1975 @cindex translation
1976 If you have a configuration file for another hardware debugger
1977 or toolset (Abatron, BDI2000, BDI3000, CCS,
1978 Lauterbach, SEGGER, Macraigor, etc.), translating
1979 it into OpenOCD syntax is often quite straightforward. The most tricky
1980 part of creating a configuration script is oftentimes the reset init
1981 sequence where e.g. PLLs, DRAM and the like is set up.
1982
1983 One trick that you can use when translating is to write small
1984 Tcl procedures to translate the syntax into OpenOCD syntax. This
1985 can avoid manual translation errors and make it easier to
1986 convert other scripts later on.
1987
1988 Example of transforming quirky arguments to a simple search and
1989 replace job:
1990
1991 @example
1992 # Lauterbach syntax(?)
1993 #
1994 # Data.Set c15:0x042f %long 0x40000015
1995 #
1996 # OpenOCD syntax when using procedure below.
1997 #
1998 # setc15 0x01 0x00050078
1999
2000 proc setc15 @{regs value@} @{
2001 global TARGETNAME
2002
2003 echo [format "set p15 0x%04x, 0x%08x" $regs $value]
2004
2005 arm mcr 15 [expr ($regs>>12)&0x7] \
2006 [expr ($regs>>0)&0xf] [expr ($regs>>4)&0xf] \
2007 [expr ($regs>>8)&0x7] $value
2008 @}
2009 @end example
2010
2011
2012
2013 @node Server Configuration
2014 @chapter Server Configuration
2015 @cindex initialization
2016 The commands here are commonly found in the openocd.cfg file and are
2017 used to specify what TCP/IP ports are used, and how GDB should be
2018 supported.
2019
2020 @anchor{configurationstage}
2021 @section Configuration Stage
2022 @cindex configuration stage
2023 @cindex config command
2024
2025 When the OpenOCD server process starts up, it enters a
2026 @emph{configuration stage} which is the only time that
2027 certain commands, @emph{configuration commands}, may be issued.
2028 Normally, configuration commands are only available
2029 inside startup scripts.
2030
2031 In this manual, the definition of a configuration command is
2032 presented as a @emph{Config Command}, not as a @emph{Command}
2033 which may be issued interactively.
2034 The runtime @command{help} command also highlights configuration
2035 commands, and those which may be issued at any time.
2036
2037 Those configuration commands include declaration of TAPs,
2038 flash banks,
2039 the interface used for JTAG communication,
2040 and other basic setup.
2041 The server must leave the configuration stage before it
2042 may access or activate TAPs.
2043 After it leaves this stage, configuration commands may no
2044 longer be issued.
2045
2046 @anchor{enteringtherunstage}
2047 @section Entering the Run Stage
2048
2049 The first thing OpenOCD does after leaving the configuration
2050 stage is to verify that it can talk to the scan chain
2051 (list of TAPs) which has been configured.
2052 It will warn if it doesn't find TAPs it expects to find,
2053 or finds TAPs that aren't supposed to be there.
2054 You should see no errors at this point.
2055 If you see errors, resolve them by correcting the
2056 commands you used to configure the server.
2057 Common errors include using an initial JTAG speed that's too
2058 fast, and not providing the right IDCODE values for the TAPs
2059 on the scan chain.
2060
2061 Once OpenOCD has entered the run stage, a number of commands
2062 become available.
2063 A number of these relate to the debug targets you may have declared.
2064 For example, the @command{mww} command will not be available until
2065 a target has been successfully instantiated.
2066 If you want to use those commands, you may need to force
2067 entry to the run stage.
2068
2069 @deffn {Config Command} init
2070 This command terminates the configuration stage and
2071 enters the run stage. This helps when you need to have
2072 the startup scripts manage tasks such as resetting the target,
2073 programming flash, etc. To reset the CPU upon startup, add "init" and
2074 "reset" at the end of the config script or at the end of the OpenOCD
2075 command line using the @option{-c} command line switch.
2076
2077 If this command does not appear in any startup/configuration file
2078 OpenOCD executes the command for you after processing all
2079 configuration files and/or command line options.
2080
2081 @b{NOTE:} This command normally occurs at or near the end of your
2082 openocd.cfg file to force OpenOCD to ``initialize'' and make the
2083 targets ready. For example: If your openocd.cfg file needs to
2084 read/write memory on your target, @command{init} must occur before
2085 the memory read/write commands. This includes @command{nand probe}.
2086 @end deffn
2087
2088 @deffn {Overridable Procedure} jtag_init
2089 This is invoked at server startup to verify that it can talk
2090 to the scan chain (list of TAPs) which has been configured.
2091
2092 The default implementation first tries @command{jtag arp_init},
2093 which uses only a lightweight JTAG reset before examining the
2094 scan chain.
2095 If that fails, it tries again, using a harder reset
2096 from the overridable procedure @command{init_reset}.
2097
2098 Implementations must have verified the JTAG scan chain before
2099 they return.
2100 This is done by calling @command{jtag arp_init}
2101 (or @command{jtag arp_init-reset}).
2102 @end deffn
2103
2104 @anchor{tcpipports}
2105 @section TCP/IP Ports
2106 @cindex TCP port
2107 @cindex server
2108 @cindex port
2109 @cindex security
2110 The OpenOCD server accepts remote commands in several syntaxes.
2111 Each syntax uses a different TCP/IP port, which you may specify
2112 only during configuration (before those ports are opened).
2113
2114 For reasons including security, you may wish to prevent remote
2115 access using one or more of these ports.
2116 In such cases, just specify the relevant port number as "disabled".
2117 If you disable all access through TCP/IP, you will need to
2118 use the command line @option{-pipe} option.
2119
2120 @anchor{gdb_port}
2121 @deffn {Command} gdb_port [number]
2122 @cindex GDB server
2123 Normally gdb listens to a TCP/IP port, but GDB can also
2124 communicate via pipes(stdin/out or named pipes). The name
2125 "gdb_port" stuck because it covers probably more than 90% of
2126 the normal use cases.
2127
2128 No arguments reports GDB port. "pipe" means listen to stdin
2129 output to stdout, an integer is base port number, "disabled"
2130 disables the gdb server.
2131
2132 When using "pipe", also use log_output to redirect the log
2133 output to a file so as not to flood the stdin/out pipes.
2134
2135 The -p/--pipe option is deprecated and a warning is printed
2136 as it is equivalent to passing in -c "gdb_port pipe; log_output openocd.log".
2137
2138 Any other string is interpreted as named pipe to listen to.
2139 Output pipe is the same name as input pipe, but with 'o' appended,
2140 e.g. /var/gdb, /var/gdbo.
2141
2142 The GDB port for the first target will be the base port, the
2143 second target will listen on gdb_port + 1, and so on.
2144 When not specified during the configuration stage,
2145 the port @var{number} defaults to 3333.
2146 When @var{number} is not a numeric value, incrementing it to compute
2147 the next port number does not work. In this case, specify the proper
2148 @var{number} for each target by using the option @code{-gdb-port} of the
2149 commands @command{target create} or @command{$target_name configure}.
2150 @xref{gdbportoverride,,option -gdb-port}.
2151
2152 Note: when using "gdb_port pipe", increasing the default remote timeout in
2153 gdb (with 'set remotetimeout') is recommended. An insufficient timeout may
2154 cause initialization to fail with "Unknown remote qXfer reply: OK".
2155 @end deffn
2156
2157 @deffn {Command} tcl_port [number]
2158 Specify or query the port used for a simplified RPC
2159 connection that can be used by clients to issue TCL commands and get the
2160 output from the Tcl engine.
2161 Intended as a machine interface.
2162 When not specified during the configuration stage,
2163 the port @var{number} defaults to 6666.
2164 When specified as "disabled", this service is not activated.
2165 @end deffn
2166
2167 @deffn {Command} telnet_port [number]
2168 Specify or query the
2169 port on which to listen for incoming telnet connections.
2170 This port is intended for interaction with one human through TCL commands.
2171 When not specified during the configuration stage,
2172 the port @var{number} defaults to 4444.
2173 When specified as "disabled", this service is not activated.
2174 @end deffn
2175
2176 @anchor{gdbconfiguration}
2177 @section GDB Configuration
2178 @cindex GDB
2179 @cindex GDB configuration
2180 You can reconfigure some GDB behaviors if needed.
2181 The ones listed here are static and global.
2182 @xref{targetconfiguration,,Target Configuration}, about configuring individual targets.
2183 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}, about configuring target-specific event handling.
2184
2185 @anchor{gdbbreakpointoverride}
2186 @deffn {Command} gdb_breakpoint_override [@option{hard}|@option{soft}|@option{disable}]
2187 Force breakpoint type for gdb @command{break} commands.
2188 This option supports GDB GUIs which don't
2189 distinguish hard versus soft breakpoints, if the default OpenOCD and
2190 GDB behaviour is not sufficient. GDB normally uses hardware
2191 breakpoints if the memory map has been set up for flash regions.
2192 @end deffn
2193
2194 @anchor{gdbflashprogram}
2195 @deffn {Config Command} gdb_flash_program (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2196 Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to program the flash memory when a
2197 vFlash packet is received.
2198 The default behaviour is @option{enable}.
2199 @end deffn
2200
2201 @deffn {Config Command} gdb_memory_map (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2202 Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to send the memory configuration to GDB when
2203 requested. GDB will then know when to set hardware breakpoints, and program flash
2204 using the GDB load command. @command{gdb_flash_program enable} must also be enabled
2205 for flash programming to work.
2206 Default behaviour is @option{enable}.
2207 @xref{gdbflashprogram,,gdb_flash_program}.
2208 @end deffn
2209
2210 @deffn {Config Command} gdb_report_data_abort (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2211 Specifies whether data aborts cause an error to be reported
2212 by GDB memory read packets.
2213 The default behaviour is @option{disable};
2214 use @option{enable} see these errors reported.
2215 @end deffn
2216
2217 @deffn {Config Command} gdb_report_register_access_error (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2218 Specifies whether register accesses requested by GDB register read/write
2219 packets report errors or not.
2220 The default behaviour is @option{disable};
2221 use @option{enable} see these errors reported.
2222 @end deffn
2223
2224 @deffn {Config Command} gdb_target_description (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2225 Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to send the target descriptions to gdb via qXfer:features:read packet.
2226 The default behaviour is @option{enable}.
2227 @end deffn
2228
2229 @deffn {Command} gdb_save_tdesc
2230 Saves the target description file to the local file system.
2231
2232 The file name is @i{target_name}.xml.
2233 @end deffn
2234
2235 @anchor{eventpolling}
2236 @section Event Polling
2237
2238 Hardware debuggers are parts of asynchronous systems,
2239 where significant events can happen at any time.
2240 The OpenOCD server needs to detect some of these events,
2241 so it can report them to through TCL command line
2242 or to GDB.
2243
2244 Examples of such events include:
2245
2246 @itemize
2247 @item One of the targets can stop running ... maybe it triggers
2248 a code breakpoint or data watchpoint, or halts itself.
2249 @item Messages may be sent over ``debug message'' channels ... many
2250 targets support such messages sent over JTAG,
2251 for receipt by the person debugging or tools.
2252 @item Loss of power ... some adapters can detect these events.
2253 @item Resets not issued through JTAG ... such reset sources
2254 can include button presses or other system hardware, sometimes
2255 including the target itself (perhaps through a watchdog).
2256 @item Debug instrumentation sometimes supports event triggering
2257 such as ``trace buffer full'' (so it can quickly be emptied)
2258 or other signals (to correlate with code behavior).
2259 @end itemize
2260
2261 None of those events are signaled through standard JTAG signals.
2262 However, most conventions for JTAG connectors include voltage
2263 level and system reset (SRST) signal detection.
2264 Some connectors also include instrumentation signals, which
2265 can imply events when those signals are inputs.
2266
2267 In general, OpenOCD needs to periodically check for those events,
2268 either by looking at the status of signals on the JTAG connector
2269 or by sending synchronous ``tell me your status'' JTAG requests
2270 to the various active targets.
2271 There is a command to manage and monitor that polling,
2272 which is normally done in the background.
2273
2274 @deffn Command poll [@option{on}|@option{off}]
2275 Poll the current target for its current state.
2276 (Also, @pxref{targetcurstate,,target curstate}.)
2277 If that target is in debug mode, architecture
2278 specific information about the current state is printed.
2279 An optional parameter
2280 allows background polling to be enabled and disabled.
2281
2282 You could use this from the TCL command shell, or
2283 from GDB using @command{monitor poll} command.
2284 Leave background polling enabled while you're using GDB.
2285 @example
2286 > poll
2287 background polling: on
2288 target state: halted
2289 target halted in ARM state due to debug-request, \
2290 current mode: Supervisor
2291 cpsr: 0x800000d3 pc: 0x11081bfc
2292 MMU: disabled, D-Cache: disabled, I-Cache: enabled
2293 >
2294 @end example
2295 @end deffn
2296
2297 @node Debug Adapter Configuration
2298 @chapter Debug Adapter Configuration
2299 @cindex config file, interface
2300 @cindex interface config file
2301
2302 Correctly installing OpenOCD includes making your operating system give
2303 OpenOCD access to debug adapters. Once that has been done, Tcl commands
2304 are used to select which one is used, and to configure how it is used.
2305
2306 @quotation Note
2307 Because OpenOCD started out with a focus purely on JTAG, you may find
2308 places where it wrongly presumes JTAG is the only transport protocol
2309 in use. Be aware that recent versions of OpenOCD are removing that
2310 limitation. JTAG remains more functional than most other transports.
2311 Other transports do not support boundary scan operations, or may be
2312 specific to a given chip vendor. Some might be usable only for
2313 programming flash memory, instead of also for debugging.
2314 @end quotation
2315
2316 Debug Adapters/Interfaces/Dongles are normally configured
2317 through commands in an interface configuration
2318 file which is sourced by your @file{openocd.cfg} file, or
2319 through a command line @option{-f interface/....cfg} option.
2320
2321 @example
2322 source [find interface/olimex-jtag-tiny.cfg]
2323 @end example
2324
2325 These commands tell
2326 OpenOCD what type of JTAG adapter you have, and how to talk to it.
2327 A few cases are so simple that you only need to say what driver to use:
2328
2329 @example
2330 # jlink interface
2331 interface jlink
2332 @end example
2333
2334 Most adapters need a bit more configuration than that.
2335
2336
2337 @section Interface Configuration
2338
2339 The interface command tells OpenOCD what type of debug adapter you are
2340 using. Depending on the type of adapter, you may need to use one or
2341 more additional commands to further identify or configure the adapter.
2342
2343 @deffn {Config Command} {interface} name
2344 Use the interface driver @var{name} to connect to the
2345 target.
2346 @end deffn
2347
2348 @deffn Command {interface_list}
2349 List the debug adapter drivers that have been built into
2350 the running copy of OpenOCD.
2351 @end deffn
2352 @deffn Command {interface transports} transport_name+
2353 Specifies the transports supported by this debug adapter.
2354 The adapter driver builds-in similar knowledge; use this only
2355 when external configuration (such as jumpering) changes what
2356 the hardware can support.
2357 @end deffn
2358
2359
2360
2361 @deffn Command {adapter_name}
2362 Returns the name of the debug adapter driver being used.
2363 @end deffn
2364
2365 @section Interface Drivers
2366
2367 Each of the interface drivers listed here must be explicitly
2368 enabled when OpenOCD is configured, in order to be made
2369 available at run time.
2370
2371 @deffn {Interface Driver} {amt_jtagaccel}
2372 Amontec Chameleon in its JTAG Accelerator configuration,
2373 connected to a PC's EPP mode parallel port.
2374 This defines some driver-specific commands:
2375
2376 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_port} number
2377 Specifies either the address of the I/O port (default: 0x378 for LPT1) or
2378 the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
2379 @end deffn
2380
2381 @deffn {Config Command} rtck [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
2382 Displays status of RTCK option.
2383 Optionally sets that option first.
2384 @end deffn
2385 @end deffn
2386
2387 @deffn {Interface Driver} {arm-jtag-ew}
2388 Olimex ARM-JTAG-EW USB adapter
2389 This has one driver-specific command:
2390
2391 @deffn Command {armjtagew_info}
2392 Logs some status
2393 @end deffn
2394 @end deffn
2395
2396 @deffn {Interface Driver} {at91rm9200}
2397 Supports bitbanged JTAG from the local system,
2398 presuming that system is an Atmel AT91rm9200
2399 and a specific set of GPIOs is used.
2400 @c command: at91rm9200_device NAME
2401 @c chooses among list of bit configs ... only one option
2402 @end deffn
2403
2404 @deffn {Interface Driver} {cmsis-dap}
2405 ARM CMSIS-DAP compliant based adapter.
2406
2407 @deffn {Config Command} {cmsis_dap_vid_pid} [vid pid]+
2408 The vendor ID and product ID of the CMSIS-DAP device. If not specified
2409 the driver will attempt to auto detect the CMSIS-DAP device.
2410 Currently, up to eight [@var{vid}, @var{pid}] pairs may be given, e.g.
2411 @example
2412 cmsis_dap_vid_pid 0xc251 0xf001 0x0d28 0x0204
2413 @end example
2414 @end deffn
2415
2416 @deffn {Config Command} {cmsis_dap_serial} [serial]
2417 Specifies the @var{serial} of the CMSIS-DAP device to use.
2418 If not specified, serial numbers are not considered.
2419 @end deffn
2420
2421 @deffn {Command} {cmsis-dap info}
2422 Display various device information, like hardware version, firmware version, current bus status.
2423 @end deffn
2424 @end deffn
2425
2426 @deffn {Interface Driver} {dummy}
2427 A dummy software-only driver for debugging.
2428 @end deffn
2429
2430 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ep93xx}
2431 Cirrus Logic EP93xx based single-board computer bit-banging (in development)
2432 @end deffn
2433
2434 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ftdi}
2435 This driver is for adapters using the MPSSE (Multi-Protocol Synchronous Serial
2436 Engine) mode built into many FTDI chips, such as the FT2232, FT4232 and FT232H.
2437
2438 The driver is using libusb-1.0 in asynchronous mode to talk to the FTDI device,
2439 bypassing intermediate libraries like libftdi or D2XX.
2440
2441 Support for new FTDI based adapters can be added completely through
2442 configuration files, without the need to patch and rebuild OpenOCD.
2443
2444 The driver uses a signal abstraction to enable Tcl configuration files to
2445 define outputs for one or several FTDI GPIO. These outputs can then be
2446 controlled using the @command{ftdi_set_signal} command. Special signal names
2447 are reserved for nTRST, nSRST and LED (for blink) so that they, if defined,
2448 will be used for their customary purpose. Inputs can be read using the
2449 @command{ftdi_get_signal} command.
2450
2451 To support SWD, a signal named SWD_EN must be defined. It is set to 1 when the
2452 SWD protocol is selected. When set, the adapter should route the SWDIO pin to
2453 the data input. An SWDIO_OE signal, if defined, will be set to 1 or 0 as
2454 required by the protocol, to tell the adapter to drive the data output onto
2455 the SWDIO pin or keep the SWDIO pin Hi-Z, respectively.
2456
2457 Depending on the type of buffer attached to the FTDI GPIO, the outputs have to
2458 be controlled differently. In order to support tristateable signals such as
2459 nSRST, both a data GPIO and an output-enable GPIO can be specified for each
2460 signal. The following output buffer configurations are supported:
2461
2462 @itemize @minus
2463 @item Push-pull with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted data line
2464 @item Open drain with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted output-enable
2465 @item Tristate with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted data line and another
2466 FTDI output as (non-)inverted output-enable
2467 @item Unbuffered, using the FTDI GPIO as a tristate output directly by
2468 switching data and direction as necessary
2469 @end itemize
2470
2471 These interfaces have several commands, used to configure the driver
2472 before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2473
2474 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_vid_pid} [vid pid]+
2475 The vendor ID and product ID of the adapter. Up to eight
2476 [@var{vid}, @var{pid}] pairs may be given, e.g.
2477 @example
2478 ftdi_vid_pid 0x0403 0xcff8 0x15ba 0x0003
2479 @end example
2480 @end deffn
2481
2482 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_device_desc} description
2483 Provides the USB device description (the @emph{iProduct string})
2484 of the adapter. If not specified, the device description is ignored
2485 during device selection.
2486 @end deffn
2487
2488 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_serial} serial-number
2489 Specifies the @var{serial-number} of the adapter to use,
2490 in case the vendor provides unique IDs and more than one adapter
2491 is connected to the host.
2492 If not specified, serial numbers are not considered.
2493 (Note that USB serial numbers can be arbitrary Unicode strings,
2494 and are not restricted to containing only decimal digits.)
2495 @end deffn
2496
2497 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_location} <bus>:<port>[,<port>]...
2498 Specifies the physical USB port of the adapter to use. The path
2499 roots at @var{bus} and walks down the physical ports, with each
2500 @var{port} option specifying a deeper level in the bus topology, the last
2501 @var{port} denoting where the target adapter is actually plugged.
2502 The USB bus topology can be queried with the command @emph{lsusb -t}.
2503
2504 This command is only available if your libusb1 is at least version 1.0.16.
2505 @end deffn
2506
2507 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_channel} channel
2508 Selects the channel of the FTDI device to use for MPSSE operations. Most
2509 adapters use the default, channel 0, but there are exceptions.
2510 @end deffn
2511
2512 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_layout_init} data direction
2513 Specifies the initial values of the FTDI GPIO data and direction registers.
2514 Each value is a 16-bit number corresponding to the concatenation of the high
2515 and low FTDI GPIO registers. The values should be selected based on the
2516 schematics of the adapter, such that all signals are set to safe levels with
2517 minimal impact on the target system. Avoid floating inputs, conflicting outputs
2518 and initially asserted reset signals.
2519 @end deffn
2520
2521 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_layout_signal} name [@option{-data}|@option{-ndata} data_mask] [@option{-input}|@option{-ninput} input_mask] [@option{-oe}|@option{-noe} oe_mask] [@option{-alias}|@option{-nalias} name]
2522 Creates a signal with the specified @var{name}, controlled by one or more FTDI
2523 GPIO pins via a range of possible buffer connections. The masks are FTDI GPIO
2524 register bitmasks to tell the driver the connection and type of the output
2525 buffer driving the respective signal. @var{data_mask} is the bitmask for the
2526 pin(s) connected to the data input of the output buffer. @option{-ndata} is
2527 used with inverting data inputs and @option{-data} with non-inverting inputs.
2528 The @option{-oe} (or @option{-noe}) option tells where the output-enable (or
2529 not-output-enable) input to the output buffer is connected. The options
2530 @option{-input} and @option{-ninput} specify the bitmask for pins to be read
2531 with the method @command{ftdi_get_signal}.
2532
2533 Both @var{data_mask} and @var{oe_mask} need not be specified. For example, a
2534 simple open-collector transistor driver would be specified with @option{-oe}
2535 only. In that case the signal can only be set to drive low or to Hi-Z and the
2536 driver will complain if the signal is set to drive high. Which means that if
2537 it's a reset signal, @command{reset_config} must be specified as
2538 @option{srst_open_drain}, not @option{srst_push_pull}.
2539
2540 A special case is provided when @option{-data} and @option{-oe} is set to the
2541 same bitmask. Then the FTDI pin is considered being connected straight to the
2542 target without any buffer. The FTDI pin is then switched between output and
2543 input as necessary to provide the full set of low, high and Hi-Z
2544 characteristics. In all other cases, the pins specified in a signal definition
2545 are always driven by the FTDI.
2546
2547 If @option{-alias} or @option{-nalias} is used, the signal is created
2548 identical (or with data inverted) to an already specified signal
2549 @var{name}.
2550 @end deffn
2551
2552 @deffn {Command} {ftdi_set_signal} name @option{0}|@option{1}|@option{z}
2553 Set a previously defined signal to the specified level.
2554 @itemize @minus
2555 @item @option{0}, drive low
2556 @item @option{1}, drive high
2557 @item @option{z}, set to high-impedance
2558 @end itemize
2559 @end deffn
2560
2561 @deffn {Command} {ftdi_get_signal} name
2562 Get the value of a previously defined signal.
2563 @end deffn
2564
2565 @deffn {Command} {ftdi_tdo_sample_edge} @option{rising}|@option{falling}
2566 Configure TCK edge at which the adapter samples the value of the TDO signal
2567
2568 Due to signal propagation delays, sampling TDO on rising TCK can become quite
2569 peculiar at high JTAG clock speeds. However, FTDI chips offer a possibility to sample
2570 TDO on falling edge of TCK. With some board/adapter configurations, this may increase
2571 stability at higher JTAG clocks.
2572 @itemize @minus
2573 @item @option{rising}, sample TDO on rising edge of TCK - this is the default
2574 @item @option{falling}, sample TDO on falling edge of TCK
2575 @end itemize
2576 @end deffn
2577
2578 For example adapter definitions, see the configuration files shipped in the
2579 @file{interface/ftdi} directory.
2580
2581 @end deffn
2582
2583 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ft232r}
2584 This driver is implementing synchronous bitbang mode of an FTDI FT232R,
2585 FT230X, FT231X and similar USB UART bridge ICs by reusing RS232 signals as GPIO.
2586 It currently doesn't support using CBUS pins as GPIO.
2587
2588 List of connections (default physical pin numbers for FT232R in 28-pin SSOP package):
2589 @itemize @minus
2590 @item RXD(5) - TDI
2591 @item TXD(1) - TCK
2592 @item RTS(3) - TDO
2593 @item CTS(11) - TMS
2594 @item DTR(2) - TRST
2595 @item DCD(10) - SRST
2596 @end itemize
2597
2598 User can change default pinout by supplying configuration
2599 commands with GPIO numbers or RS232 signal names.
2600 GPIO numbers correspond to bit numbers in FTDI GPIO register.
2601 They differ from physical pin numbers.
2602 For details see actual FTDI chip datasheets.
2603 Every JTAG line must be configured to unique GPIO number
2604 different than any other JTAG line, even those lines
2605 that are sometimes not used like TRST or SRST.
2606
2607 FT232R
2608 @itemize @minus
2609 @item bit 7 - RI
2610 @item bit 6 - DCD
2611 @item bit 5 - DSR
2612 @item bit 4 - DTR
2613 @item bit 3 - CTS
2614 @item bit 2 - RTS
2615 @item bit 1 - RXD
2616 @item bit 0 - TXD
2617 @end itemize
2618
2619 These interfaces have several commands, used to configure the driver
2620 before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2621
2622 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_vid_pid} @var{vid} @var{pid}
2623 The vendor ID and product ID of the adapter. If not specified, default
2624 0x0403:0x6001 is used.
2625 @end deffn
2626
2627 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_serial_desc} @var{serial}
2628 Specifies the @var{serial} of the adapter to use, in case the
2629 vendor provides unique IDs and more than one adapter is connected to
2630 the host. If not specified, serial numbers are not considered.
2631 @end deffn
2632
2633 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_jtag_nums} @var{tck} @var{tms} @var{tdi} @var{tdo}
2634 Set four JTAG GPIO numbers at once.
2635 If not specified, default 0 3 1 2 or TXD CTS RXD RTS is used.
2636 @end deffn
2637
2638 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_tck_num} @var{tck}
2639 Set TCK GPIO number. If not specified, default 0 or TXD is used.
2640 @end deffn
2641
2642 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_tms_num} @var{tms}
2643 Set TMS GPIO number. If not specified, default 3 or CTS is used.
2644 @end deffn
2645
2646 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_tdi_num} @var{tdi}
2647 Set TDI GPIO number. If not specified, default 1 or RXD is used.
2648 @end deffn
2649
2650 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_tdo_num} @var{tdo}
2651 Set TDO GPIO number. If not specified, default 2 or RTS is used.
2652 @end deffn
2653
2654 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_trst_num} @var{trst}
2655 Set TRST GPIO number. If not specified, default 4 or DTR is used.
2656 @end deffn
2657
2658 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_srst_num} @var{srst}
2659 Set SRST GPIO number. If not specified, default 6 or DCD is used.
2660 @end deffn
2661
2662 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_restore_serial} @var{word}
2663 Restore serial port after JTAG. This USB bitmode control word
2664 (16-bit) will be sent before quit. Lower byte should
2665 set GPIO direction register to a "sane" state:
2666 0x15 for TXD RTS DTR as outputs (1), others as inputs (0). Higher
2667 byte is usually 0 to disable bitbang mode.
2668 When kernel driver reattaches, serial port should continue to work.
2669 Value 0xFFFF disables sending control word and serial port,
2670 then kernel driver will not reattach.
2671 If not specified, default 0xFFFF is used.
2672 @end deffn
2673
2674 @end deffn
2675
2676 @deffn {Interface Driver} {remote_bitbang}
2677 Drive JTAG from a remote process. This sets up a UNIX or TCP socket connection
2678 with a remote process and sends ASCII encoded bitbang requests to that process
2679 instead of directly driving JTAG.
2680
2681 The remote_bitbang driver is useful for debugging software running on
2682 processors which are being simulated.
2683
2684 @deffn {Config Command} {remote_bitbang_port} number
2685 Specifies the TCP port of the remote process to connect to or 0 to use UNIX
2686 sockets instead of TCP.
2687 @end deffn
2688
2689 @deffn {Config Command} {remote_bitbang_host} hostname
2690 Specifies the hostname of the remote process to connect to using TCP, or the
2691 name of the UNIX socket to use if remote_bitbang_port is 0.
2692 @end deffn
2693
2694 For example, to connect remotely via TCP to the host foobar you might have
2695 something like:
2696
2697 @example
2698 interface remote_bitbang
2699 remote_bitbang_port 3335
2700 remote_bitbang_host foobar
2701 @end example
2702
2703 To connect to another process running locally via UNIX sockets with socket
2704 named mysocket:
2705
2706 @example
2707 interface remote_bitbang
2708 remote_bitbang_port 0
2709 remote_bitbang_host mysocket
2710 @end example
2711 @end deffn
2712
2713 @deffn {Interface Driver} {usb_blaster}
2714 USB JTAG/USB-Blaster compatibles over one of the userspace libraries
2715 for FTDI chips. These interfaces have several commands, used to
2716 configure the driver before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2717
2718 @deffn {Config Command} {usb_blaster_device_desc} description
2719 Provides the USB device description (the @emph{iProduct string})
2720 of the FTDI FT245 device. If not
2721 specified, the FTDI default value is used. This setting is only valid
2722 if compiled with FTD2XX support.
2723 @end deffn
2724
2725 @deffn {Config Command} {usb_blaster_vid_pid} vid pid
2726 The vendor ID and product ID of the FTDI FT245 device. If not specified,
2727 default values are used.
2728 Currently, only one @var{vid}, @var{pid} pair may be given, e.g. for
2729 Altera USB-Blaster (default):
2730 @example
2731 usb_blaster_vid_pid 0x09FB 0x6001
2732 @end example
2733 The following VID/PID is for Kolja Waschk's USB JTAG:
2734 @example
2735 usb_blaster_vid_pid 0x16C0 0x06AD
2736 @end example
2737 @end deffn
2738
2739 @deffn {Command} {usb_blaster_pin} (@option{pin6}|@option{pin8}) (@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{s}|@option{t})
2740 Sets the state or function of the unused GPIO pins on USB-Blasters
2741 (pins 6 and 8 on the female JTAG header). These pins can be used as
2742 SRST and/or TRST provided the appropriate connections are made on the
2743 target board.
2744
2745 For example, to use pin 6 as SRST:
2746 @example
2747 usb_blaster_pin pin6 s
2748 reset_config srst_only
2749 @end example
2750 @end deffn
2751
2752 @deffn {Command} {usb_blaster_lowlevel_driver} (@option{ftdi}|@option{ublast2})
2753 Chooses the low level access method for the adapter. If not specified,
2754 @option{ftdi} is selected unless it wasn't enabled during the
2755 configure stage. USB-Blaster II needs @option{ublast2}.
2756 @end deffn
2757
2758 @deffn {Command} {usb_blaster_firmware} @var{path}
2759 This command specifies @var{path} to access USB-Blaster II firmware
2760 image. To be used with USB-Blaster II only.
2761 @end deffn
2762
2763 @end deffn
2764
2765 @deffn {Interface Driver} {gw16012}
2766 Gateworks GW16012 JTAG programmer.
2767 This has one driver-specific command:
2768
2769 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_port} [port_number]
2770 Display either the address of the I/O port
2771 (default: 0x378 for LPT1) or the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
2772 If a parameter is provided, first switch to use that port.
2773 This is a write-once setting.
2774 @end deffn
2775 @end deffn
2776
2777 @deffn {Interface Driver} {jlink}
2778 SEGGER J-Link family of USB adapters. It currently supports JTAG and SWD
2779 transports.
2780
2781 @quotation Compatibility Note
2782 SEGGER released many firmware versions for the many hardware versions they
2783 produced. OpenOCD was extensively tested and intended to run on all of them,
2784 but some combinations were reported as incompatible. As a general
2785 recommendation, it is advisable to use the latest firmware version
2786 available for each hardware version. However the current V8 is a moving
2787 target, and SEGGER firmware versions released after the OpenOCD was
2788 released may not be compatible. In such cases it is recommended to
2789 revert to the last known functional version. For 0.5.0, this is from
2790 "Feb 8 2012 14:30:39", packed with 4.42c. For 0.6.0, the last known
2791 version is from "May 3 2012 18:36:22", packed with 4.46f.
2792 @end quotation
2793
2794 @deffn {Command} {jlink hwstatus}
2795 Display various hardware related information, for example target voltage and pin
2796 states.
2797 @end deffn
2798 @deffn {Command} {jlink freemem}
2799 Display free device internal memory.
2800 @end deffn
2801 @deffn {Command} {jlink jtag} [@option{2}|@option{3}]
2802 Set the JTAG command version to be used. Without argument, show the actual JTAG
2803 command version.
2804 @end deffn
2805 @deffn {Command} {jlink config}
2806 Display the device configuration.
2807 @end deffn
2808 @deffn {Command} {jlink config targetpower} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
2809 Set the target power state on JTAG-pin 19. Without argument, show the target
2810 power state.
2811 @end deffn
2812 @deffn {Command} {jlink config mac} [@option{ff:ff:ff:ff:ff:ff}]
2813 Set the MAC address of the device. Without argument, show the MAC address.
2814 @end deffn
2815 @deffn {Command} {jlink config ip} [@option{A.B.C.D}(@option{/E}|@option{F.G.H.I})]
2816 Set the IP configuration of the device, where A.B.C.D is the IP address, E the
2817 bit of the subnet mask and F.G.H.I the subnet mask. Without arguments, show the
2818 IP configuration.
2819 @end deffn
2820 @deffn {Command} {jlink config usb} [@option{0} to @option{3}]
2821 Set the USB address of the device. This will also change the USB Product ID
2822 (PID) of the device. Without argument, show the USB address.
2823 @end deffn
2824 @deffn {Command} {jlink config reset}
2825 Reset the current configuration.
2826 @end deffn
2827 @deffn {Command} {jlink config write}
2828 Write the current configuration to the internal persistent storage.
2829 @end deffn
2830 @deffn {Command} {jlink emucom write <channel> <data>}
2831 Write data to an EMUCOM channel. The data needs to be encoded as hexadecimal
2832 pairs.
2833
2834 The following example shows how to write the three bytes 0xaa, 0x0b and 0x23 to
2835 the EMUCOM channel 0x10:
2836 @example
2837 > jlink emucom write 0x10 aa0b23
2838 @end example
2839 @end deffn
2840 @deffn {Command} {jlink emucom read <channel> <length>}
2841 Read data from an EMUCOM channel. The read data is encoded as hexadecimal
2842 pairs.
2843
2844 The following example shows how to read 4 bytes from the EMUCOM channel 0x0:
2845 @example
2846 > jlink emucom read 0x0 4
2847 77a90000
2848 @end example
2849 @end deffn
2850 @deffn {Config} {jlink usb} <@option{0} to @option{3}>
2851 Set the USB address of the interface, in case more than one adapter is connected
2852 to the host. If not specified, USB addresses are not considered. Device
2853 selection via USB address is deprecated and the serial number should be used
2854 instead.
2855
2856 As a configuration command, it can be used only before 'init'.
2857 @end deffn
2858 @deffn {Config} {jlink serial} <serial number>
2859 Set the serial number of the interface, in case more than one adapter is
2860 connected to the host. If not specified, serial numbers are not considered.
2861
2862 As a configuration command, it can be used only before 'init'.
2863 @end deffn
2864 @end deffn
2865
2866 @deffn {Interface Driver} {kitprog}
2867 This driver is for Cypress Semiconductor's KitProg adapters. The KitProg is an
2868 SWD-only adapter that is designed to be used with Cypress's PSoC and PRoC device
2869 families, but it is possible to use it with some other devices. If you are using
2870 this adapter with a PSoC or a PRoC, you may need to add
2871 @command{kitprog_init_acquire_psoc} or @command{kitprog acquire_psoc} to your
2872 configuration script.
2873
2874 Note that this driver is for the proprietary KitProg protocol, not the CMSIS-DAP
2875 mode introduced in firmware 2.14. If the KitProg is in CMSIS-DAP mode, it cannot
2876 be used with this driver, and must either be used with the cmsis-dap driver or
2877 switched back to KitProg mode. See the Cypress KitProg User Guide for
2878 instructions on how to switch KitProg modes.
2879
2880 Known limitations:
2881 @itemize @bullet
2882 @item The frequency of SWCLK cannot be configured, and varies between 1.6 MHz
2883 and 2.7 MHz.
2884 @item For firmware versions below 2.14, "JTAG to SWD" sequences are replaced by
2885 "SWD line reset" in the driver. This is for two reasons. First, the KitProg does
2886 not support sending arbitrary SWD sequences, and only firmware 2.14 and later
2887 implement both "JTAG to SWD" and "SWD line reset" in firmware. Earlier firmware
2888 versions only implement "SWD line reset". Second, due to a firmware quirk, an
2889 SWD sequence must be sent after every target reset in order to re-establish
2890 communications with the target.
2891 @item Due in part to the limitation above, KitProg devices with firmware below
2892 version 2.14 will need to use @command{kitprog_init_acquire_psoc} in order to
2893 communicate with PSoC 5LP devices. This is because, assuming debug is not
2894 disabled on the PSoC, the PSoC 5LP needs its JTAG interface switched to SWD
2895 mode before communication can begin, but prior to firmware 2.14, "JTAG to SWD"
2896 could only be sent with an acquisition sequence.
2897 @end itemize
2898
2899 @deffn {Config Command} {kitprog_init_acquire_psoc}
2900 Indicate that a PSoC acquisition sequence needs to be run during adapter init.
2901 Please be aware that the acquisition sequence hard-resets the target.
2902 @end deffn
2903
2904 @deffn {Config Command} {kitprog_serial} serial
2905 Select a KitProg device by its @var{serial}. If left unspecified, the first
2906 device detected by OpenOCD will be used.
2907 @end deffn
2908
2909 @deffn {Command} {kitprog acquire_psoc}
2910 Run a PSoC acquisition sequence immediately. Typically, this should not be used
2911 outside of the target-specific configuration scripts since it hard-resets the
2912 target as a side-effect.
2913 This is necessary for "reset halt" on some PSoC 4 series devices.
2914 @end deffn
2915
2916 @deffn {Command} {kitprog info}
2917 Display various adapter information, such as the hardware version, firmware
2918 version, and target voltage.
2919 @end deffn
2920 @end deffn
2921
2922 @deffn {Interface Driver} {parport}
2923 Supports PC parallel port bit-banging cables:
2924 Wigglers, PLD download cable, and more.
2925 These interfaces have several commands, used to configure the driver
2926 before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2927
2928 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_cable} name
2929 Set the layout of the parallel port cable used to connect to the target.
2930 This is a write-once setting.
2931 Currently valid cable @var{name} values include:
2932
2933 @itemize @minus
2934 @item @b{altium} Altium Universal JTAG cable.
2935 @item @b{arm-jtag} Same as original wiggler except SRST and
2936 TRST connections reversed and TRST is also inverted.
2937 @item @b{chameleon} The Amontec Chameleon's CPLD when operated
2938 in configuration mode. This is only used to
2939 program the Chameleon itself, not a connected target.
2940 @item @b{dlc5} The Xilinx Parallel cable III.
2941 @item @b{flashlink} The ST Parallel cable.
2942 @item @b{lattice} Lattice ispDOWNLOAD Cable
2943 @item @b{old_amt_wiggler} The Wiggler configuration that comes with
2944 some versions of
2945 Amontec's Chameleon Programmer. The new version available from
2946 the website uses the original Wiggler layout ('@var{wiggler}')
2947 @item @b{triton} The parallel port adapter found on the
2948 ``Karo Triton 1 Development Board''.
2949 This is also the layout used by the HollyGates design
2950 (see @uref{http://www.lartmaker.nl/projects/jtag/}).
2951 @item @b{wiggler} The original Wiggler layout, also supported by
2952 several clones, such as the Olimex ARM-JTAG
2953 @item @b{wiggler2} Same as original wiggler except an led is fitted on D5.
2954 @item @b{wiggler_ntrst_inverted} Same as original wiggler except TRST is inverted.
2955 @end itemize
2956 @end deffn
2957
2958 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_port} [port_number]
2959 Display either the address of the I/O port
2960 (default: 0x378 for LPT1) or the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
2961 If a parameter is provided, first switch to use that port.
2962 This is a write-once setting.
2963
2964 When using PPDEV to access the parallel port, use the number of the parallel port:
2965 @option{parport_port 0} (the default). If @option{parport_port 0x378} is specified
2966 you may encounter a problem.
2967 @end deffn
2968
2969 @deffn Command {parport_toggling_time} [nanoseconds]
2970 Displays how many nanoseconds the hardware needs to toggle TCK;
2971 the parport driver uses this value to obey the
2972 @command{adapter_khz} configuration.
2973 When the optional @var{nanoseconds} parameter is given,
2974 that setting is changed before displaying the current value.
2975
2976 The default setting should work reasonably well on commodity PC hardware.
2977 However, you may want to calibrate for your specific hardware.
2978 @quotation Tip
2979 To measure the toggling time with a logic analyzer or a digital storage
2980 oscilloscope, follow the procedure below:
2981 @example
2982 > parport_toggling_time 1000
2983 > adapter_khz 500
2984 @end example
2985 This sets the maximum JTAG clock speed of the hardware, but
2986 the actual speed probably deviates from the requested 500 kHz.
2987 Now, measure the time between the two closest spaced TCK transitions.
2988 You can use @command{runtest 1000} or something similar to generate a
2989 large set of samples.
2990 Update the setting to match your measurement:
2991 @example
2992 > parport_toggling_time <measured nanoseconds>
2993 @end example
2994 Now the clock speed will be a better match for @command{adapter_khz rate}
2995 commands given in OpenOCD scripts and event handlers.
2996
2997 You can do something similar with many digital multimeters, but note
2998 that you'll probably need to run the clock continuously for several
2999 seconds before it decides what clock rate to show. Adjust the
3000 toggling time up or down until the measured clock rate is a good
3001 match for the adapter_khz rate you specified; be conservative.
3002 @end quotation
3003 @end deffn
3004
3005 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_write_on_exit} (@option{on}|@option{off})
3006 This will configure the parallel driver to write a known
3007 cable-specific value to the parallel interface on exiting OpenOCD.
3008 @end deffn
3009
3010 For example, the interface configuration file for a
3011 classic ``Wiggler'' cable on LPT2 might look something like this:
3012
3013 @example
3014 interface parport
3015 parport_port 0x278
3016 parport_cable wiggler
3017 @end example
3018 @end deffn
3019
3020 @deffn {Interface Driver} {presto}
3021 ASIX PRESTO USB JTAG programmer.
3022 @deffn {Config Command} {presto_serial} serial_string
3023 Configures the USB serial number of the Presto device to use.
3024 @end deffn
3025 @end deffn
3026
3027 @deffn {Interface Driver} {rlink}
3028 Raisonance RLink USB adapter
3029 @end deffn
3030
3031 @deffn {Interface Driver} {usbprog}
3032 usbprog is a freely programmable USB adapter.
3033 @end deffn
3034
3035 @deffn {Interface Driver} {vsllink}
3036 vsllink is part of Versaloon which is a versatile USB programmer.
3037
3038 @quotation Note
3039 This defines quite a few driver-specific commands,
3040 which are not currently documented here.
3041 @end quotation
3042 @end deffn
3043
3044 @anchor{hla_interface}
3045 @deffn {Interface Driver} {hla}
3046 This is a driver that supports multiple High Level Adapters.
3047 This type of adapter does not expose some of the lower level api's
3048 that OpenOCD would normally use to access the target.
3049
3050 Currently supported adapters include the STMicroelectronics ST-LINK and TI ICDI.
3051 ST-LINK firmware version >= V2.J21.S4 recommended due to issues with earlier
3052 versions of firmware where serial number is reset after first use. Suggest
3053 using ST firmware update utility to upgrade ST-LINK firmware even if current
3054 version reported is V2.J21.S4.
3055
3056 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_device_desc} description
3057 Currently Not Supported.
3058 @end deffn
3059
3060 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_serial} serial
3061 Specifies the serial number of the adapter.
3062 @end deffn
3063
3064 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_layout} (@option{stlink}|@option{icdi})
3065 Specifies the adapter layout to use.
3066 @end deffn
3067
3068 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_vid_pid} [vid pid]+
3069 Pairs of vendor IDs and product IDs of the device.
3070 @end deffn
3071
3072 @deffn {Command} {hla_command} command
3073 Execute a custom adapter-specific command. The @var{command} string is
3074 passed as is to the underlying adapter layout handler.
3075 @end deffn
3076 @end deffn
3077
3078 @deffn {Interface Driver} {opendous}
3079 opendous-jtag is a freely programmable USB adapter.
3080 @end deffn
3081
3082 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ulink}
3083 This is the Keil ULINK v1 JTAG debugger.
3084 @end deffn
3085
3086 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ZY1000}
3087 This is the Zylin ZY1000 JTAG debugger.
3088 @end deffn
3089
3090 @quotation Note
3091 This defines some driver-specific commands,
3092 which are not currently documented here.
3093 @end quotation
3094
3095 @deffn Command power [@option{on}|@option{off}]
3096 Turn power switch to target on/off.
3097 No arguments: print status.
3098 @end deffn
3099
3100 @deffn {Interface Driver} {bcm2835gpio}
3101 This SoC is present in Raspberry Pi which is a cheap single-board computer
3102 exposing some GPIOs on its expansion header.
3103
3104 The driver accesses memory-mapped GPIO peripheral registers directly
3105 for maximum performance, but the only possible race condition is for
3106 the pins' modes/muxing (which is highly unlikely), so it should be
3107 able to coexist nicely with both sysfs bitbanging and various
3108 peripherals' kernel drivers. The driver restores the previous
3109 configuration on exit.
3110
3111 See @file{interface/raspberrypi-native.cfg} for a sample config and
3112 pinout.
3113
3114 @end deffn
3115
3116 @deffn {Interface Driver} {imx_gpio}
3117 i.MX SoC is present in many community boards. Wandboard is an example
3118 of the one which is most popular.
3119
3120 This driver is mostly the same as bcm2835gpio.
3121
3122 See @file{interface/imx-native.cfg} for a sample config and
3123 pinout.
3124
3125 @end deffn
3126
3127
3128 @deffn {Interface Driver} {openjtag}
3129 OpenJTAG compatible USB adapter.
3130 This defines some driver-specific commands:
3131
3132 @deffn {Config Command} {openjtag_variant} variant
3133 Specifies the variant of the OpenJTAG adapter (see @uref{http://www.openjtag.org/}).
3134 Currently valid @var{variant} values include:
3135
3136 @itemize @minus
3137 @item @b{standard} Standard variant (default).
3138 @item @b{cy7c65215} Cypress CY7C65215 Dual Channel USB-Serial Bridge Controller
3139 (see @uref{http://www.cypress.com/?rID=82870}).
3140 @end itemize
3141 @end deffn
3142
3143 @deffn {Config Command} {openjtag_device_desc} string
3144 The USB device description string of the adapter.
3145 This value is only used with the standard variant.
3146 @end deffn
3147 @end deffn
3148
3149 @section Transport Configuration
3150 @cindex Transport
3151 As noted earlier, depending on the version of OpenOCD you use,
3152 and the debug adapter you are using,
3153 several transports may be available to
3154 communicate with debug targets (or perhaps to program flash memory).
3155 @deffn Command {transport list}
3156 displays the names of the transports supported by this
3157 version of OpenOCD.
3158 @end deffn
3159
3160 @deffn Command {transport select} @option{transport_name}
3161 Select which of the supported transports to use in this OpenOCD session.
3162
3163 When invoked with @option{transport_name}, attempts to select the named
3164 transport. The transport must be supported by the debug adapter
3165 hardware and by the version of OpenOCD you are using (including the
3166 adapter's driver).
3167
3168 If no transport has been selected and no @option{transport_name} is
3169 provided, @command{transport select} auto-selects the first transport
3170 supported by the debug adapter.
3171
3172 @command{transport select} always returns the name of the session's selected
3173 transport, if any.
3174 @end deffn
3175
3176 @subsection JTAG Transport
3177 @cindex JTAG
3178 JTAG is the original transport supported by OpenOCD, and most
3179 of the OpenOCD commands support it.
3180 JTAG transports expose a chain of one or more Test Access Points (TAPs),
3181 each of which must be explicitly declared.
3182 JTAG supports both debugging and boundary scan testing.
3183 Flash programming support is built on top of debug support.
3184
3185 JTAG transport is selected with the command @command{transport select
3186 jtag}. Unless your adapter uses @ref{hla_interface,the hla interface
3187 driver}, in which case the command is @command{transport select
3188 hla_jtag}.
3189
3190 @subsection SWD Transport
3191 @cindex SWD
3192 @cindex Serial Wire Debug
3193 SWD (Serial Wire Debug) is an ARM-specific transport which exposes one
3194 Debug Access Point (DAP, which must be explicitly declared.
3195 (SWD uses fewer signal wires than JTAG.)
3196 SWD is debug-oriented, and does not support boundary scan testing.
3197 Flash programming support is built on top of debug support.
3198 (Some processors support both JTAG and SWD.)
3199
3200 SWD transport is selected with the command @command{transport select
3201 swd}. Unless your adapter uses @ref{hla_interface,the hla interface
3202 driver}, in which case the command is @command{transport select
3203 hla_swd}.
3204
3205 @deffn Command {swd newdap} ...
3206 Declares a single DAP which uses SWD transport.
3207 Parameters are currently the same as "jtag newtap" but this is
3208 expected to change.
3209 @end deffn
3210 @deffn Command {swd wcr trn prescale}
3211 Updates TRN (turnaround delay) and prescaling.fields of the
3212 Wire Control Register (WCR).
3213 No parameters: displays current settings.
3214 @end deffn
3215
3216 @subsection SPI Transport
3217 @cindex SPI
3218 @cindex Serial Peripheral Interface
3219 The Serial Peripheral Interface (SPI) is a general purpose transport
3220 which uses four wire signaling. Some processors use it as part of a
3221 solution for flash programming.
3222
3223 @anchor{jtagspeed}
3224 @section JTAG Speed
3225 JTAG clock setup is part of system setup.
3226 It @emph{does not belong with interface setup} since any interface
3227 only knows a few of the constraints for the JTAG clock speed.
3228 Sometimes the JTAG speed is
3229 changed during the target initialization process: (1) slow at
3230 reset, (2) program the CPU clocks, (3) run fast.
3231 Both the "slow" and "fast" clock rates are functions of the
3232 oscillators used, the chip, the board design, and sometimes
3233 power management software that may be active.
3234
3235 The speed used during reset, and the scan chain verification which
3236 follows reset, can be adjusted using a @code{reset-start}
3237 target event handler.
3238 It can then be reconfigured to a faster speed by a
3239 @code{reset-init} target event handler after it reprograms those
3240 CPU clocks, or manually (if something else, such as a boot loader,
3241 sets up those clocks).
3242 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
3243 When the initial low JTAG speed is a chip characteristic, perhaps
3244 because of a required oscillator speed, provide such a handler
3245 in the target config file.
3246 When that speed is a function of a board-specific characteristic
3247 such as which speed oscillator is used, it belongs in the board
3248 config file instead.
3249 In both cases it's safest to also set the initial JTAG clock rate
3250 to that same slow speed, so that OpenOCD never starts up using a
3251 clock speed that's faster than the scan chain can support.
3252
3253 @example
3254 jtag_rclk 3000
3255 $_TARGET.cpu configure -event reset-start @{ jtag_rclk 3000 @}
3256 @end example
3257
3258 If your system supports adaptive clocking (RTCK), configuring
3259 JTAG to use that is probably the most robust approach.
3260 However, it introduces delays to synchronize clocks; so it
3261 may not be the fastest solution.
3262
3263 @b{NOTE:} Script writers should consider using @command{jtag_rclk}
3264 instead of @command{adapter_khz}, but only for (ARM) cores and boards
3265 which support adaptive clocking.
3266
3267 @deffn {Command} adapter_khz max_speed_kHz
3268 A non-zero speed is in KHZ. Hence: 3000 is 3mhz.
3269 JTAG interfaces usually support a limited number of
3270 speeds. The speed actually used won't be faster
3271 than the speed specified.
3272
3273 Chip data sheets generally include a top JTAG clock rate.
3274 The actual rate is often a function of a CPU core clock,
3275 and is normally less than that peak rate.
3276 For example, most ARM cores accept at most one sixth of the CPU clock.
3277
3278 Speed 0 (khz) selects RTCK method.
3279 @xref{faqrtck,,FAQ RTCK}.
3280 If your system uses RTCK, you won't need to change the
3281 JTAG clocking after setup.
3282 Not all interfaces, boards, or targets support ``rtck''.
3283 If the interface device can not
3284 support it, an error is returned when you try to use RTCK.
3285 @end deffn
3286
3287 @defun jtag_rclk fallback_speed_kHz
3288 @cindex adaptive clocking
3289 @cindex RTCK
3290 This Tcl proc (defined in @file{startup.tcl}) attempts to enable RTCK/RCLK.
3291 If that fails (maybe the interface, board, or target doesn't
3292 support it), falls back to the specified frequency.
3293 @example
3294 # Fall back to 3mhz if RTCK is not supported
3295 jtag_rclk 3000
3296 @end example
3297 @end defun
3298
3299 @node Reset Configuration
3300 @chapter Reset Configuration
3301 @cindex Reset Configuration
3302
3303 Every system configuration may require a different reset
3304 configuration. This can also be quite confusing.
3305 Resets also interact with @var{reset-init} event handlers,
3306 which do things like setting up clocks and DRAM, and
3307 JTAG clock rates. (@xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.)
3308 They can also interact with JTAG routers.
3309 Please see the various board files for examples.
3310
3311 @quotation Note
3312 To maintainers and integrators:
3313 Reset configuration touches several things at once.
3314 Normally the board configuration file
3315 should define it and assume that the JTAG adapter supports
3316 everything that's wired up to the board's JTAG connector.
3317
3318 However, the target configuration file could also make note
3319 of something the silicon vendor has done inside the chip,
3320 which will be true for most (or all) boards using that chip.
3321 And when the JTAG adapter doesn't support everything, the
3322 user configuration file will need to override parts of
3323 the reset configuration provided by other files.
3324 @end quotation
3325
3326 @section Types of Reset
3327
3328 There are many kinds of reset possible through JTAG, but
3329 they may not all work with a given board and adapter.
3330 That's part of why reset configuration can be error prone.
3331
3332 @itemize @bullet
3333 @item
3334 @emph{System Reset} ... the @emph{SRST} hardware signal
3335 resets all chips connected to the JTAG adapter, such as processors,
3336 power management chips, and I/O controllers. Normally resets triggered
3337 with this signal behave exactly like pressing a RESET button.
3338 @item
3339 @emph{JTAG TAP Reset} ... the @emph{TRST} hardware signal resets
3340 just the TAP controllers connected to the JTAG adapter.
3341 Such resets should not be visible to the rest of the system; resetting a
3342 device's TAP controller just puts that controller into a known state.
3343 @item
3344 @emph{Emulation Reset} ... many devices can be reset through JTAG
3345 commands. These resets are often distinguishable from system
3346 resets, either explicitly (a "reset reason" register says so)
3347 or implicitly (not all parts of the chip get reset).
3348 @item
3349 @emph{Other Resets} ... system-on-chip devices often support
3350 several other types of reset.
3351 You may need to arrange that a watchdog timer stops
3352 while debugging, preventing a watchdog reset.
3353 There may be individual module resets.
3354 @end itemize
3355
3356 In the best case, OpenOCD can hold SRST, then reset
3357 the TAPs via TRST and send commands through JTAG to halt the
3358 CPU at the reset vector before the 1st instruction is executed.
3359 Then when it finally releases the SRST signal, the system is
3360 halted under debugger control before any code has executed.
3361 This is the behavior required to support the @command{reset halt}
3362 and @command{reset init} commands; after @command{reset init} a
3363 board-specific script might do things like setting up DRAM.
3364 (@xref{resetcommand,,Reset Command}.)
3365
3366 @anchor{srstandtrstissues}
3367 @section SRST and TRST Issues
3368
3369 Because SRST and TRST are hardware signals, they can have a
3370 variety of system-specific constraints. Some of the most
3371 common issues are:
3372
3373 @itemize @bullet
3374
3375 @item @emph{Signal not available} ... Some boards don't wire
3376 SRST or TRST to the JTAG connector. Some JTAG adapters don't
3377 support such signals even if they are wired up.
3378 Use the @command{reset_config} @var{signals} options to say
3379 when either of those signals is not connected.
3380 When SRST is not available, your code might not be able to rely
3381 on controllers having been fully reset during code startup.
3382 Missing TRST is not a problem, since JTAG-level resets can
3383 be triggered using with TMS signaling.
3384
3385 @item @emph{Signals shorted} ... Sometimes a chip, board, or
3386 adapter will connect SRST to TRST, instead of keeping them separate.
3387 Use the @command{reset_config} @var{combination} options to say
3388 when those signals aren't properly independent.
3389
3390 @item @emph{Timing} ... Reset circuitry like a resistor/capacitor
3391 delay circuit, reset supervisor, or on-chip features can extend
3392 the effect of a JTAG adapter's reset for some time after the adapter
3393 stops issuing the reset. For example, there may be chip or board
3394 requirements that all reset pulses last for at least a
3395 certain amount of time; and reset buttons commonly have
3396 hardware debouncing.
3397 Use the @command{adapter_nsrst_delay} and @command{jtag_ntrst_delay}
3398 commands to say when extra delays are needed.
3399
3400 @item @emph{Drive type} ... Reset lines often have a pullup
3401 resistor, letting the JTAG interface treat them as open-drain
3402 signals. But that's not a requirement, so the adapter may need
3403 to use push/pull output drivers.
3404 Also, with weak pullups it may be advisable to drive
3405 signals to both levels (push/pull) to minimize rise times.
3406 Use the @command{reset_config} @var{trst_type} and
3407 @var{srst_type} parameters to say how to drive reset signals.
3408
3409 @item @emph{Special initialization} ... Targets sometimes need
3410 special JTAG initialization sequences to handle chip-specific
3411 issues (not limited to errata).
3412 For example, certain JTAG commands might need to be issued while
3413 the system as a whole is in a reset state (SRST active)
3414 but the JTAG scan chain is usable (TRST inactive).
3415 Many systems treat combined assertion of SRST and TRST as a
3416 trigger for a harder reset than SRST alone.
3417 Such custom reset handling is discussed later in this chapter.
3418 @end itemize
3419
3420 There can also be other issues.
3421 Some devices don't fully conform to the JTAG specifications.
3422 Trivial system-specific differences are common, such as
3423 SRST and TRST using slightly different names.
3424 There are also vendors who distribute key JTAG documentation for
3425 their chips only to developers who have signed a Non-Disclosure
3426 Agreement (NDA).
3427
3428 Sometimes there are chip-specific extensions like a requirement to use
3429 the normally-optional TRST signal (precluding use of JTAG adapters which
3430 don't pass TRST through), or needing extra steps to complete a TAP reset.
3431
3432 In short, SRST and especially TRST handling may be very finicky,
3433 needing to cope with both architecture and board specific constraints.
3434
3435 @section Commands for Handling Resets
3436
3437 @deffn {Command} adapter_nsrst_assert_width milliseconds
3438 Minimum amount of time (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait
3439 after asserting nSRST (active-low system reset) before
3440 allowing it to be deasserted.
3441 @end deffn
3442
3443 @deffn {Command} adapter_nsrst_delay milliseconds
3444 How long (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait after deasserting
3445 nSRST (active-low system reset) before starting new JTAG operations.
3446 When a board has a reset button connected to SRST line it will
3447 probably have hardware debouncing, implying you should use this.
3448 @end deffn
3449
3450 @deffn {Command} jtag_ntrst_assert_width milliseconds
3451 Minimum amount of time (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait
3452 after asserting nTRST (active-low JTAG TAP reset) before
3453 allowing it to be deasserted.
3454 @end deffn
3455
3456 @deffn {Command} jtag_ntrst_delay milliseconds
3457 How long (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait after deasserting
3458 nTRST (active-low JTAG TAP reset) before starting new JTAG operations.
3459 @end deffn
3460
3461 @anchor {reset_config}
3462 @deffn {Command} reset_config mode_flag ...
3463 This command displays or modifies the reset configuration
3464 of your combination of JTAG board and target in target
3465 configuration scripts.
3466
3467 Information earlier in this section describes the kind of problems
3468 the command is intended to address (@pxref{srstandtrstissues,,SRST and TRST Issues}).
3469 As a rule this command belongs only in board config files,
3470 describing issues like @emph{board doesn't connect TRST};
3471 or in user config files, addressing limitations derived
3472 from a particular combination of interface and board.
3473 (An unlikely example would be using a TRST-only adapter
3474 with a board that only wires up SRST.)
3475
3476 The @var{mode_flag} options can be specified in any order, but only one
3477 of each type -- @var{signals}, @var{combination}, @var{gates},
3478 @var{trst_type}, @var{srst_type} and @var{connect_type}
3479 -- may be specified at a time.
3480 If you don't provide a new value for a given type, its previous
3481 value (perhaps the default) is unchanged.
3482 For example, this means that you don't need to say anything at all about
3483 TRST just to declare that if the JTAG adapter should want to drive SRST,
3484 it must explicitly be driven high (@option{srst_push_pull}).
3485
3486 @itemize
3487 @item
3488 @var{signals} can specify which of the reset signals are connected.
3489 For example, If the JTAG interface provides SRST, but the board doesn't
3490 connect that signal properly, then OpenOCD can't use it.
3491 Possible values are @option{none} (the default), @option{trst_only},
3492 @option{srst_only} and @option{trst_and_srst}.
3493
3494 @quotation Tip
3495 If your board provides SRST and/or TRST through the JTAG connector,
3496 you must declare that so those signals can be used.
3497 @end quotation
3498
3499 @item
3500 The @var{combination} is an optional value specifying broken reset
3501 signal implementations.
3502 The default behaviour if no option given is @option{separate},
3503 indicating everything behaves normally.
3504 @option{srst_pulls_trst} states that the
3505 test logic is reset together with the reset of the system (e.g. NXP
3506 LPC2000, "broken" board layout), @option{trst_pulls_srst} says that
3507 the system is reset together with the test logic (only hypothetical, I
3508 haven't seen hardware with such a bug, and can be worked around).
3509 @option{combined} implies both @option{srst_pulls_trst} and
3510 @option{trst_pulls_srst}.
3511
3512 @item
3513 The @var{gates} tokens control flags that describe some cases where
3514 JTAG may be unavailable during reset.
3515 @option{srst_gates_jtag} (default)
3516 indicates that asserting SRST gates the
3517 JTAG clock. This means that no communication can happen on JTAG
3518 while SRST is asserted.
3519 Its converse is @option{srst_nogate}, indicating that JTAG commands
3520 can safely be issued while SRST is active.
3521
3522 @item
3523 The @var{connect_type} tokens control flags that describe some cases where
3524 SRST is asserted while connecting to the target. @option{srst_nogate}
3525 is required to use this option.
3526 @option{connect_deassert_srst} (default)
3527 indicates that SRST will not be asserted while connecting to the target.
3528 Its converse is @option{connect_assert_srst}, indicating that SRST will
3529 be asserted before any target connection.
3530 Only some targets support this feature, STM32 and STR9 are examples.
3531 This feature is useful if you are unable to connect to your target due
3532 to incorrect options byte config or illegal program execution.
3533 @end itemize
3534
3535 The optional @var{trst_type} and @var{srst_type} parameters allow the
3536 driver mode of each reset line to be specified. These values only affect
3537 JTAG interfaces with support for different driver modes, like the Amontec
3538 JTAGkey and JTAG Accelerator. Also, they are necessarily ignored if the
3539 relevant signal (TRST or SRST) is not connected.
3540
3541 @itemize
3542 @item
3543 Possible @var{trst_type} driver modes for the test reset signal (TRST)
3544 are the default @option{trst_push_pull}, and @option{trst_open_drain}.
3545 Most boards connect this signal to a pulldown, so the JTAG TAPs
3546 never leave reset unless they are hooked up to a JTAG adapter.
3547
3548 @item
3549 Possible @var{srst_type} driver modes for the system reset signal (SRST)
3550 are the default @option{srst_open_drain}, and @option{srst_push_pull}.
3551 Most boards connect this signal to a pullup, and allow the
3552 signal to be pulled low by various events including system
3553 power-up and pressing a reset button.
3554 @end itemize
3555 @end deffn
3556
3557 @section Custom Reset Handling
3558 @cindex events
3559
3560 OpenOCD has several ways to help support the various reset
3561 mechanisms provided by chip and board vendors.
3562 The commands shown in the previous section give standard parameters.
3563 There are also @emph{event handlers} associated with TAPs or Targets.
3564 Those handlers are Tcl procedures you can provide, which are invoked
3565 at particular points in the reset sequence.
3566
3567 @emph{When SRST is not an option} you must set
3568 up a @code{reset-assert} event handler for your target.
3569 For example, some JTAG adapters don't include the SRST signal;
3570 and some boards have multiple targets, and you won't always
3571 want to reset everything at once.
3572
3573 After configuring those mechanisms, you might still
3574 find your board doesn't start up or reset correctly.
3575 For example, maybe it needs a slightly different sequence
3576 of SRST and/or TRST manipulations, because of quirks that
3577 the @command{reset_config} mechanism doesn't address;
3578 or asserting both might trigger a stronger reset, which
3579 needs special attention.
3580
3581 Experiment with lower level operations, such as @command{jtag_reset}
3582 and the @command{jtag arp_*} operations shown here,
3583 to find a sequence of operations that works.
3584 @xref{JTAG Commands}.
3585 When you find a working sequence, it can be used to override
3586 @command{jtag_init}, which fires during OpenOCD startup
3587 (@pxref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage});
3588 or @command{init_reset}, which fires during reset processing.
3589
3590 You might also want to provide some project-specific reset
3591 schemes. For example, on a multi-target board the standard
3592 @command{reset} command would reset all targets, but you
3593 may need the ability to reset only one target at time and
3594 thus want to avoid using the board-wide SRST signal.
3595
3596 @deffn {Overridable Procedure} init_reset mode
3597 This is invoked near the beginning of the @command{reset} command,
3598 usually to provide as much of a cold (power-up) reset as practical.
3599 By default it is also invoked from @command{jtag_init} if
3600 the scan chain does not respond to pure JTAG operations.
3601 The @var{mode} parameter is the parameter given to the
3602 low level reset command (@option{halt},
3603 @option{init}, or @option{run}), @option{setup},
3604 or potentially some other value.
3605
3606 The default implementation just invokes @command{jtag arp_init-reset}.
3607 Replacements will normally build on low level JTAG
3608 operations such as @command{jtag_reset}.
3609 Operations here must not address individual TAPs
3610 (or their associated targets)
3611 until the JTAG scan chain has first been verified to work.
3612
3613 Implementations must have verified the JTAG scan chain before
3614 they return.
3615 This is done by calling @command{jtag arp_init}
3616 (or @command{jtag arp_init-reset}).
3617 @end deffn
3618
3619 @deffn Command {jtag arp_init}
3620 This validates the scan chain using just the four
3621 standard JTAG signals (TMS, TCK, TDI, TDO).
3622 It starts by issuing a JTAG-only reset.
3623 Then it performs checks to verify that the scan chain configuration
3624 matches the TAPs it can observe.
3625 Those checks include checking IDCODE values for each active TAP,
3626 and verifying the length of their instruction registers using
3627 TAP @code{-ircapture} and @code{-irmask} values.
3628 If these tests all pass, TAP @code{setup} events are
3629 issued to all TAPs with handlers for that event.
3630 @end deffn
3631
3632 @deffn Command {jtag arp_init-reset}
3633 This uses TRST and SRST to try resetting
3634 everything on the JTAG scan chain
3635 (and anything else connected to SRST).
3636 It then invokes the logic of @command{jtag arp_init}.
3637 @end deffn
3638
3639
3640 @node TAP Declaration
3641 @chapter TAP Declaration
3642 @cindex TAP declaration
3643 @cindex TAP configuration
3644
3645 @emph{Test Access Ports} (TAPs) are the core of JTAG.
3646 TAPs serve many roles, including:
3647
3648 @itemize @bullet
3649 @item @b{Debug Target} A CPU TAP can be used as a GDB debug target.
3650 @item @b{Flash Programming} Some chips program the flash directly via JTAG.
3651 Others do it indirectly, making a CPU do it.
3652 @item @b{Program Download} Using the same CPU support GDB uses,
3653 you can initialize a DRAM controller, download code to DRAM, and then
3654 start running that code.
3655 @item @b{Boundary Scan} Most chips support boundary scan, which
3656 helps test for board assembly problems like solder bridges
3657 and missing connections.
3658 @end itemize
3659
3660 OpenOCD must know about the active TAPs on your board(s).
3661 Setting up the TAPs is the core task of your configuration files.
3662 Once those TAPs are set up, you can pass their names to code
3663 which sets up CPUs and exports them as GDB targets,
3664 probes flash memory, performs low-level JTAG operations, and more.
3665
3666 @section Scan Chains
3667 @cindex scan chain
3668
3669 TAPs are part of a hardware @dfn{scan chain},
3670 which is a daisy chain of TAPs.
3671 They also need to be added to
3672 OpenOCD's software mirror of that hardware list,
3673 giving each member a name and associating other data with it.
3674 Simple scan chains, with a single TAP, are common in
3675 systems with a single microcontroller or microprocessor.
3676 More complex chips may have several TAPs internally.
3677 Very complex scan chains might have a dozen or more TAPs:
3678 several in one chip, more in the next, and connecting
3679 to other boards with their own chips and TAPs.
3680
3681 You can display the list with the @command{scan_chain} command.
3682 (Don't confuse this with the list displayed by the @command{targets}
3683 command, presented in the next chapter.
3684 That only displays TAPs for CPUs which are configured as
3685 debugging targets.)
3686 Here's what the scan chain might look like for a chip more than one TAP:
3687
3688 @verbatim
3689 TapName Enabled IdCode Expected IrLen IrCap IrMask
3690 -- ------------------ ------- ---------- ---------- ----- ----- ------
3691 0 omap5912.dsp Y 0x03df1d81 0x03df1d81 38 0x01 0x03
3692 1 omap5912.arm Y 0x0692602f 0x0692602f 4 0x01 0x0f
3693 2 omap5912.unknown Y 0x00000000 0x00000000 8 0x01 0x03
3694 @end verbatim
3695
3696 OpenOCD can detect some of that information, but not all
3697 of it. @xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
3698 Unfortunately, those TAPs can't always be autoconfigured,
3699 because not all devices provide good support for that.
3700 JTAG doesn't require supporting IDCODE instructions, and
3701 chips with JTAG routers may not link TAPs into the chain
3702 until they are told to do so.
3703
3704 The configuration mechanism currently supported by OpenOCD
3705 requires explicit configuration of all TAP devices using
3706 @command{jtag newtap} commands, as detailed later in this chapter.
3707 A command like this would declare one tap and name it @code{chip1.cpu}:
3708
3709 @example
3710 jtag newtap chip1 cpu -irlen 4 -expected-id 0x3ba00477
3711 @end example
3712
3713 Each target configuration file lists the TAPs provided
3714 by a given chip.
3715 Board configuration files combine all the targets on a board,
3716 and so forth.
3717 Note that @emph{the order in which TAPs are declared is very important.}
3718 That declaration order must match the order in the JTAG scan chain,
3719 both inside a single chip and between them.
3720 @xref{faqtaporder,,FAQ TAP Order}.
3721
3722 For example, the STMicroelectronics STR912 chip has
3723 three separate TAPs@footnote{See the ST
3724 document titled: @emph{STR91xFAxxx, Section 3.15 Jtag Interface, Page:
3725 28/102, Figure 3: JTAG chaining inside the STR91xFA}.
3726 @url{http://eu.st.com/stonline/products/literature/ds/13495.pdf}}.
3727 To configure those taps, @file{target/str912.cfg}
3728 includes commands something like this:
3729
3730 @example
3731 jtag newtap str912 flash ... params ...
3732 jtag newtap str912 cpu ... params ...
3733 jtag newtap str912 bs ... params ...
3734 @end example
3735
3736 Actual config files typically use a variable such as @code{$_CHIPNAME}
3737 instead of literals like @option{str912}, to support more than one chip
3738 of each type. @xref{Config File Guidelines}.
3739
3740 @deffn Command {jtag names}
3741 Returns the names of all current TAPs in the scan chain.
3742 Use @command{jtag cget} or @command{jtag tapisenabled}
3743 to examine attributes and state of each TAP.
3744 @example
3745 foreach t [jtag names] @{
3746 puts [format "TAP: %s\n" $t]
3747 @}
3748 @end example
3749 @end deffn
3750
3751 @deffn Command {scan_chain}
3752 Displays the TAPs in the scan chain configuration,
3753 and their status.
3754 The set of TAPs listed by this command is fixed by
3755 exiting the OpenOCD configuration stage,
3756 but systems with a JTAG router can
3757 enable or disable TAPs dynamically.
3758 @end deffn
3759
3760 @c FIXME! "jtag cget" should be able to return all TAP
3761 @c attributes, like "$target_name cget" does for targets.
3762
3763 @c Probably want "jtag eventlist", and a "tap-reset" event
3764 @c (on entry to RESET state).
3765
3766 @section TAP Names
3767 @cindex dotted name
3768
3769 When TAP objects are declared with @command{jtag newtap},
3770 a @dfn{dotted.name} is created for the TAP, combining the
3771 name of a module (usually a chip) and a label for the TAP.
3772 For example: @code{xilinx.tap}, @code{str912.flash},
3773 @code{omap3530.jrc}, @code{dm6446.dsp}, or @code{stm32.cpu}.
3774 Many other commands use that dotted.name to manipulate or
3775 refer to the TAP. For example, CPU configuration uses the
3776 name, as does declaration of NAND or NOR flash banks.
3777
3778 The components of a dotted name should follow ``C'' symbol
3779 name rules: start with an alphabetic character, then numbers
3780 and underscores are OK; while others (including dots!) are not.
3781
3782 @section TAP Declaration Commands
3783
3784 @c shouldn't this be(come) a {Config Command}?
3785 @deffn Command {jtag newtap} chipname tapname configparams...
3786 Declares a new TAP with the dotted name @var{chipname}.@var{tapname},
3787 and configured according to the various @var{configparams}.
3788
3789 The @var{chipname} is a symbolic name for the chip.
3790 Conventionally target config files use @code{$_CHIPNAME},
3791 defaulting to the model name given by the chip vendor but
3792 overridable.
3793
3794 @cindex TAP naming convention
3795 The @var{tapname} reflects the role of that TAP,
3796 and should follow this convention:
3797
3798 @itemize @bullet
3799 @item @code{bs} -- For boundary scan if this is a separate TAP;
3800 @item @code{cpu} -- The main CPU of the chip, alternatively
3801 @code{arm} and @code{dsp} on chips with both ARM and DSP CPUs,
3802 @code{arm1} and @code{arm2} on chips with two ARMs, and so forth;
3803 @item @code{etb} -- For an embedded trace buffer (example: an ARM ETB11);
3804 @item @code{flash} -- If the chip has a flash TAP, like the str912;
3805 @item @code{jrc} -- For JTAG route controller (example: the ICEPick modules
3806 on many Texas Instruments chips, like the OMAP3530 on Beagleboards);
3807 @item @code{tap} -- Should be used only for FPGA- or CPLD-like devices
3808 with a single TAP;
3809 @item @code{unknownN} -- If you have no idea what the TAP is for (N is a number);
3810 @item @emph{when in doubt} -- Use the chip maker's name in their data sheet.
3811 For example, the Freescale i.MX31 has a SDMA (Smart DMA) with
3812 a JTAG TAP; that TAP should be named @code{sdma}.
3813 @end itemize
3814
3815 Every TAP requires at least the following @var{configparams}:
3816
3817 @itemize @bullet
3818 @item @code{-irlen} @var{NUMBER}
3819 @*The length in bits of the
3820 instruction register, such as 4 or 5 bits.
3821 @end itemize
3822
3823 A TAP may also provide optional @var{configparams}:
3824
3825 @itemize @bullet
3826 @item @code{-disable} (or @code{-enable})
3827 @*Use the @code{-disable} parameter to flag a TAP which is not
3828 linked into the scan chain after a reset using either TRST
3829 or the JTAG state machine's @sc{reset} state.
3830 You may use @code{-enable} to highlight the default state
3831 (the TAP is linked in).
3832 @xref{enablinganddisablingtaps,,Enabling and Disabling TAPs}.
3833 @item @code{-expected-id} @var{NUMBER}
3834 @*A non-zero @var{number} represents a 32-bit IDCODE
3835 which you expect to find when the scan chain is examined.
3836 These codes are not required by all JTAG devices.
3837 @emph{Repeat the option} as many times as required if more than one
3838 ID code could appear (for example, multiple versions).
3839 Specify @var{number} as zero to suppress warnings about IDCODE
3840 values that were found but not included in the list.
3841
3842 Provide this value if at all possible, since it lets OpenOCD
3843 tell when the scan chain it sees isn't right. These values
3844 are provided in vendors' chip documentation, usually a technical
3845 reference manual. Sometimes you may need to probe the JTAG
3846 hardware to find these values.
3847 @xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
3848 @item @code{-ignore-version}
3849 @*Specify this to ignore the JTAG version field in the @code{-expected-id}
3850 option. When vendors put out multiple versions of a chip, or use the same
3851 JTAG-level ID for several largely-compatible chips, it may be more practical
3852 to ignore the version field than to update config files to handle all of
3853 the various chip IDs. The version field is defined as bit 28-31 of the IDCODE.
3854 @item @code{-ircapture} @var{NUMBER}
3855 @*The bit pattern loaded by the TAP into the JTAG shift register
3856 on entry to the @sc{ircapture} state, such as 0x01.
3857 JTAG requires the two LSBs of this value to be 01.
3858 By default, @code{-ircapture} and @code{-irmask} are set
3859 up to verify that two-bit value. You may provide
3860 additional bits if you know them, or indicate that
3861 a TAP doesn't conform to the JTAG specification.
3862 @item @code{-irmask} @var{NUMBER}
3863 @*A mask used with @code{-ircapture}
3864 to verify that instruction scans work correctly.
3865 Such scans are not used by OpenOCD except to verify that
3866 there seems to be no problems with JTAG scan chain operations.
3867 @item @code{-ignore-syspwrupack}
3868 @*Specify this to ignore the CSYSPWRUPACK bit in the ARM DAP DP CTRL/STAT
3869 register during initial examination and when checking the sticky error bit.
3870 This bit is normally checked after setting the CSYSPWRUPREQ bit, but some
3871 devices do not set the ack bit until sometime later.
3872 @end itemize
3873 @end deffn
3874
3875 @section Other TAP commands
3876
3877 @deffn Command {jtag cget} dotted.name @option{-event} event_name
3878 @deffnx Command {jtag configure} dotted.name @option{-event} event_name handler
3879 At this writing this TAP attribute
3880 mechanism is used only for event handling.
3881 (It is not a direct analogue of the @code{cget}/@code{configure}
3882 mechanism for debugger targets.)
3883 See the next section for information about the available events.
3884
3885 The @code{configure} subcommand assigns an event handler,
3886 a TCL string which is evaluated when the event is triggered.
3887 The @code{cget} subcommand returns that handler.
3888 @end deffn
3889
3890 @section TAP Events
3891 @cindex events
3892 @cindex TAP events
3893
3894 OpenOCD includes two event mechanisms.
3895 The one presented here applies to all JTAG TAPs.
3896 The other applies to debugger targets,
3897 which are associated with certain TAPs.
3898
3899 The TAP events currently defined are:
3900
3901 @itemize @bullet
3902 @item @b{post-reset}
3903 @* The TAP has just completed a JTAG reset.
3904 The tap may still be in the JTAG @sc{reset} state.
3905 Handlers for these events might perform initialization sequences
3906 such as issuing TCK cycles, TMS sequences to ensure
3907 exit from the ARM SWD mode, and more.
3908
3909 Because the scan chain has not yet been verified, handlers for these events
3910 @emph{should not issue commands which scan the JTAG IR or DR registers}
3911 of any particular target.
3912 @b{NOTE:} As this is written (September 2009), nothing prevents such access.
3913 @item @b{setup}
3914 @* The scan chain has been reset and verified.
3915 This handler may enable TAPs as needed.
3916 @item @b{tap-disable}
3917 @* The TAP needs to be disabled. This handler should
3918 implement @command{jtag tapdisable}
3919 by issuing the relevant JTAG commands.
3920 @item @b{tap-enable}
3921 @* The TAP needs to be enabled. This handler should
3922 implement @command{jtag tapenable}
3923 by issuing the relevant JTAG commands.
3924 @end itemize
3925
3926 If you need some action after each JTAG reset which isn't actually
3927 specific to any TAP (since you can't yet trust the scan chain's
3928 contents to be accurate), you might:
3929
3930 @example
3931 jtag configure CHIP.jrc -event post-reset @{
3932 echo "JTAG Reset done"
3933 ... non-scan jtag operations to be done after reset
3934 @}
3935 @end example
3936
3937
3938 @anchor{enablinganddisablingtaps}
3939 @section Enabling and Disabling TAPs
3940 @cindex JTAG Route Controller
3941 @cindex jrc
3942
3943 In some systems, a @dfn{JTAG Route Controller} (JRC)
3944 is used to enable and/or disable specific JTAG TAPs.
3945 Many ARM-based chips from Texas Instruments include
3946 an ``ICEPick'' module, which is a JRC.
3947 Such chips include DaVinci and OMAP3 processors.
3948
3949 A given TAP may not be visible until the JRC has been
3950 told to link it into the scan chain; and if the JRC
3951 has been told to unlink that TAP, it will no longer
3952 be visible.
3953 Such routers address problems that JTAG ``bypass mode''
3954 ignores, such as:
3955
3956 @itemize
3957 @item The scan chain can only go as fast as its slowest TAP.
3958 @item Having many TAPs slows instruction scans, since all
3959 TAPs receive new instructions.
3960 @item TAPs in the scan chain must be powered up, which wastes
3961 power and prevents debugging some power management mechanisms.
3962 @end itemize
3963
3964 The IEEE 1149.1 JTAG standard has no concept of a ``disabled'' tap,
3965 as implied by the existence of JTAG routers.
3966 However, the upcoming IEEE 1149.7 framework (layered on top of JTAG)
3967 does include a kind of JTAG router functionality.
3968
3969 @c (a) currently the event handlers don't seem to be able to
3970 @c fail in a way that could lead to no-change-of-state.
3971
3972 In OpenOCD, tap enabling/disabling is invoked by the Tcl commands
3973 shown below, and is implemented using TAP event handlers.
3974 So for example, when defining a TAP for a CPU connected to
3975 a JTAG router, your @file{target.cfg} file
3976 should define TAP event handlers using
3977 code that looks something like this:
3978
3979 @example
3980 jtag configure CHIP.cpu -event tap-enable @{
3981 ... jtag operations using CHIP.jrc
3982 @}
3983 jtag configure CHIP.cpu -event tap-disable @{
3984 ... jtag operations using CHIP.jrc
3985 @}
3986 @end example
3987
3988 Then you might want that CPU's TAP enabled almost all the time:
3989
3990 @example
3991 jtag configure $CHIP.jrc -event setup "jtag tapenable $CHIP.cpu"
3992 @end example
3993
3994 Note how that particular setup event handler declaration
3995 uses quotes to evaluate @code{$CHIP} when the event is configured.
3996 Using brackets @{ @} would cause it to be evaluated later,
3997 at runtime, when it might have a different value.
3998
3999 @deffn Command {jtag tapdisable} dotted.name
4000 If necessary, disables the tap
4001 by sending it a @option{tap-disable} event.
4002 Returns the string "1" if the tap
4003 specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
4004 and "0" if it is disabled.
4005 @end deffn
4006
4007 @deffn Command {jtag tapenable} dotted.name
4008 If necessary, enables the tap
4009 by sending it a @option{tap-enable} event.
4010 Returns the string "1" if the tap
4011 specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
4012 and "0" if it is disabled.
4013 @end deffn
4014
4015 @deffn Command {jtag tapisenabled} dotted.name
4016 Returns the string "1" if the tap
4017 specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
4018 and "0" if it is disabled.
4019
4020 @quotation Note
4021 Humans will find the @command{scan_chain} command more helpful
4022 for querying the state of the JTAG taps.
4023 @end quotation
4024 @end deffn
4025
4026 @anchor{autoprobing}
4027 @section Autoprobing
4028 @cindex autoprobe
4029 @cindex JTAG autoprobe
4030
4031 TAP configuration is the first thing that needs to be done
4032 after interface and reset configuration. Sometimes it's
4033 hard finding out what TAPs exist, or how they are identified.
4034 Vendor documentation is not always easy to find and use.
4035
4036 To help you get past such problems, OpenOCD has a limited
4037 @emph{autoprobing} ability to look at the scan chain, doing
4038 a @dfn{blind interrogation} and then reporting the TAPs it finds.
4039 To use this mechanism, start the OpenOCD server with only data
4040 that configures your JTAG interface, and arranges to come up
4041 with a slow clock (many devices don't support fast JTAG clocks
4042 right when they come out of reset).
4043
4044 For example, your @file{openocd.cfg} file might have:
4045
4046 @example
4047 source [find interface/olimex-arm-usb-tiny-h.cfg]
4048 reset_config trst_and_srst
4049 jtag_rclk 8
4050 @end example
4051
4052 When you start the server without any TAPs configured, it will
4053 attempt to autoconfigure the TAPs. There are two parts to this:
4054
4055 @enumerate
4056 @item @emph{TAP discovery} ...
4057 After a JTAG reset (sometimes a system reset may be needed too),
4058 each TAP's data registers will hold the contents of either the
4059 IDCODE or BYPASS register.
4060 If JTAG communication is working, OpenOCD will see each TAP,
4061 and report what @option{-expected-id} to use with it.
4062 @item @emph{IR Length discovery} ...
4063 Unfortunately JTAG does not provide a reliable way to find out
4064 the value of the @option{-irlen} parameter to use with a TAP
4065 that is discovered.
4066 If OpenOCD can discover the length of a TAP's instruction
4067 register, it will report it.
4068 Otherwise you may need to consult vendor documentation, such
4069 as chip data sheets or BSDL files.
4070 @end enumerate
4071
4072 In many cases your board will have a simple scan chain with just
4073 a single device. Here's what OpenOCD reported with one board
4074 that's a bit more complex:
4075
4076 @example
4077 clock speed 8 kHz
4078 There are no enabled taps. AUTO PROBING MIGHT NOT WORK!!
4079 AUTO auto0.tap - use "jtag newtap auto0 tap -expected-id 0x2b900f0f ..."
4080 AUTO auto1.tap - use "jtag newtap auto1 tap -expected-id 0x07926001 ..."
4081 AUTO auto2.tap - use "jtag newtap auto2 tap -expected-id 0x0b73b02f ..."
4082 AUTO auto0.tap - use "... -irlen 4"
4083 AUTO auto1.tap - use "... -irlen 4"
4084 AUTO auto2.tap - use "... -irlen 6"
4085 no gdb ports allocated as no target has been specified
4086 @end example
4087
4088 Given that information, you should be able to either find some existing
4089 config files to use, or create your own. If you create your own, you
4090 would configure from the bottom up: first a @file{target.cfg} file
4091 with these TAPs, any targets associated with them, and any on-chip
4092 resources; then a @file{board.cfg} with off-chip resources, clocking,
4093 and so forth.
4094
4095 @anchor{dapdeclaration}
4096 @section DAP declaration (ARMv6-M, ARMv7 and ARMv8 targets)
4097 @cindex DAP declaration
4098
4099 Since OpenOCD version 0.11.0, the Debug Access Port (DAP) is
4100 no longer implicitly created together with the target. It must be
4101 explicitly declared using the @command{dap create} command. For all ARMv6-M, ARMv7
4102 and ARMv8 targets, the option "@option{-dap} @var{dap_name}" has to be used
4103 instead of "@option{-chain-position} @var{dotted.name}" when the target is created.
4104
4105 The @command{dap} command group supports the following sub-commands:
4106
4107 @deffn Command {dap create} dap_name @option{-chain-position} dotted.name configparams...
4108 Declare a DAP instance named @var{dap_name} linked to the JTAG tap
4109 @var{dotted.name}. This also creates a new command (@command{dap_name})
4110 which is used for various purposes including additional configuration.
4111 There can only be one DAP for each JTAG tap in the system.
4112
4113 A DAP may also provide optional @var{configparams}:
4114
4115 @itemize @bullet
4116 @item @code{-ignore-syspwrupack}
4117 @*Specify this to ignore the CSYSPWRUPACK bit in the ARM DAP DP CTRL/STAT
4118 register during initial examination and when checking the sticky error bit.
4119 This bit is normally checked after setting the CSYSPWRUPREQ bit, but some
4120 devices do not set the ack bit until sometime later.
4121 @end itemize
4122 @end deffn
4123
4124 @deffn Command {dap names}
4125 This command returns a list of all registered DAP objects. It it useful mainly
4126 for TCL scripting.
4127 @end deffn
4128
4129 @deffn Command {dap info} [num]
4130 Displays the ROM table for MEM-AP @var{num},
4131 defaulting to the currently selected AP of the currently selected target.
4132 @end deffn
4133
4134 @deffn Command {dap init}
4135 Initialize all registered DAPs. This command is used internally
4136 during initialization. It can be issued at any time after the
4137 initialization, too.
4138 @end deffn
4139
4140 The following commands exist as subcommands of DAP instances:
4141
4142 @deffn Command {$dap_name info} [num]
4143 Displays the ROM table for MEM-AP @var{num},
4144 defaulting to the currently selected AP.
4145 @end deffn
4146
4147 @deffn Command {$dap_name apid} [num]
4148 Displays ID register from AP @var{num}, defaulting to the currently selected AP.
4149 @end deffn
4150
4151 @anchor{DAP subcommand apreg}
4152 @deffn Command {$dap_name apreg} ap_num reg [value]
4153 Displays content of a register @var{reg} from AP @var{ap_num}
4154 or set a new value @var{value}.
4155 @var{reg} is byte address of a word register, 0, 4, 8 ... 0xfc.
4156 @end deffn
4157
4158 @deffn Command {$dap_name apsel} [num]
4159 Select AP @var{num}, defaulting to 0.
4160 @end deffn
4161
4162 @deffn Command {$dap_name dpreg} reg [value]
4163 Displays the content of DP register at address @var{reg}, or set it to a new
4164 value @var{value}.
4165
4166 In case of SWD, @var{reg} is a value in packed format
4167 @math{dpbanksel << 4 | addr} and assumes values 0, 4, 8 ... 0xfc.
4168 In case of JTAG it only assumes values 0, 4, 8 and 0xc.
4169
4170 @emph{Note:} Consider using @command{poll off} to avoid any disturbing
4171 background activity by OpenOCD while you are operating at such low-level.
4172 @end deffn
4173
4174 @deffn Command {$dap_name baseaddr} [num]
4175 Displays debug base address from MEM-AP @var{num},
4176 defaulting to the currently selected AP.
4177 @end deffn
4178
4179 @deffn Command {$dap_name memaccess} [value]
4180 Displays the number of extra tck cycles in the JTAG idle to use for MEM-AP
4181 memory bus access [0-255], giving additional time to respond to reads.
4182 If @var{value} is defined, first assigns that.
4183 @end deffn
4184
4185 @deffn Command {$dap_name apcsw} [value [mask]]
4186 Displays or changes CSW bit pattern for MEM-AP transfers.
4187
4188 At the begin of each memory access the CSW pattern is extended (bitwise or-ed)
4189 by @dfn{Size} and @dfn{AddrInc} bit-fields according to transfer requirements
4190 and the result is written to the real CSW register. All bits except dynamically
4191 updated fields @dfn{Size} and @dfn{AddrInc} can be changed by changing
4192 the CSW pattern. Refer to ARM ADI v5 manual chapter 7.6.4 and appendix A
4193 for details.
4194
4195 Use @var{value} only syntax if you want to set the new CSW pattern as a whole.
4196 The example sets HPROT1 bit (required by Cortex-M) and clears the rest of
4197 the pattern:
4198 @example
4199 kx.dap apcsw 0x2000000
4200 @end example
4201
4202 If @var{mask} is also used, the CSW pattern is changed only on bit positions
4203 where the mask bit is 1. The following example sets HPROT3 (cacheable)
4204 and leaves the rest of the pattern intact. It configures memory access through
4205 DCache on Cortex-M7.
4206 @example
4207 set CSW_HPROT3_CACHEABLE [expr 1 << 27]
4208 samv.dap apcsw $CSW_HPROT3_CACHEABLE $CSW_HPROT3_CACHEABLE
4209 @end example
4210
4211 Another example clears SPROT bit and leaves the rest of pattern intact:
4212 @example
4213 set CSW_SPROT [expr 1 << 30]
4214 samv.dap apcsw 0 $CSW_SPROT
4215 @end example
4216
4217 @emph{Note:} If you want to check the real value of CSW, not CSW pattern, use
4218 @code{xxx.dap apreg 0}. @xref{DAP subcommand apreg,,}.
4219
4220 @emph{Warning:} Some of the CSW bits are vital for working memory transfer.
4221 If you set a wrong CSW pattern and MEM-AP stopped working, use the following
4222 example with a proper dap name:
4223 @example
4224 xxx.dap apcsw default
4225 @end example
4226 @end deffn
4227
4228 @deffn Command {$dap_name ti_be_32_quirks} [@option{enable}]
4229 Set/get quirks mode for TI TMS450/TMS570 processors
4230 Disabled by default
4231 @end deffn
4232
4233
4234 @node CPU Configuration
4235 @chapter CPU Configuration
4236 @cindex GDB target
4237
4238 This chapter discusses how to set up GDB debug targets for CPUs.
4239 You can also access these targets without GDB
4240 (@pxref{Architecture and Core Commands},
4241 and @ref{targetstatehandling,,Target State handling}) and
4242 through various kinds of NAND and NOR flash commands.
4243 If you have multiple CPUs you can have multiple such targets.
4244
4245 We'll start by looking at how to examine the targets you have,
4246 then look at how to add one more target and how to configure it.
4247
4248 @section Target List
4249 @cindex target, current
4250 @cindex target, list
4251
4252 All targets that have been set up are part of a list,
4253 where each member has a name.
4254 That name should normally be the same as the TAP name.
4255 You can display the list with the @command{targets}
4256 (plural!) command.
4257 This display often has only one CPU; here's what it might
4258 look like with more than one:
4259 @verbatim
4260 TargetName Type Endian TapName State
4261 -- ------------------ ---------- ------ ------------------ ------------
4262 0* at91rm9200.cpu arm920t little at91rm9200.cpu running
4263 1 MyTarget cortex_m little mychip.foo tap-disabled
4264 @end verbatim
4265
4266 One member of that list is the @dfn{current target}, which
4267 is implicitly referenced by many commands.
4268 It's the one marked with a @code{*} near the target name.
4269 In particular, memory addresses often refer to the address
4270 space seen by that current target.
4271 Commands like @command{mdw} (memory display words)
4272 and @command{flash erase_address} (erase NOR flash blocks)
4273 are examples; and there are many more.
4274
4275 Several commands let you examine the list of targets:
4276
4277 @deffn Command {target current}
4278 Returns the name of the current target.
4279 @end deffn
4280
4281 @deffn Command {target names}
4282 Lists the names of all current targets in the list.
4283 @example
4284 foreach t [target names] @{
4285 puts [format "Target: %s\n" $t]
4286 @}
4287 @end example
4288 @end deffn
4289
4290 @c yep, "target list" would have been better.
4291 @c plus maybe "target setdefault".
4292
4293 @deffn Command targets [name]
4294 @emph{Note: the name of this command is plural. Other target
4295 command names are singular.}
4296
4297 With no parameter, this command displays a table of all known
4298 targets in a user friendly form.
4299
4300 With a parameter, this command sets the current target to
4301 the given target with the given @var{name}; this is
4302 only relevant on boards which have more than one target.
4303 @end deffn
4304
4305 @section Target CPU Types
4306 @cindex target type
4307 @cindex CPU type
4308
4309 Each target has a @dfn{CPU type}, as shown in the output of
4310 the @command{targets} command. You need to specify that type
4311 when calling @command{target create}.
4312 The CPU type indicates more than just the instruction set.
4313 It also indicates how that instruction set is implemented,
4314 what kind of debug support it integrates,
4315 whether it has an MMU (and if so, what kind),
4316 what core-specific commands may be available
4317 (@pxref{Architecture and Core Commands}),
4318 and more.
4319
4320 It's easy to see what target types are supported,
4321 since there's a command to list them.
4322
4323 @anchor{targettypes}
4324 @deffn Command {target types}
4325 Lists all supported target types.
4326 At this writing, the supported CPU types are:
4327
4328 @itemize @bullet
4329 @item @code{arm11} -- this is a generation of ARMv6 cores
4330 @item @code{arm720t} -- this is an ARMv4 core with an MMU
4331 @item @code{arm7tdmi} -- this is an ARMv4 core
4332 @item @code{arm920t} -- this is an ARMv4 core with an MMU
4333 @item @code{arm926ejs} -- this is an ARMv5 core with an MMU
4334 @item @code{arm966e} -- this is an ARMv5 core
4335 @item @code{arm9tdmi} -- this is an ARMv4 core
4336 @item @code{avr} -- implements Atmel's 8-bit AVR instruction set.
4337 (Support for this is preliminary and incomplete.)
4338 @item @code{cortex_a} -- this is an ARMv7 core with an MMU
4339 @item @code{cortex_m} -- this is an ARMv7 core, supporting only the
4340 compact Thumb2 instruction set.
4341 @item @code{aarch64} -- this is an ARMv8-A core with an MMU
4342 @item @code{dragonite} -- resembles arm966e
4343 @item @code{dsp563xx} -- implements Freescale's 24-bit DSP.
4344 (Support for this is still incomplete.)
4345 @item @code{esirisc} -- this is an EnSilica eSi-RISC core.
4346 The current implementation supports eSi-32xx cores.
4347 @item @code{fa526} -- resembles arm920 (w/o Thumb)
4348 @item @code{feroceon} -- resembles arm926
4349 @item @code{mips_m4k} -- a MIPS core
4350 @item @code{xscale} -- this is actually an architecture,
4351 not a CPU type. It is based on the ARMv5 architecture.
4352 @item @code{openrisc} -- this is an OpenRISC 1000 core.
4353 The current implementation supports three JTAG TAP cores:
4354 @item @code{ls1_sap} -- this is the SAP on NXP LS102x CPUs,
4355 allowing access to physical memory addresses independently of CPU cores.
4356 @itemize @minus
4357 @item @code{OpenCores TAP} (See: @url{http://opencores.org/project,jtag})
4358 @item @code{Altera Virtual JTAG TAP} (See: @url{http://www.altera.com/literature/ug/ug_virtualjtag.pdf})
4359 @item @code{Xilinx BSCAN_* virtual JTAG interface} (See: @url{http://www.xilinx.com/support/documentation/sw_manuals/xilinx14_2/spartan6_hdl.pdf})
4360 @end itemize
4361 And two debug interfaces cores:
4362 @itemize @minus
4363 @item @code{Advanced debug interface} (See: @url{http://opencores.org/project,adv_debug_sys})
4364 @item @code{SoC Debug Interface} (See: @url{http://opencores.org/project,dbg_interface})
4365 @end itemize
4366 @end itemize
4367 @end deffn
4368
4369 To avoid being confused by the variety of ARM based cores, remember
4370 this key point: @emph{ARM is a technology licencing company}.
4371 (See: @url{http://www.arm.com}.)
4372 The CPU name used by OpenOCD will reflect the CPU design that was
4373 licensed, not a vendor brand which incorporates that design.
4374 Name prefixes like arm7, arm9, arm11, and cortex
4375 reflect design generations;
4376 while names like ARMv4, ARMv5, ARMv6, ARMv7 and ARMv8
4377 reflect an architecture version implemented by a CPU design.
4378
4379 @anchor{targetconfiguration}
4380 @section Target Configuration
4381
4382 Before creating a ``target'', you must have added its TAP to the scan chain.
4383 When you've added that TAP, you will have a @code{dotted.name}
4384 which is used to set up the CPU support.
4385 The chip-specific configuration file will normally configure its CPU(s)
4386 right after it adds all of the chip's TAPs to the scan chain.
4387
4388 Although you can set up a target in one step, it's often clearer if you
4389 use shorter commands and do it in two steps: create it, then configure
4390 optional parts.
4391 All operations on the target after it's created will use a new
4392 command, created as part of target creation.
4393
4394 The two main things to configure after target creation are
4395 a work area, which usually has target-specific defaults even
4396 if the board setup code overrides them later;
4397 and event handlers (@pxref{targetevents,,Target Events}), which tend
4398 to be much more board-specific.
4399 The key steps you use might look something like this
4400
4401 @example
4402 dap create mychip.dap -chain-position mychip.cpu
4403 target create MyTarget cortex_m -dap mychip.dap
4404 MyTarget configure -work-area-phys 0x08000 -work-area-size 8096
4405 MyTarget configure -event reset-deassert-pre @{ jtag_rclk 5 @}
4406 MyTarget configure -event reset-init @{ myboard_reinit @}
4407 @end example
4408
4409 You should specify a working area if you can; typically it uses some
4410 on-chip SRAM.
4411 Such a working area can speed up many things, including bulk
4412 writes to target memory;
4413 flash operations like checking to see if memory needs to be erased;
4414 GDB memory checksumming;
4415 and more.
4416
4417 @quotation Warning
4418 On more complex chips, the work area can become
4419 inaccessible when application code
4420 (such as an operating system)
4421 enables or disables the MMU.
4422 For example, the particular MMU context used to access the virtual
4423 address will probably matter ... and that context might not have
4424 easy access to other addresses needed.
4425 At this writing, OpenOCD doesn't have much MMU intelligence.
4426 @end quotation
4427
4428 It's often very useful to define a @code{reset-init} event handler.
4429 For systems that are normally used with a boot loader,
4430 common tasks include updating clocks and initializing memory
4431 controllers.
4432 That may be needed to let you write the boot loader into flash,
4433 in order to ``de-brick'' your board; or to load programs into
4434 external DDR memory without having run the boot loader.
4435
4436 @deffn Command {target create} target_name type configparams...
4437 This command creates a GDB debug target that refers to a specific JTAG tap.
4438 It enters that target into a list, and creates a new
4439 command (@command{@var{target_name}}) which is used for various
4440 purposes including additional configuration.
4441
4442 @itemize @bullet
4443 @item @var{target_name} ... is the name of the debug target.
4444 By convention this should be the same as the @emph{dotted.name}
4445 of the TAP associated with this target, which must be specified here
4446 using the @code{-chain-position @var{dotted.name}} configparam.
4447
4448 This name is also used to create the target object command,
4449 referred to here as @command{$target_name},
4450 and in other places the target needs to be identified.
4451 @item @var{type} ... specifies the target type. @xref{targettypes,,target types}.
4452 @item @var{configparams} ... all parameters accepted by
4453 @command{$target_name configure} are permitted.
4454 If the target is big-endian, set it here with @code{-endian big}.
4455
4456 You @emph{must} set the @code{-chain-position @var{dotted.name}} or
4457 @code{-dap @var{dap_name}} here.
4458 @end itemize
4459 @end deffn
4460
4461 @deffn Command {$target_name configure} configparams...
4462 The options accepted by this command may also be
4463 specified as parameters to @command{target create}.
4464 Their values can later be queried one at a time by
4465 using the @command{$target_name cget} command.
4466
4467 @emph{Warning:} changing some of these after setup is dangerous.
4468 For example, moving a target from one TAP to another;
4469 and changing its endianness.
4470
4471 @itemize @bullet
4472
4473 @item @code{-chain-position} @var{dotted.name} -- names the TAP
4474 used to access this target.
4475
4476 @item @code{-dap} @var{dap_name} -- names the DAP used to access
4477 this target. @xref{dapdeclaration,,DAP declaration}, on how to
4478 create and manage DAP instances.
4479
4480 @item @code{-endian} (@option{big}|@option{little}) -- specifies
4481 whether the CPU uses big or little endian conventions
4482
4483 @item @code{-event} @var{event_name} @var{event_body} --
4484 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
4485 Note that this updates a list of named event handlers.
4486 Calling this twice with two different event names assigns
4487 two different handlers, but calling it twice with the
4488 same event name assigns only one handler.
4489
4490 Current target is temporarily overridden to the event issuing target
4491 before handler code starts and switched back after handler is done.
4492
4493 @item @code{-work-area-backup} (@option{0}|@option{1}) -- says
4494 whether the work area gets backed up; by default,
4495 @emph{it is not backed up.}
4496 When possible, use a working_area that doesn't need to be backed up,
4497 since performing a backup slows down operations.
4498 For example, the beginning of an SRAM block is likely to
4499 be used by most build systems, but the end is often unused.
4500
4501 @item @code{-work-area-size} @var{size} -- specify work are size,
4502 in bytes. The same size applies regardless of whether its physical
4503 or virtual address is being used.
4504
4505 @item @code{-work-area-phys} @var{address} -- set the work area
4506 base @var{address} to be used when no MMU is active.
4507
4508 @item @code{-work-area-virt} @var{address} -- set the work area
4509 base @var{address} to be used when an MMU is active.
4510 @emph{Do not specify a value for this except on targets with an MMU.}
4511 The value should normally correspond to a static mapping for the
4512 @code{-work-area-phys} address, set up by the current operating system.
4513
4514 @anchor{rtostype}
4515 @item @code{-rtos} @var{rtos_type} -- enable rtos support for target,
4516 @var{rtos_type} can be one of @option{auto}, @option{eCos},
4517 @option{ThreadX}, @option{FreeRTOS}, @option{linux}, @option{ChibiOS},
4518 @option{embKernel}, @option{mqx}, @option{uCOS-III}, @option{nuttx}
4519 @xref{gdbrtossupport,,RTOS Support}.
4520
4521 @item @code{-defer-examine} -- skip target examination at initial JTAG chain
4522 scan and after a reset. A manual call to arp_examine is required to
4523 access the target for debugging.
4524
4525 @item @code{-ap-num} @var{ap_number} -- set DAP access port for target,
4526 @var{ap_number} is the numeric index of the DAP AP the target is connected to.
4527 Use this option with systems where multiple, independent cores are connected
4528 to separate access ports of the same DAP.
4529
4530 @item @code{-cti} @var{cti_name} -- set Cross-Trigger Interface (CTI) connected
4531 to the target. Currently, only the @code{aarch64} target makes use of this option,
4532 where it is a mandatory configuration for the target run control.
4533 @xref{armcrosstrigger,,ARM Cross-Trigger Interface},
4534 for instruction on how to declare and control a CTI instance.
4535
4536 @anchor{gdbportoverride}
4537 @item @code{-gdb-port} @var{number} -- see command @command{gdb_port} for the
4538 possible values of the parameter @var{number}, which are not only numeric values.
4539 Use this option to override, for this target only, the global parameter set with
4540 command @command{gdb_port}.
4541 @xref{gdb_port,,command gdb_port}.
4542 @end itemize
4543 @end deffn
4544
4545 @section Other $target_name Commands
4546 @cindex object command
4547
4548 The Tcl/Tk language has the concept of object commands,
4549 and OpenOCD adopts that same model for targets.
4550
4551 A good Tk example is a on screen button.
4552 Once a button is created a button
4553 has a name (a path in Tk terms) and that name is useable as a first
4554 class command. For example in Tk, one can create a button and later
4555 configure it like this:
4556
4557 @example
4558 # Create
4559 button .foobar -background red -command @{ foo @}
4560 # Modify
4561 .foobar configure -foreground blue
4562 # Query
4563 set x [.foobar cget -background]
4564 # Report
4565 puts [format "The button is %s" $x]
4566 @end example
4567
4568 In OpenOCD's terms, the ``target'' is an object just like a Tcl/Tk
4569 button, and its object commands are invoked the same way.
4570
4571 @example
4572 str912.cpu mww 0x1234 0x42
4573 omap3530.cpu mww 0x5555 123
4574 @end example
4575
4576 The commands supported by OpenOCD target objects are:
4577
4578 @deffn Command {$target_name arp_examine} @option{allow-defer}
4579 @deffnx Command {$target_name arp_halt}
4580 @deffnx Command {$target_name arp_poll}
4581 @deffnx Command {$target_name arp_reset}
4582 @deffnx Command {$target_name arp_waitstate}
4583 Internal OpenOCD scripts (most notably @file{startup.tcl})
4584 use these to deal with specific reset cases.
4585 They are not otherwise documented here.
4586 @end deffn
4587
4588 @deffn Command {$target_name array2mem} arrayname width address count
4589 @deffnx Command {$target_name mem2array} arrayname width address count
4590 These provide an efficient script-oriented interface to memory.
4591 The @code{array2mem} primitive writes bytes, halfwords, or words;
4592 while @code{mem2array} reads them.
4593 In both cases, the TCL side uses an array, and
4594 the target side uses raw memory.
4595
4596 The efficiency comes from enabling the use of
4597 bulk JTAG data transfer operations.
4598 The script orientation comes from working with data
4599 values that are packaged for use by TCL scripts;
4600 @command{mdw} type primitives only print data they retrieve,
4601 and neither store nor return those values.
4602
4603 @itemize
4604 @item @var{arrayname} ... is the name of an array variable
4605 @item @var{width} ... is 8/16/32 - indicating the memory access size
4606 @item @var{address} ... is the target memory address
4607 @item @var{count} ... is the number of elements to process
4608 @end itemize
4609 @end deffn
4610
4611 @deffn Command {$target_name cget} queryparm
4612 Each configuration parameter accepted by
4613 @command{$target_name configure}
4614 can be individually queried, to return its current value.
4615 The @var{queryparm} is a parameter name
4616 accepted by that command, such as @code{-work-area-phys}.
4617 There are a few special cases:
4618
4619 @itemize @bullet
4620 @item @code{-event} @var{event_name} -- returns the handler for the
4621 event named @var{event_name}.
4622 This is a special case because setting a handler requires
4623 two parameters.
4624 @item @code{-type} -- returns the target type.
4625 This is a special case because this is set using
4626 @command{target create} and can't be changed
4627 using @command{$target_name configure}.
4628 @end itemize
4629
4630 For example, if you wanted to summarize information about
4631 all the targets you might use something like this:
4632
4633 @example
4634 foreach name [target names] @{
4635 set y [$name cget -endian]
4636 set z [$name cget -type]
4637 puts [format "Chip %d is %s, Endian: %s, type: %s" \
4638 $x $name $y $z]
4639 @}
4640 @end example
4641 @end deffn
4642
4643 @anchor{targetcurstate}
4644 @deffn Command {$target_name curstate}
4645 Displays the current target state:
4646 @code{debug-running},
4647 @code{halted},
4648 @code{reset},
4649 @code{running}, or @code{unknown}.
4650 (Also, @pxref{eventpolling,,Event Polling}.)
4651 @end deffn
4652
4653 @deffn Command {$target_name eventlist}
4654 Displays a table listing all event handlers
4655 currently associated with this target.
4656 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
4657 @end deffn
4658
4659 @deffn Command {$target_name invoke-event} event_name
4660 Invokes the handler for the event named @var{event_name}.
4661 (This is primarily intended for use by OpenOCD framework
4662 code, for example by the reset code in @file{startup.tcl}.)
4663 @end deffn
4664
4665 @deffn Command {$target_name mdw} addr [count]
4666 @deffnx Command {$target_name mdh} addr [count]
4667 @deffnx Command {$target_name mdb} addr [count]
4668 Display contents of address @var{addr}, as
4669 32-bit words (@command{mdw}), 16-bit halfwords (@command{mdh}),
4670 or 8-bit bytes (@command{mdb}).
4671 If @var{count} is specified, displays that many units.
4672 (If you want to manipulate the data instead of displaying it,
4673 see the @code{mem2array} primitives.)
4674 @end deffn
4675
4676 @deffn Command {$target_name mww} addr word
4677 @deffnx Command {$target_name mwh} addr halfword
4678 @deffnx Command {$target_name mwb} addr byte
4679 Writes the specified @var{word} (32 bits),
4680 @var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) pattern,
4681 at the specified address @var{addr}.
4682 @end deffn
4683
4684 @anchor{targetevents}
4685 @section Target Events
4686 @cindex target events
4687 @cindex events
4688 At various times, certain things can happen, or you want them to happen.
4689 For example:
4690 @itemize @bullet
4691 @item What should happen when GDB connects? Should your target reset?
4692 @item When GDB tries to flash the target, do you need to enable the flash via a special command?
4693 @item Is using SRST appropriate (and possible) on your system?
4694 Or instead of that, do you need to issue JTAG commands to trigger reset?
4695 SRST usually resets everything on the scan chain, which can be inappropriate.
4696 @item During reset, do you need to write to certain memory locations
4697 to set up system clocks or
4698 to reconfigure the SDRAM?
4699 How about configuring the watchdog timer, or other peripherals,
4700 to stop running while you hold the core stopped for debugging?
4701 @end itemize
4702
4703 All of the above items can be addressed by target event handlers.
4704 These are set up by @command{$target_name configure -event} or
4705 @command{target create ... -event}.
4706
4707 The programmer's model matches the @code{-command} option used in Tcl/Tk
4708 buttons and events. The two examples below act the same, but one creates
4709 and invokes a small procedure while the other inlines it.
4710
4711 @example
4712 proc my_init_proc @{ @} @{
4713 echo "Disabling watchdog..."
4714 mww 0xfffffd44 0x00008000
4715 @}
4716 mychip.cpu configure -event reset-init my_init_proc
4717 mychip.cpu configure -event reset-init @{
4718 echo "Disabling watchdog..."
4719 mww 0xfffffd44 0x00008000
4720 @}
4721 @end example
4722
4723 The following target events are defined:
4724
4725 @itemize @bullet
4726 @item @b{debug-halted}
4727 @* The target has halted for debug reasons (i.e.: breakpoint)
4728 @item @b{debug-resumed}
4729 @* The target has resumed (i.e.: GDB said run)
4730 @item @b{early-halted}
4731 @* Occurs early in the halt process
4732 @item @b{examine-start}
4733 @* Before target examine is called.
4734 @item @b{examine-end}
4735 @* After target examine is called with no errors.
4736 @item @b{gdb-attach}
4737 @* When GDB connects. Issued before any GDB communication with the target
4738 starts. GDB expects the target is halted during attachment.
4739 @xref{gdbmeminspect,,GDB as a non-intrusive memory inspector}, how to
4740 connect GDB to running target.
4741 The event can be also used to set up the target so it is possible to probe flash.
4742 Probing flash is necessary during GDB connect if you want to use
4743 @pxref{programmingusinggdb,,programming using GDB}.
4744 Another use of the flash memory map is for GDB to automatically choose
4745 hardware or software breakpoints depending on whether the breakpoint
4746 is in RAM or read only memory.
4747 Default is @code{halt}
4748 @item @b{gdb-detach}
4749 @* When GDB disconnects
4750 @item @b{gdb-end}
4751 @* When the target has halted and GDB is not doing anything (see early halt)
4752 @item @b{gdb-flash-erase-start}
4753 @* Before the GDB flash process tries to erase the flash (default is
4754 @code{reset init})
4755 @item @b{gdb-flash-erase-end}
4756 @* After the GDB flash process has finished erasing the flash
4757 @item @b{gdb-flash-write-start}
4758 @* Before GDB writes to the flash
4759 @item @b{gdb-flash-write-end}
4760 @* After GDB writes to the flash (default is @code{reset halt})
4761 @item @b{gdb-start}
4762 @* Before the target steps, GDB is trying to start/resume the target
4763 @item @b{halted}
4764 @* The target has halted
4765 @item @b{reset-assert-pre}
4766 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4767 after @command{reset-start} was triggered
4768 but before either SRST alone is asserted on the scan chain,
4769 or @code{reset-assert} is triggered.
4770 @item @b{reset-assert}
4771 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4772 after @command{reset-assert-pre} was triggered.
4773 When such a handler is present, cores which support this event will use
4774 it instead of asserting SRST.
4775 This support is essential for debugging with JTAG interfaces which
4776 don't include an SRST line (JTAG doesn't require SRST), and for
4777 selective reset on scan chains that have multiple targets.
4778 @item @b{reset-assert-post}
4779 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4780 after @code{reset-assert} has been triggered.
4781 or the target asserted SRST on the entire scan chain.
4782 @item @b{reset-deassert-pre}
4783 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4784 after @code{reset-assert-post} has been triggered.
4785 @item @b{reset-deassert-post}
4786 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4787 after @code{reset-deassert-pre} has been triggered
4788 and (if the target is using it) after SRST has been
4789 released on the scan chain.
4790 @item @b{reset-end}
4791 @* Issued as the final step in @command{reset} processing.
4792 @item @b{reset-init}
4793 @* Used by @b{reset init} command for board-specific initialization.
4794 This event fires after @emph{reset-deassert-post}.
4795
4796 This is where you would configure PLLs and clocking, set up DRAM so
4797 you can download programs that don't fit in on-chip SRAM, set up pin
4798 multiplexing, and so on.
4799 (You may be able to switch to a fast JTAG clock rate here, after
4800 the target clocks are fully set up.)
4801 @item @b{reset-start}
4802 @* Issued as the first step in @command{reset} processing
4803 before @command{reset-assert-pre} is called.
4804
4805 This is the most robust place to use @command{jtag_rclk}
4806 or @command{adapter_khz} to switch to a low JTAG clock rate,
4807 when reset disables PLLs needed to use a fast clock.
4808 @item @b{resume-start}
4809 @* Before any target is resumed
4810 @item @b{resume-end}
4811 @* After all targets have resumed
4812 @item @b{resumed}
4813 @* Target has resumed
4814 @item @b{trace-config}
4815 @* After target hardware trace configuration was changed
4816 @end itemize
4817
4818 @node Flash Commands
4819 @chapter Flash Commands
4820
4821 OpenOCD has different commands for NOR and NAND flash;
4822 the ``flash'' command works with NOR flash, while
4823 the ``nand'' command works with NAND flash.
4824 This partially reflects different hardware technologies:
4825 NOR flash usually supports direct CPU instruction and data bus access,
4826 while data from a NAND flash must be copied to memory before it can be
4827 used. (SPI flash must also be copied to memory before use.)
4828 However, the documentation also uses ``flash'' as a generic term;
4829 for example, ``Put flash configuration in board-specific files''.
4830
4831 Flash Steps:
4832 @enumerate
4833 @item Configure via the command @command{flash bank}
4834 @* Do this in a board-specific configuration file,
4835 passing parameters as needed by the driver.
4836 @item Operate on the flash via @command{flash subcommand}
4837 @* Often commands to manipulate the flash are typed by a human, or run
4838 via a script in some automated way. Common tasks include writing a
4839 boot loader, operating system, or other data.
4840 @item GDB Flashing
4841 @* Flashing via GDB requires the flash be configured via ``flash
4842 bank'', and the GDB flash features be enabled.
4843 @xref{gdbconfiguration,,GDB Configuration}.
4844 @end enumerate
4845
4846 Many CPUs have the ability to ``boot'' from the first flash bank.
4847 This means that misprogramming that bank can ``brick'' a system,
4848 so that it can't boot.
4849 JTAG tools, like OpenOCD, are often then used to ``de-brick'' the
4850 board by (re)installing working boot firmware.
4851
4852 @anchor{norconfiguration}
4853 @section Flash Configuration Commands
4854 @cindex flash configuration
4855
4856 @deffn {Config Command} {flash bank} name driver base size chip_width bus_width target [driver_options]
4857 Configures a flash bank which provides persistent storage
4858 for addresses from @math{base} to @math{base + size - 1}.
4859 These banks will often be visible to GDB through the target's memory map.
4860 In some cases, configuring a flash bank will activate extra commands;
4861 see the driver-specific documentation.
4862
4863 @itemize @bullet
4864 @item @var{name} ... may be used to reference the flash bank
4865 in other flash commands. A number is also available.
4866 @item @var{driver} ... identifies the controller driver
4867 associated with the flash bank being declared.
4868 This is usually @code{cfi} for external flash, or else
4869 the name of a microcontroller with embedded flash memory.
4870 @xref{flashdriverlist,,Flash Driver List}.
4871 @item @var{base} ... Base address of the flash chip.
4872 @item @var{size} ... Size of the chip, in bytes.
4873 For some drivers, this value is detected from the hardware.
4874 @item @var{chip_width} ... Width of the flash chip, in bytes;
4875 ignored for most microcontroller drivers.
4876 @item @var{bus_width} ... Width of the data bus used to access the
4877 chip, in bytes; ignored for most microcontroller drivers.
4878 @item @var{target} ... Names the target used to issue
4879 commands to the flash controller.
4880 @comment Actually, it's currently a controller-specific parameter...
4881 @item @var{driver_options} ... drivers may support, or require,
4882 additional parameters. See the driver-specific documentation
4883 for more information.
4884 @end itemize
4885 @quotation Note
4886 This command is not available after OpenOCD initialization has completed.
4887 Use it in board specific configuration files, not interactively.
4888 @end quotation
4889 @end deffn
4890
4891 @comment the REAL name for this command is "ocd_flash_banks"
4892 @comment less confusing would be: "flash list" (like "nand list")
4893 @deffn Command {flash banks}
4894 Prints a one-line summary of each device that was
4895 declared using @command{flash bank}, numbered from zero.
4896 Note that this is the @emph{plural} form;
4897 the @emph{singular} form is a very different command.
4898 @end deffn
4899
4900 @deffn Command {flash list}
4901 Retrieves a list of associative arrays for each device that was
4902 declared using @command{flash bank}, numbered from zero.
4903 This returned list can be manipulated easily from within scripts.
4904 @end deffn
4905
4906 @deffn Command {flash probe} num
4907 Identify the flash, or validate the parameters of the configured flash. Operation
4908 depends on the flash type.
4909 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
4910 Most flash commands will implicitly @emph{autoprobe} the bank;
4911 flash drivers can distinguish between probing and autoprobing,
4912 but most don't bother.
4913 @end deffn
4914
4915 @section Erasing, Reading, Writing to Flash
4916 @cindex flash erasing
4917 @cindex flash reading
4918 @cindex flash writing
4919 @cindex flash programming
4920 @anchor{flashprogrammingcommands}
4921
4922 One feature distinguishing NOR flash from NAND or serial flash technologies
4923 is that for read access, it acts exactly like any other addressable memory.
4924 This means you can use normal memory read commands like @command{mdw} or
4925 @command{dump_image} with it, with no special @command{flash} subcommands.
4926 @xref{memoryaccess,,Memory access}, and @ref{imageaccess,,Image access}.
4927
4928 Write access works differently. Flash memory normally needs to be erased
4929 before it's written. Erasing a sector turns all of its bits to ones, and
4930 writing can turn ones into zeroes. This is why there are special commands
4931 for interactive erasing and writing, and why GDB needs to know which parts
4932 of the address space hold NOR flash memory.
4933
4934 @quotation Note
4935 Most of these erase and write commands leverage the fact that NOR flash
4936 chips consume target address space. They implicitly refer to the current
4937 JTAG target, and map from an address in that target's address space
4938 back to a flash bank.
4939 @comment In May 2009, those mappings may fail if any bank associated
4940 @comment with that target doesn't successfully autoprobe ... bug worth fixing?
4941 A few commands use abstract addressing based on bank and sector numbers,
4942 and don't depend on searching the current target and its address space.
4943 Avoid confusing the two command models.
4944 @end quotation
4945
4946 Some flash chips implement software protection against accidental writes,
4947 since such buggy writes could in some cases ``brick'' a system.
4948 For such systems, erasing and writing may require sector protection to be
4949 disabled first.
4950 Examples include CFI flash such as ``Intel Advanced Bootblock flash'',
4951 and AT91SAM7 on-chip flash.
4952 @xref{flashprotect,,flash protect}.
4953
4954 @deffn Command {flash erase_sector} num first last
4955 Erase sectors in bank @var{num}, starting at sector @var{first}
4956 up to and including @var{last}.
4957 Sector numbering starts at 0.
4958 Providing a @var{last} sector of @option{last}
4959 specifies "to the end of the flash bank".
4960 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
4961 @end deffn
4962
4963 @deffn Command {flash erase_address} [@option{pad}] [@option{unlock}] address length
4964 Erase sectors starting at @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
4965 Unless @option{pad} is specified, @math{address} must begin a
4966 flash sector, and @math{address + length - 1} must end a sector.
4967 Specifying @option{pad} erases extra data at the beginning and/or
4968 end of the specified region, as needed to erase only full sectors.
4969 The flash bank to use is inferred from the @var{address}, and
4970 the specified length must stay within that bank.
4971 As a special case, when @var{length} is zero and @var{address} is
4972 the start of the bank, the whole flash is erased.
4973 If @option{unlock} is specified, then the flash is unprotected
4974 before erase starts.
4975 @end deffn
4976
4977 @deffn Command {flash fillw} address word length
4978 @deffnx Command {flash fillh} address halfword length
4979 @deffnx Command {flash fillb} address byte length
4980 Fills flash memory with the specified @var{word} (32 bits),
4981 @var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) pattern,
4982 starting at @var{address} and continuing
4983 for @var{length} units (word/halfword/byte).
4984 No erasure is done before writing; when needed, that must be done
4985 before issuing this command.
4986 Writes are done in blocks of up to 1024 bytes, and each write is
4987 verified by reading back the data and comparing it to what was written.
4988 The flash bank to use is inferred from the @var{address} of
4989 each block, and the specified length must stay within that bank.
4990 @end deffn
4991 @comment no current checks for errors if fill blocks touch multiple banks!
4992
4993 @deffn Command {flash write_bank} num filename [offset]
4994 Write the binary @file{filename} to flash bank @var{num},
4995 starting at @var{offset} bytes from the beginning of the bank. If @var{offset}
4996 is omitted, start at the beginning of the flash bank.
4997 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
4998 @end deffn
4999
5000 @deffn Command {flash read_bank} num filename [offset [length]]
5001 Read @var{length} bytes from the flash bank @var{num} starting at @var{offset}
5002 and write the contents to the binary @file{filename}. If @var{offset} is
5003 omitted, start at the beginning of the flash bank. If @var{length} is omitted,
5004 read the remaining bytes from the flash bank.
5005 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5006 @end deffn
5007
5008 @deffn Command {flash verify_bank} num filename [offset]
5009 Compare the contents of the binary file @var{filename} with the contents of the
5010 flash bank @var{num} starting at @var{offset}. If @var{offset} is omitted,
5011 start at the beginning of the flash bank. Fail if the contents do not match.
5012 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5013 @end deffn
5014
5015 @deffn Command {flash write_image} [erase] [unlock] filename [offset] [type]
5016 Write the image @file{filename} to the current target's flash bank(s).
5017 Only loadable sections from the image are written.
5018 A relocation @var{offset} may be specified, in which case it is added
5019 to the base address for each section in the image.
5020 The file [@var{type}] can be specified
5021 explicitly as @option{bin} (binary), @option{ihex} (Intel hex),
5022 @option{elf} (ELF file), @option{s19} (Motorola s19).
5023 @option{mem}, or @option{builder}.
5024 The relevant flash sectors will be erased prior to programming
5025 if the @option{erase} parameter is given. If @option{unlock} is
5026 provided, then the flash banks are unlocked before erase and
5027 program. The flash bank to use is inferred from the address of
5028 each image section.
5029
5030 @quotation Warning
5031 Be careful using the @option{erase} flag when the flash is holding
5032 data you want to preserve.
5033 Portions of the flash outside those described in the image's
5034 sections might be erased with no notice.
5035 @itemize
5036 @item
5037 When a section of the image being written does not fill out all the
5038 sectors it uses, the unwritten parts of those sectors are necessarily
5039 also erased, because sectors can't be partially erased.
5040 @item
5041 Data stored in sector "holes" between image sections are also affected.
5042 For example, "@command{flash write_image erase ...}" of an image with
5043 one byte at the beginning of a flash bank and one byte at the end
5044 erases the entire bank -- not just the two sectors being written.
5045 @end itemize
5046 Also, when flash protection is important, you must re-apply it after
5047 it has been removed by the @option{unlock} flag.
5048 @end quotation
5049
5050 @end deffn
5051
5052 @section Other Flash commands
5053 @cindex flash protection
5054
5055 @deffn Command {flash erase_check} num
5056 Check erase state of sectors in flash bank @var{num},
5057 and display that status.
5058 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5059 @end deffn
5060
5061 @deffn Command {flash info} num [sectors]
5062 Print info about flash bank @var{num}, a list of protection blocks
5063 and their status. Use @option{sectors} to show a list of sectors instead.
5064
5065 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5066 This command will first query the hardware, it does not print cached
5067 and possibly stale information.
5068 @end deffn
5069
5070 @anchor{flashprotect}
5071 @deffn Command {flash protect} num first last (@option{on}|@option{off})
5072 Enable (@option{on}) or disable (@option{off}) protection of flash blocks
5073 in flash bank @var{num}, starting at protection block @var{first}
5074 and continuing up to and including @var{last}.
5075 Providing a @var{last} block of @option{last}
5076 specifies "to the end of the flash bank".
5077 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5078 The protection block is usually identical to a flash sector.
5079 Some devices may utilize a protection block distinct from flash sector.
5080 See @command{flash info} for a list of protection blocks.
5081 @end deffn
5082
5083 @deffn Command {flash padded_value} num value
5084 Sets the default value used for padding any image sections, This should
5085 normally match the flash bank erased value. If not specified by this
5086 command or the flash driver then it defaults to 0xff.
5087 @end deffn
5088
5089 @anchor{program}
5090 @deffn Command {program} filename [verify] [reset] [exit] [offset]
5091 This is a helper script that simplifies using OpenOCD as a standalone
5092 programmer. The only required parameter is @option{filename}, the others are optional.
5093 @xref{Flash Programming}.
5094 @end deffn
5095
5096 @anchor{flashdriverlist}
5097 @section Flash Driver List
5098 As noted above, the @command{flash bank} command requires a driver name,
5099 and allows driver-specific options and behaviors.
5100 Some drivers also activate driver-specific commands.
5101
5102 @deffn {Flash Driver} virtual
5103 This is a special driver that maps a previously defined bank to another
5104 address. All bank settings will be copied from the master physical bank.
5105
5106 The @var{virtual} driver defines one mandatory parameters,
5107
5108 @itemize
5109 @item @var{master_bank} The bank that this virtual address refers to.
5110 @end itemize
5111
5112 So in the following example addresses 0xbfc00000 and 0x9fc00000 refer to
5113 the flash bank defined at address 0x1fc00000. Any command executed on
5114 the virtual banks is actually performed on the physical banks.
5115 @example
5116 flash bank $_FLASHNAME pic32mx 0x1fc00000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5117 flash bank vbank0 virtual 0xbfc00000 0 0 0 \
5118 $_TARGETNAME $_FLASHNAME
5119 flash bank vbank1 virtual 0x9fc00000 0 0 0 \
5120 $_TARGETNAME $_FLASHNAME
5121 @end example
5122 @end deffn
5123
5124 @subsection External Flash
5125
5126 @deffn {Flash Driver} cfi
5127 @cindex Common Flash Interface
5128 @cindex CFI
5129 The ``Common Flash Interface'' (CFI) is the main standard for
5130 external NOR flash chips, each of which connects to a
5131 specific external chip select on the CPU.
5132 Frequently the first such chip is used to boot the system.
5133 Your board's @code{reset-init} handler might need to
5134 configure additional chip selects using other commands (like: @command{mww} to
5135 configure a bus and its timings), or
5136 perhaps configure a GPIO pin that controls the ``write protect'' pin
5137 on the flash chip.
5138 The CFI driver can use a target-specific working area to significantly
5139 speed up operation.
5140
5141 The CFI driver can accept the following optional parameters, in any order:
5142
5143 @itemize
5144 @item @var{jedec_probe} ... is used to detect certain non-CFI flash ROMs,
5145 like AM29LV010 and similar types.
5146 @item @var{x16_as_x8} ... when a 16-bit flash is hooked up to an 8-bit bus.
5147 @item @var{bus_swap} ... when data bytes in a 16-bit flash needs to be swapped.
5148 @item @var{data_swap} ... when data bytes in a 16-bit flash needs to be
5149 swapped when writing data values (i.e. not CFI commands).
5150 @end itemize
5151
5152 To configure two adjacent banks of 16 MBytes each, both sixteen bits (two bytes)
5153 wide on a sixteen bit bus:
5154
5155 @example
5156 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x00000000 0x01000000 2 2 $_TARGETNAME
5157 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x01000000 0x01000000 2 2 $_TARGETNAME
5158 @end example
5159
5160 To configure one bank of 32 MBytes
5161 built from two sixteen bit (two byte) wide parts wired in parallel
5162 to create a thirty-two bit (four byte) bus with doubled throughput:
5163
5164 @example
5165 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x00000000 0x02000000 2 4 $_TARGETNAME
5166 @end example
5167
5168 @c "cfi part_id" disabled
5169 @end deffn
5170
5171 @deffn {Flash Driver} jtagspi
5172 @cindex Generic JTAG2SPI driver
5173 @cindex SPI
5174 @cindex jtagspi
5175 @cindex bscan_spi
5176 Several FPGAs and CPLDs can retrieve their configuration (bitstream) from a
5177 SPI flash connected to them. To access this flash from the host, the device
5178 is first programmed with a special proxy bitstream that
5179 exposes the SPI flash on the device's JTAG interface. The flash can then be
5180 accessed through JTAG.
5181
5182 Since signaling between JTAG and SPI is compatible, all that is required for
5183 a proxy bitstream is to connect TDI-MOSI, TDO-MISO, TCK-CLK and activate
5184 the flash chip select when the JTAG state machine is in SHIFT-DR. Such
5185 a bitstream for several Xilinx FPGAs can be found in
5186 @file{contrib/loaders/flash/fpga/xilinx_bscan_spi.py}. It requires
5187 @uref{https://github.com/m-labs/migen, migen} and a Xilinx toolchain to build.
5188
5189 This flash bank driver requires a target on a JTAG tap and will access that
5190 tap directly. Since no support from the target is needed, the target can be a
5191 "testee" dummy. Since the target does not expose the flash memory
5192 mapping, target commands that would otherwise be expected to access the flash
5193 will not work. These include all @command{*_image} and
5194 @command{$target_name m*} commands as well as @command{program}. Equivalent
5195 functionality is available through the @command{flash write_bank},
5196 @command{flash read_bank}, and @command{flash verify_bank} commands.
5197
5198 @itemize
5199 @item @var{ir} ... is loaded into the JTAG IR to map the flash as the JTAG DR.
5200 For the bitstreams generated from @file{xilinx_bscan_spi.py} this is the
5201 @var{USER1} instruction.
5202 @end itemize
5203
5204 @example
5205 target create $_TARGETNAME testee -chain-position $_CHIPNAME.fpga
5206 set _XILINX_USER1 0x02
5207 flash bank $_FLASHNAME spi 0x0 0 0 0 \
5208 $_TARGETNAME $_XILINX_USER1
5209 @end example
5210 @end deffn
5211
5212 @deffn {Flash Driver} xcf
5213 @cindex Xilinx Platform flash driver
5214 @cindex xcf
5215 Xilinx FPGAs can be configured from specialized flash ICs named Platform Flash.
5216 It is (almost) regular NOR flash with erase sectors, program pages, etc. The
5217 only difference is special registers controlling its FPGA specific behavior.
5218 They must be properly configured for successful FPGA loading using
5219 additional @var{xcf} driver command:
5220
5221 @deffn Command {xcf ccb} <bank_id>
5222 command accepts additional parameters:
5223 @itemize
5224 @item @var{external|internal} ... selects clock source.
5225 @item @var{serial|parallel} ... selects serial or parallel data bus mode.
5226 @item @var{slave|master} ... selects slave of master mode for flash device.
5227 @item @var{40|20} ... selects clock frequency in MHz for internal clock
5228 in master mode.
5229 @end itemize
5230 @example
5231 xcf ccb 0 external parallel slave 40
5232 @end example
5233 All of them must be specified even if clock frequency is pointless
5234 in slave mode. If only bank id specified than command prints current
5235 CCB register value. Note: there is no need to write this register
5236 every time you erase/program data sectors because it stores in
5237 dedicated sector.
5238 @end deffn
5239
5240 @deffn Command {xcf configure} <bank_id>
5241 Initiates FPGA loading procedure. Useful if your board has no "configure"
5242 button.
5243 @example
5244 xcf configure 0
5245 @end example
5246 @end deffn
5247
5248 Additional driver notes:
5249 @itemize
5250 @item Only single revision supported.
5251 @item Driver automatically detects need of bit reverse, but
5252 only "bin" (raw binary, do not confuse it with "bit") and "mcs"
5253 (Intel hex) file types supported.
5254 @item For additional info check xapp972.pdf and ug380.pdf.
5255 @end itemize
5256 @end deffn
5257
5258 @deffn {Flash Driver} lpcspifi
5259 @cindex NXP SPI Flash Interface
5260 @cindex SPIFI
5261 @cindex lpcspifi
5262 NXP's LPC43xx and LPC18xx families include a proprietary SPI
5263 Flash Interface (SPIFI) peripheral that can drive and provide
5264 memory mapped access to external SPI flash devices.
5265
5266 The lpcspifi driver initializes this interface and provides
5267 program and erase functionality for these serial flash devices.
5268 Use of this driver @b{requires} a working area of at least 1kB
5269 to be configured on the target device; more than this will
5270 significantly reduce flash programming times.
5271
5272 The setup command only requires the @var{base} parameter. All
5273 other parameters are ignored, and the flash size and layout
5274 are configured by the driver.
5275
5276 @example
5277 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpcspifi 0x14000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5278 @end example
5279
5280 @end deffn
5281
5282 @deffn {Flash Driver} stmsmi
5283 @cindex STMicroelectronics Serial Memory Interface
5284 @cindex SMI
5285 @cindex stmsmi
5286 Some devices from STMicroelectronics (e.g. STR75x MCU family,
5287 SPEAr MPU family) include a proprietary
5288 ``Serial Memory Interface'' (SMI) controller able to drive external
5289 SPI flash devices.
5290 Depending on specific device and board configuration, up to 4 external
5291 flash devices can be connected.
5292
5293 SMI makes the flash content directly accessible in the CPU address
5294 space; each external device is mapped in a memory bank.
5295 CPU can directly read data, execute code and boot from SMI banks.
5296 Normal OpenOCD commands like @command{mdw} can be used to display
5297 the flash content.
5298
5299 The setup command only requires the @var{base} parameter in order
5300 to identify the memory bank.
5301 All other parameters are ignored. Additional information, like
5302 flash size, are detected automatically.
5303
5304 @example
5305 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stmsmi 0xf8000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5306 @end example
5307
5308 @end deffn
5309
5310 @deffn {Flash Driver} mrvlqspi
5311 This driver supports QSPI flash controller of Marvell's Wireless
5312 Microcontroller platform.
5313
5314 The flash size is autodetected based on the table of known JEDEC IDs
5315 hardcoded in the OpenOCD sources.
5316
5317 @example
5318 flash bank $_FLASHNAME mrvlqspi 0x0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 0x46010000
5319 @end example
5320
5321 @end deffn
5322
5323 @deffn {Flash Driver} ath79
5324 @cindex Atheros ath79 SPI driver
5325 @cindex ath79
5326 Members of ATH79 SoC family from Atheros include a SPI interface with 3
5327 chip selects.
5328 On reset a SPI flash connected to the first chip select (CS0) is made
5329 directly read-accessible in the CPU address space (up to 16MBytes)
5330 and is usually used to store the bootloader and operating system.
5331 Normal OpenOCD commands like @command{mdw} can be used to display
5332 the flash content while it is in memory-mapped mode (only the first
5333 4MBytes are accessible without additional configuration on reset).
5334
5335 The setup command only requires the @var{base} parameter in order
5336 to identify the memory bank. The actual value for the base address
5337 is not otherwise used by the driver. However the mapping is passed
5338 to gdb. Thus for the memory mapped flash (chipselect CS0) the base
5339 address should be the actual memory mapped base address. For unmapped
5340 chipselects (CS1 and CS2) care should be taken to use a base address
5341 that does not overlap with real memory regions.
5342 Additional information, like flash size, are detected automatically.
5343 An optional additional parameter sets the chipselect for the bank,
5344 with the default CS0.
5345 CS1 and CS2 require additional GPIO setup before they can be used
5346 since the alternate function must be enabled on the GPIO pin
5347 CS1/CS2 is routed to on the given SoC.
5348
5349 @example
5350 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ath79 0xbf000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5351
5352 # When using multiple chipselects the base should be different for each,
5353 # otherwise the write_image command is not able to distinguish the
5354 # banks.
5355 flash bank flash0 ath79 0xbf000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME cs0
5356 flash bank flash1 ath79 0x10000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME cs1
5357 flash bank flash2 ath79 0x20000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME cs2
5358 @end example
5359
5360 @end deffn
5361
5362 @subsection Internal Flash (Microcontrollers)
5363
5364 @deffn {Flash Driver} aduc702x
5365 The ADUC702x analog microcontrollers from Analog Devices
5366 include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
5367 The aduc702x flash driver works with models ADUC7019 through ADUC7028.
5368 The setup command only requires the @var{target} argument
5369 since all devices in this family have the same memory layout.
5370
5371 @example
5372 flash bank $_FLASHNAME aduc702x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5373 @end example
5374 @end deffn
5375
5376 @deffn {Flash Driver} ambiqmicro
5377 @cindex ambiqmicro
5378 @cindex apollo
5379 All members of the Apollo microcontroller family from
5380 Ambiq Micro include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
5381 The host connects over USB to an FTDI interface that communicates
5382 with the target using SWD.
5383
5384 The @var{ambiqmicro} driver reads the Chip Information Register detect
5385 the device class of the MCU.
5386 The Flash and SRAM sizes directly follow device class, and are used
5387 to set up the flash banks.
5388 If this fails, the driver will use default values set to the minimum
5389 sizes of an Apollo chip.
5390
5391 All Apollo chips have two flash banks of the same size.
5392 In all cases the first flash bank starts at location 0,
5393 and the second bank starts after the first.
5394
5395 @example
5396 # Flash bank 0
5397 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ambiqmicro 0 0x00040000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5398 # Flash bank 1 - same size as bank0, starts after bank 0.
5399 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ambiqmicro 0x00040000 0x00040000 0 0 \
5400 $_TARGETNAME
5401 @end example
5402
5403 Flash is programmed using custom entry points into the bootloader.
5404 This is the only way to program the flash as no flash control registers
5405 are available to the user.
5406
5407 The @var{ambiqmicro} driver adds some additional commands:
5408
5409 @deffn Command {ambiqmicro mass_erase} <bank>
5410 Erase entire bank.
5411 @end deffn
5412 @deffn Command {ambiqmicro page_erase} <bank> <first> <last>
5413 Erase device pages.
5414 @end deffn
5415 @deffn Command {ambiqmicro program_otp} <bank> <offset> <count>
5416 Program OTP is a one time operation to create write protected flash.
5417 The user writes sectors to SRAM starting at 0x10000010.
5418 Program OTP will write these sectors from SRAM to flash, and write protect
5419 the flash.
5420 @end deffn
5421 @end deffn
5422
5423 @anchor{at91samd}
5424 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91samd
5425 @cindex at91samd
5426 All members of the ATSAMD, ATSAMR, ATSAML and ATSAMC microcontroller
5427 families from Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M0+ core.
5428 This driver uses the same command names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
5429
5430 @deffn Command {at91samd chip-erase}
5431 Issues a complete Flash erase via the Device Service Unit (DSU). This can be
5432 used to erase a chip back to its factory state and does not require the
5433 processor to be halted.
5434 @end deffn
5435
5436 @deffn Command {at91samd set-security}
5437 Secures the Flash via the Set Security Bit (SSB) command. This prevents access
5438 to the Flash and can only be undone by using the chip-erase command which
5439 erases the Flash contents and turns off the security bit. Warning: at this
5440 time, openocd will not be able to communicate with a secured chip and it is
5441 therefore not possible to chip-erase it without using another tool.
5442
5443 @example
5444 at91samd set-security enable
5445 @end example
5446 @end deffn
5447
5448 @deffn Command {at91samd eeprom}
5449 Shows or sets the EEPROM emulation size configuration, stored in the User Row
5450 of the Flash. When setting, the EEPROM size must be specified in bytes and it
5451 must be one of the permitted sizes according to the datasheet. Settings are
5452 written immediately but only take effect on MCU reset. EEPROM emulation
5453 requires additional firmware support and the minimum EEPROM size may not be
5454 the same as the minimum that the hardware supports. Set the EEPROM size to 0
5455 in order to disable this feature.
5456
5457 @example
5458 at91samd eeprom
5459 at91samd eeprom 1024
5460 @end example
5461 @end deffn
5462
5463 @deffn Command {at91samd bootloader}
5464 Shows or sets the bootloader size configuration, stored in the User Row of the
5465 Flash. This is called the BOOTPROT region. When setting, the bootloader size
5466 must be specified in bytes and it must be one of the permitted sizes according
5467 to the datasheet. Settings are written immediately but only take effect on
5468 MCU reset. Setting the bootloader size to 0 disables bootloader protection.
5469
5470 @example
5471 at91samd bootloader
5472 at91samd bootloader 16384
5473 @end example
5474 @end deffn
5475
5476 @deffn Command {at91samd dsu_reset_deassert}
5477 This command releases internal reset held by DSU
5478 and prepares reset vector catch in case of reset halt.
5479 Command is used internally in event event reset-deassert-post.
5480 @end deffn
5481
5482 @deffn Command {at91samd nvmuserrow}
5483 Writes or reads the entire 64 bit wide NVM user row register which is located at
5484 0x804000. This register includes various fuses lock-bits and factory calibration
5485 data. Reading the register is done by invoking this command without any
5486 arguments. Writing is possible by giving 1 or 2 hex values. The first argument
5487 is the register value to be written and the second one is an optional changemask.
5488 Every bit which value in changemask is 0 will stay unchanged. The lock- and
5489 reserved-bits are masked out and cannot be changed.
5490
5491 @example
5492 # Read user row
5493 >at91samd nvmuserrow
5494 NVMUSERROW: 0xFFFFFC5DD8E0C788
5495 # Write 0xFFFFFC5DD8E0C788 to user row
5496 >at91samd nvmuserrow 0xFFFFFC5DD8E0C788
5497 # Write 0x12300 to user row but leave other bits and low byte unchanged
5498 >at91samd nvmuserrow 0x12345 0xFFF00
5499 @end example
5500 @end deffn
5501
5502 @end deffn
5503
5504 @anchor{at91sam3}
5505 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91sam3
5506 @cindex at91sam3
5507 All members of the AT91SAM3 microcontroller family from
5508 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M3 core. The driver
5509 currently (6/22/09) recognizes the AT91SAM3U[1/2/4][C/E] chips. Note
5510 that the driver was orginaly developed and tested using the
5511 AT91SAM3U4E, using a SAM3U-EK eval board. Support for other chips in
5512 the family was cribbed from the data sheet. @emph{Note to future
5513 readers/updaters: Please remove this worrisome comment after other
5514 chips are confirmed.}
5515
5516 The AT91SAM3U4[E/C] (256K) chips have two flash banks; most other chips
5517 have one flash bank. In all cases the flash banks are at
5518 the following fixed locations:
5519
5520 @example
5521 # Flash bank 0 - all chips
5522 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam3 0x00080000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
5523 # Flash bank 1 - only 256K chips
5524 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam3 0x00100000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
5525 @end example
5526
5527 Internally, the AT91SAM3 flash memory is organized as follows.
5528 Unlike the AT91SAM7 chips, these are not used as parameters
5529 to the @command{flash bank} command:
5530
5531 @itemize
5532 @item @emph{N-Banks:} 256K chips have 2 banks, others have 1 bank.
5533 @item @emph{Bank Size:} 128K/64K Per flash bank
5534 @item @emph{Sectors:} 16 or 8 per bank
5535 @item @emph{SectorSize:} 8K Per Sector
5536 @item @emph{PageSize:} 256 bytes per page. Note that OpenOCD operates on 'sector' sizes, not page sizes.
5537 @end itemize
5538
5539 The AT91SAM3 driver adds some additional commands:
5540
5541 @deffn Command {at91sam3 gpnvm}
5542 @deffnx Command {at91sam3 gpnvm clear} number
5543 @deffnx Command {at91sam3 gpnvm set} number
5544 @deffnx Command {at91sam3 gpnvm show} [@option{all}|number]
5545 With no parameters, @command{show} or @command{show all},
5546 shows the status of all GPNVM bits.
5547 With @command{show} @var{number}, displays that bit.
5548
5549 With @command{set} @var{number} or @command{clear} @var{number},
5550 modifies that GPNVM bit.
5551 @end deffn
5552
5553 @deffn Command {at91sam3 info}
5554 This command attempts to display information about the AT91SAM3
5555 chip. @emph{First} it read the @code{CHIPID_CIDR} [address 0x400e0740, see
5556 Section 28.2.1, page 505 of the AT91SAM3U 29/may/2009 datasheet,
5557 document id: doc6430A] and decodes the values. @emph{Second} it reads the
5558 various clock configuration registers and attempts to display how it
5559 believes the chip is configured. By default, the SLOWCLK is assumed to
5560 be 32768 Hz, see the command @command{at91sam3 slowclk}.
5561 @end deffn
5562
5563 @deffn Command {at91sam3 slowclk} [value]
5564 This command shows/sets the slow clock frequency used in the
5565 @command{at91sam3 info} command calculations above.
5566 @end deffn
5567 @end deffn
5568
5569 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91sam4
5570 @cindex at91sam4
5571 All members of the AT91SAM4 microcontroller family from
5572 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
5573 This driver uses the same command names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
5574 @end deffn
5575
5576 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91sam4l
5577 @cindex at91sam4l
5578 All members of the AT91SAM4L microcontroller family from
5579 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
5580 This driver uses the same command names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
5581
5582 The AT91SAM4L driver adds some additional commands:
5583 @deffn Command {at91sam4l smap_reset_deassert}
5584 This command releases internal reset held by SMAP
5585 and prepares reset vector catch in case of reset halt.
5586 Command is used internally in event event reset-deassert-post.
5587 @end deffn
5588 @end deffn
5589
5590 @deffn {Flash Driver} atsamv
5591 @cindex atsamv
5592 All members of the ATSAMV, ATSAMS, and ATSAME families from
5593 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M7 core.
5594 This driver uses the same command names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
5595 @end deffn
5596
5597 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91sam7
5598 All members of the AT91SAM7 microcontroller family from Atmel include
5599 internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores. The driver automatically
5600 recognizes a number of these chips using the chip identification
5601 register, and autoconfigures itself.
5602
5603 @example
5604 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam7 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5605 @end example
5606
5607 For chips which are not recognized by the controller driver, you must
5608 provide additional parameters in the following order:
5609
5610 @itemize
5611 @item @var{chip_model} ... label used with @command{flash info}
5612 @item @var{banks}
5613 @item @var{sectors_per_bank}
5614 @item @var{pages_per_sector}
5615 @item @var{pages_size}
5616 @item @var{num_nvm_bits}
5617 @item @var{freq_khz} ... required if an external clock is provided,
5618 optional (but recommended) when the oscillator frequency is known
5619 @end itemize
5620
5621 It is recommended that you provide zeroes for all of those values
5622 except the clock frequency, so that everything except that frequency
5623 will be autoconfigured.
5624 Knowing the frequency helps ensure correct timings for flash access.
5625
5626 The flash controller handles erases automatically on a page (128/256 byte)
5627 basis, so explicit erase commands are not necessary for flash programming.
5628 However, there is an ``EraseAll`` command that can erase an entire flash
5629 plane (of up to 256KB), and it will be used automatically when you issue
5630 @command{flash erase_sector} or @command{flash erase_address} commands.
5631
5632 @deffn Command {at91sam7 gpnvm} bitnum (@option{set}|@option{clear})
5633 Set or clear a ``General Purpose Non-Volatile Memory'' (GPNVM)
5634 bit for the processor. Each processor has a number of such bits,
5635 used for controlling features such as brownout detection (so they
5636 are not truly general purpose).
5637 @quotation Note
5638 This assumes that the first flash bank (number 0) is associated with
5639 the appropriate at91sam7 target.
5640 @end quotation
5641 @end deffn
5642 @end deffn
5643
5644 @deffn {Flash Driver} avr
5645 The AVR 8-bit microcontrollers from Atmel integrate flash memory.
5646 @emph{The current implementation is incomplete.}
5647 @comment - defines mass_erase ... pointless given flash_erase_address
5648 @end deffn
5649
5650 @deffn {Flash Driver} bluenrg-x
5651 STMicroelectronics BlueNRG-1 and BlueNRG-2 Bluetooth low energy wireless system-on-chip. They include ARM Cortex-M0 core and internal flash memory.
5652 The driver automatically recognizes these chips using
5653 the chip identification registers, and autoconfigures itself.
5654
5655 @example
5656 flash bank $_FLASHNAME bluenrg-x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5657 @end example
5658
5659 Note that when users ask to erase all the sectors of the flash, a mass erase command is used which is faster than erasing
5660 each single sector one by one.
5661
5662 @example
5663 flash erase_sector 0 0 79 # It will perform a mass erase on BlueNRG-1
5664 @end example
5665
5666 @example
5667 flash erase_sector 0 0 127 # It will perform a mass erase on BlueNRG-2
5668 @end example
5669
5670 Triggering a mass erase is also useful when users want to disable readout protection.
5671 @end deffn
5672
5673 @deffn {Flash Driver} cc26xx
5674 All versions of the SimpleLink CC13xx and CC26xx microcontrollers from Texas
5675 Instruments include internal flash. The cc26xx flash driver supports both the
5676 CC13xx and CC26xx family of devices. The driver automatically recognizes the
5677 specific version's flash parameters and autoconfigures itself. The flash bank
5678 starts at address 0.
5679
5680 @example
5681 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cc26xx 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5682 @end example
5683 @end deffn
5684
5685 @deffn {Flash Driver} cc3220sf
5686 The CC3220SF version of the SimpleLink CC32xx microcontrollers from Texas
5687 Instruments includes 1MB of internal flash. The cc3220sf flash driver only
5688 supports the internal flash. The serial flash on SimpleLink boards is
5689 programmed via the bootloader over a UART connection. Security features of
5690 the CC3220SF may erase the internal flash during power on reset. Refer to
5691 documentation at @url{www.ti.com/cc3220sf} for details on security features
5692 and programming the serial flash.
5693
5694 @example
5695 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cc3220sf 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5696 @end example
5697 @end deffn
5698
5699 @deffn {Flash Driver} efm32
5700 All members of the EFM32 microcontroller family from Energy Micro include
5701 internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores. The driver automatically recognizes
5702 a number of these chips using the chip identification register, and
5703 autoconfigures itself.
5704 @example
5705 flash bank $_FLASHNAME efm32 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5706 @end example
5707 A special feature of efm32 controllers is that it is possible to completely disable the
5708 debug interface by writing the correct values to the 'Debug Lock Word'. OpenOCD supports
5709 this via the following command:
5710 @example
5711 efm32 debuglock num
5712 @end example
5713 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5714 Note that in order for this command to take effect, the target needs to be reset.
5715 @emph{The current implementation is incomplete. Unprotecting flash pages is not
5716 supported.}
5717 @end deffn
5718
5719 @deffn {Flash Driver} esirisc
5720 Members of the eSi-RISC family may optionally include internal flash programmed
5721 via the eSi-TSMC Flash interface. Additional parameters are required to
5722 configure the driver: @option{cfg_address} is the base address of the
5723 configuration register interface, @option{clock_hz} is the expected clock
5724 frequency, and @option{wait_states} is the number of configured read wait states.
5725
5726 @example
5727 flash bank $_FLASHNAME esirisc base_address size_bytes 0 0 \
5728 $_TARGETNAME cfg_address clock_hz wait_states
5729 @end example
5730
5731 @deffn Command {esirisc flash mass_erase} bank_id
5732 Erase all pages in data memory for the bank identified by @option{bank_id}.
5733 @end deffn
5734
5735 @deffn Command {esirisc flash ref_erase} bank_id
5736 Erase the reference cell for the bank identified by @option{bank_id}. @emph{This
5737 is an uncommon operation.}
5738 @end deffn
5739 @end deffn
5740
5741 @deffn {Flash Driver} fm3
5742 All members of the FM3 microcontroller family from Fujitsu
5743 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
5744 The @var{fm3} driver uses the @var{target} parameter to select the
5745 correct bank config, it can currently be one of the following:
5746 @code{mb9bfxx1.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx2.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx3.cpu},
5747 @code{mb9bfxx4.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx5.cpu} or @code{mb9bfxx6.cpu}.
5748
5749 @example
5750 flash bank $_FLASHNAME fm3 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5751 @end example
5752 @end deffn
5753
5754 @deffn {Flash Driver} fm4
5755 All members of the FM4 microcontroller family from Spansion (formerly Fujitsu)
5756 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M4 cores.
5757 The @var{fm4} driver uses a @var{family} parameter to select the
5758 correct bank config, it can currently be one of the following:
5759 @code{MB9BFx64}, @code{MB9BFx65}, @code{MB9BFx66}, @code{MB9BFx67}, @code{MB9BFx68},
5760 @code{S6E2Cx8}, @code{S6E2Cx9}, @code{S6E2CxA} or @code{S6E2Dx},
5761 with @code{x} treated as wildcard and otherwise case (and any trailing
5762 characters) ignored.
5763
5764 @example
5765 flash bank $@{_FLASHNAME@}0 fm4 0x00000000 0 0 0 \
5766 $_TARGETNAME S6E2CCAJ0A
5767 flash bank $@{_FLASHNAME@}1 fm4 0x00100000 0 0 0 \
5768 $_TARGETNAME S6E2CCAJ0A
5769 @end example
5770 @emph{The current implementation is incomplete. Protection is not supported,
5771 nor is Chip Erase (only Sector Erase is implemented).}
5772 @end deffn
5773
5774 @deffn {Flash Driver} kinetis
5775 @cindex kinetis
5776 Kx, KLx, KVx and KE1x members of the Kinetis microcontroller family
5777 from NXP (former Freescale) include
5778 internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0+ or M4 cores. The driver automatically
5779 recognizes flash size and a number of flash banks (1-4) using the chip
5780 identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
5781 Use kinetis_ke driver for KE0x and KEAx devices.
5782
5783 The @var{kinetis} driver defines option:
5784 @itemize
5785 @item -sim-base @var{addr} ... base of System Integration Module where chip identification resides. Driver tries two known locations if option is omitted.
5786 @end itemize
5787
5788 @example
5789 flash bank $_FLASHNAME kinetis 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5790 @end example
5791
5792 @deffn Command {kinetis create_banks}
5793 Configuration command enables automatic creation of additional flash banks
5794 based on real flash layout of device. Banks are created during device probe.
5795 Use 'flash probe 0' to force probe.
5796 @end deffn
5797
5798 @deffn Command {kinetis fcf_source} [protection|write]
5799 Select what source is used when writing to a Flash Configuration Field.
5800 @option{protection} mode builds FCF content from protection bits previously
5801 set by 'flash protect' command.
5802 This mode is default. MCU is protected from unwanted locking by immediate
5803 writing FCF after erase of relevant sector.
5804 @option{write} mode enables direct write to FCF.
5805 Protection cannot be set by 'flash protect' command. FCF is written along
5806 with the rest of a flash image.
5807 @emph{BEWARE: Incorrect flash configuration may permanently lock the device!}
5808 @end deffn
5809
5810 @deffn Command {kinetis fopt} [num]
5811 Set value to write to FOPT byte of Flash Configuration Field.
5812 Used in kinetis 'fcf_source protection' mode only.
5813 @end deffn
5814
5815 @deffn Command {kinetis mdm check_security}
5816 Checks status of device security lock. Used internally in examine-end event.
5817 @end deffn
5818
5819 @deffn Command {kinetis mdm halt}
5820 Issues a halt via the MDM-AP. This command can be used to break a watchdog reset
5821 loop when connecting to an unsecured target.
5822 @end deffn
5823
5824 @deffn Command {kinetis mdm mass_erase}
5825 Issues a complete flash erase via the MDM-AP. This can be used to erase a chip
5826 back to its factory state, removing security. It does not require the processor
5827 to be halted, however the target will remain in a halted state after this
5828 command completes.
5829 @end deffn
5830
5831 @deffn Command {kinetis nvm_partition}
5832 For FlexNVM devices only (KxxDX and KxxFX).
5833 Command shows or sets data flash or EEPROM backup size in kilobytes,
5834 sets two EEPROM blocks sizes in bytes and enables/disables loading
5835 of EEPROM contents to FlexRAM during reset.
5836
5837 For details see device reference manual, Flash Memory Module,
5838 Program Partition command.
5839
5840 Setting is possible only once after mass_erase.
5841 Reset the device after partition setting.
5842
5843 Show partition size:
5844 @example
5845 kinetis nvm_partition info
5846 @end example
5847
5848 Set 32 KB data flash, rest of FlexNVM is EEPROM backup. EEPROM has two blocks
5849 of 512 and 1536 bytes and its contents is loaded to FlexRAM during reset:
5850 @example
5851 kinetis nvm_partition dataflash 32 512 1536 on
5852 @end example
5853
5854 Set 16 KB EEPROM backup, rest of FlexNVM is a data flash. EEPROM has two blocks
5855 of 1024 bytes and its contents is not loaded to FlexRAM during reset:
5856 @example
5857 kinetis nvm_partition eebkp 16 1024 1024 off
5858 @end example
5859 @end deffn
5860
5861 @deffn Command {kinetis mdm reset}
5862 Issues a reset via the MDM-AP. This causes the MCU to output a low pulse on the
5863 RESET pin, which can be used to reset other hardware on board.
5864 @end deffn
5865
5866 @deffn Command {kinetis disable_wdog}
5867 For Kx devices only (KLx has different COP watchdog, it is not supported).
5868 Command disables watchdog timer.
5869 @end deffn
5870 @end deffn
5871
5872 @deffn {Flash Driver} kinetis_ke
5873 @cindex kinetis_ke
5874 KE0x and KEAx members of the Kinetis microcontroller family from NXP include
5875 internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0+. The driver automatically recognizes
5876 the KE0x sub-family using the chip identification register, and
5877 autoconfigures itself.
5878 Use kinetis (not kinetis_ke) driver for KE1x devices.
5879
5880 @example
5881 flash bank $_FLASHNAME kinetis_ke 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5882 @end example
5883
5884 @deffn Command {kinetis_ke mdm check_security}
5885 Checks status of device security lock. Used internally in examine-end event.
5886 @end deffn
5887
5888 @deffn Command {kinetis_ke mdm mass_erase}
5889 Issues a complete Flash erase via the MDM-AP.
5890 This can be used to erase a chip back to its factory state.
5891 Command removes security lock from a device (use of SRST highly recommended).
5892 It does not require the processor to be halted.
5893 @end deffn
5894
5895 @deffn Command {kinetis_ke disable_wdog}
5896 Command disables watchdog timer.
5897 @end deffn
5898 @end deffn
5899
5900 @deffn {Flash Driver} lpc2000
5901 This is the driver to support internal flash of all members of the
5902 LPC11(x)00 and LPC1300 microcontroller families and most members of
5903 the LPC800, LPC1500, LPC1700, LPC1800, LPC2000, LPC4000, LPC54100,
5904 LPC8Nxx and NHS31xx microcontroller families from NXP.
5905
5906 @quotation Note
5907 There are LPC2000 devices which are not supported by the @var{lpc2000}
5908 driver:
5909 The LPC2888 is supported by the @var{lpc288x} driver.
5910 The LPC29xx family is supported by the @var{lpc2900} driver.
5911 @end quotation
5912
5913 The @var{lpc2000} driver defines two mandatory and two optional parameters,
5914 which must appear in the following order:
5915
5916 @itemize
5917 @item @var{variant} ... required, may be
5918 @option{lpc2000_v1} (older LPC21xx and LPC22xx)
5919 @option{lpc2000_v2} (LPC213x, LPC214x, LPC210[123], LPC23xx and LPC24xx)
5920 @option{lpc1700} (LPC175x and LPC176x and LPC177x/8x)
5921 @option{lpc4300} - available also as @option{lpc1800} alias (LPC18x[2357] and
5922 LPC43x[2357])
5923 @option{lpc800} (LPC8xx)
5924 @option{lpc1100} (LPC11(x)xx and LPC13xx)
5925 @option{lpc1500} (LPC15xx)
5926 @option{lpc54100} (LPC541xx)
5927 @option{lpc4000} (LPC40xx)
5928 or @option{auto} - automatically detects flash variant and size for LPC11(x)00,
5929 LPC8xx, LPC13xx, LPC17xx, LPC40xx, LPC8Nxx and NHS31xx
5930 @item @var{clock_kHz} ... the frequency, in kiloHertz,
5931 at which the core is running
5932 @item @option{calc_checksum} ... optional (but you probably want to provide this!),
5933 telling the driver to calculate a valid checksum for the exception vector table.
5934 @quotation Note
5935 If you don't provide @option{calc_checksum} when you're writing the vector
5936 table, the boot ROM will almost certainly ignore your flash image.
5937 However, if you do provide it,
5938 with most tool chains @command{verify_image} will fail.
5939 @end quotation
5940 @item @option{iap_entry} ... optional telling the driver to use a different
5941 ROM IAP entry point.
5942 @end itemize
5943
5944 LPC flashes don't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
5945
5946 @example
5947 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2000 0x0 0x7d000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME \
5948 lpc2000_v2 14765 calc_checksum
5949 @end example
5950
5951 @deffn {Command} {lpc2000 part_id} bank
5952 Displays the four byte part identifier associated with
5953 the specified flash @var{bank}.
5954 @end deffn
5955 @end deffn
5956
5957 @deffn {Flash Driver} lpc288x
5958 The LPC2888 microcontroller from NXP needs slightly different flash
5959 support from its lpc2000 siblings.
5960 The @var{lpc288x} driver defines one mandatory parameter,
5961 the programming clock rate in Hz.
5962 LPC flashes don't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
5963
5964 @example
5965 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc288x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 12000000
5966 @end example
5967 @end deffn
5968
5969 @deffn {Flash Driver} lpc2900
5970 This driver supports the LPC29xx ARM968E based microcontroller family
5971 from NXP.
5972
5973 The predefined parameters @var{base}, @var{size}, @var{chip_width} and
5974 @var{bus_width} of the @code{flash bank} command are ignored. Flash size and
5975 sector layout are auto-configured by the driver.
5976 The driver has one additional mandatory parameter: The CPU clock rate
5977 (in kHz) at the time the flash operations will take place. Most of the time this
5978 will not be the crystal frequency, but a higher PLL frequency. The
5979 @code{reset-init} event handler in the board script is usually the place where
5980 you start the PLL.
5981
5982 The driver rejects flashless devices (currently the LPC2930).
5983
5984 The EEPROM in LPC2900 devices is not mapped directly into the address space.
5985 It must be handled much more like NAND flash memory, and will therefore be
5986 handled by a separate @code{lpc2900_eeprom} driver (not yet available).
5987
5988 Sector protection in terms of the LPC2900 is handled transparently. Every time a
5989 sector needs to be erased or programmed, it is automatically unprotected.
5990 What is shown as protection status in the @code{flash info} command, is
5991 actually the LPC2900 @emph{sector security}. This is a mechanism to prevent a
5992 sector from ever being erased or programmed again. As this is an irreversible
5993 mechanism, it is handled by a special command (@code{lpc2900 secure_sector}),
5994 and not by the standard @code{flash protect} command.
5995
5996 Example for a 125 MHz clock frequency:
5997 @example
5998 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2900 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 125000
5999 @end example
6000
6001 Some @code{lpc2900}-specific commands are defined. In the following command list,
6002 the @var{bank} parameter is the bank number as obtained by the
6003 @code{flash banks} command.
6004
6005 @deffn Command {lpc2900 signature} bank
6006 Calculates a 128-bit hash value, the @emph{signature}, from the whole flash
6007 content. This is a hardware feature of the flash block, hence the calculation is
6008 very fast. You may use this to verify the content of a programmed device against
6009 a known signature.
6010 Example:
6011 @example
6012 lpc2900 signature 0
6013 signature: 0x5f40cdc8:0xc64e592e:0x10490f89:0x32a0f317
6014 @end example
6015 @end deffn
6016
6017 @deffn Command {lpc2900 read_custom} bank filename
6018 Reads the 912 bytes of customer information from the flash index sector, and
6019 saves it to a file in binary format.
6020 Example:
6021 @example
6022 lpc2900 read_custom 0 /path_to/customer_info.bin
6023 @end example
6024 @end deffn
6025
6026 The index sector of the flash is a @emph{write-only} sector. It cannot be
6027 erased! In order to guard against unintentional write access, all following
6028 commands need to be preceded by a successful call to the @code{password}
6029 command:
6030
6031 @deffn Command {lpc2900 password} bank password
6032 You need to use this command right before each of the following commands:
6033 @code{lpc2900 write_custom}, @code{lpc2900 secure_sector},
6034 @code{lpc2900 secure_jtag}.
6035
6036 The password string is fixed to "I_know_what_I_am_doing".
6037 Example:
6038 @example
6039 lpc2900 password 0 I_know_what_I_am_doing
6040 Potentially dangerous operation allowed in next command!
6041 @end example
6042 @end deffn
6043
6044 @deffn Command {lpc2900 write_custom} bank filename type
6045 Writes the content of the file into the customer info space of the flash index
6046 sector. The filetype can be specified with the @var{type} field. Possible values
6047 for @var{type} are: @var{bin} (binary), @var{ihex} (Intel hex format),
6048 @var{elf} (ELF binary) or @var{s19} (Motorola S-records). The file must
6049 contain a single section, and the contained data length must be exactly
6050 912 bytes.
6051 @quotation Attention
6052 This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
6053 @end quotation
6054 Example:
6055 @example
6056 lpc2900 write_custom 0 /path_to/customer_info.bin bin
6057 @end example
6058 @end deffn
6059
6060 @deffn Command {lpc2900 secure_sector} bank first last
6061 Secures the sector range from @var{first} to @var{last} (including) against
6062 further program and erase operations. The sector security will be effective
6063 after the next power cycle.
6064 @quotation Attention
6065 This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
6066 @end quotation
6067 Secured sectors appear as @emph{protected} in the @code{flash info} command.
6068 Example:
6069 @example
6070 lpc2900 secure_sector 0 1 1
6071 flash info 0
6072 #0 : lpc2900 at 0x20000000, size 0x000c0000, (...)
6073 # 0: 0x00000000 (0x2000 8kB) not protected
6074 # 1: 0x00002000 (0x2000 8kB) protected
6075 # 2: 0x00004000 (0x2000 8kB) not protected
6076 @end example
6077 @end deffn
6078
6079 @deffn Command {lpc2900 secure_jtag} bank
6080 Irreversibly disable the JTAG port. The new JTAG security setting will be
6081 effective after the next power cycle.
6082 @quotation Attention
6083 This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
6084 @end quotation
6085 Examples:
6086 @example
6087 lpc2900 secure_jtag 0
6088 @end example
6089 @end deffn
6090 @end deffn
6091
6092 @deffn {Flash Driver} mdr
6093 This drivers handles the integrated NOR flash on Milandr Cortex-M
6094 based controllers. A known limitation is that the Info memory can't be
6095 read or verified as it's not memory mapped.
6096
6097 @example
6098 flash bank <name> mdr <base> <size> \
6099 0 0 <target#> @var{type} @var{page_count} @var{sec_count}
6100 @end example
6101
6102 @itemize @bullet
6103 @item @var{type} - 0 for main memory, 1 for info memory
6104 @item @var{page_count} - total number of pages
6105 @item @var{sec_count} - number of sector per page count
6106 @end itemize
6107
6108 Example usage:
6109 @example
6110 if @{ [info exists IMEMORY] && [string equal $IMEMORY true] @} @{
6111 flash bank $@{_CHIPNAME@}_info.flash mdr 0x00000000 0x01000 \
6112 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 1 1 4
6113 @} else @{
6114 flash bank $_CHIPNAME.flash mdr 0x00000000 0x20000 \
6115 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 0 32 4
6116 @}
6117 @end example
6118 @end deffn
6119
6120 @deffn {Flash Driver} msp432
6121 All versions of the SimpleLink MSP432 microcontrollers from Texas
6122 Instruments include internal flash. The msp432 flash driver automatically
6123 recognizes the specific version's flash parameters and autoconfigures itself.
6124 Main program flash (starting at address 0) is flash bank 0. Information flash
6125 region on MSP432P4 versions (starting at address 0x200000) is flash bank 1.
6126
6127 @example
6128 flash bank $_FLASHNAME msp432 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6129 @end example
6130
6131 @deffn Command {msp432 mass_erase} [main|all]
6132 Performs a complete erase of flash. By default, @command{mass_erase} will erase
6133 only the main program flash.
6134
6135 On MSP432P4 versions, using @command{mass_erase all} will erase both the
6136 main program and information flash regions. To also erase the BSL in information
6137 flash, the user must first use the @command{bsl} command.
6138 @end deffn
6139
6140 @deffn Command {msp432 bsl} [unlock|lock]
6141 On MSP432P4 versions, @command{bsl} unlocks and locks the bootstrap loader (BSL)
6142 region in information flash so that flash commands can erase or write the BSL.
6143 Leave the BSL locked to prevent accidentally corrupting the bootstrap loader.
6144
6145 To erase and program the BSL:
6146 @example
6147 msp432 bsl unlock
6148 flash erase_address 0x202000 0x2000
6149 flash write_image bsl.bin 0x202000
6150 msp432 bsl lock
6151 @end example
6152 @end deffn
6153 @end deffn
6154
6155 @deffn {Flash Driver} niietcm4
6156 This drivers handles the integrated NOR flash on NIIET Cortex-M4
6157 based controllers. Flash size and sector layout are auto-configured by the driver.
6158 Main flash memory is called "Bootflash" and has main region and info region.
6159 Info region is NOT memory mapped by default,
6160 but it can replace first part of main region if needed.
6161 Full erase, single and block writes are supported for both main and info regions.
6162 There is additional not memory mapped flash called "Userflash", which
6163 also have division into regions: main and info.
6164 Purpose of userflash - to store system and user settings.
6165 Driver has special commands to perform operations with this memory.
6166
6167 @example
6168 flash bank $_FLASHNAME niietcm4 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6169 @end example
6170
6171 Some niietcm4-specific commands are defined:
6172
6173 @deffn Command {niietcm4 uflash_read_byte} bank ('main'|'info') address
6174 Read byte from main or info userflash region.
6175 @end deffn
6176
6177 @deffn Command {niietcm4 uflash_write_byte} bank ('main'|'info') address value
6178 Write byte to main or info userflash region.
6179 @end deffn
6180
6181 @deffn Command {niietcm4 uflash_full_erase} bank
6182 Erase all userflash including info region.
6183 @end deffn
6184
6185 @deffn Command {niietcm4 uflash_erase} bank ('main'|'info') first_sector last_sector
6186 Erase sectors of main or info userflash region, starting at sector first up to and including last.
6187 @end deffn
6188
6189 @deffn Command {niietcm4 uflash_protect_check} bank ('main'|'info')
6190 Check sectors protect.
6191 @end deffn
6192
6193 @deffn Command {niietcm4 uflash_protect} bank ('main'|'info') first_sector last_sector ('on'|'off')
6194 Protect sectors of main or info userflash region, starting at sector first up to and including last.
6195 @end deffn
6196
6197 @deffn Command {niietcm4 bflash_info_remap} bank ('on'|'off')
6198 Enable remapping bootflash info region to 0x00000000 (or 0x40000000 if external memory boot used).
6199 @end deffn
6200
6201 @deffn Command {niietcm4 extmem_cfg} bank ('gpioa'|'gpiob'|'gpioc'|'gpiod'|'gpioe'|'gpiof'|'gpiog'|'gpioh') pin_num ('func1'|'func3')
6202 Configure external memory interface for boot.
6203 @end deffn
6204
6205 @deffn Command {niietcm4 service_mode_erase} bank
6206 Perform emergency erase of all flash (bootflash and userflash).
6207 @end deffn
6208
6209 @deffn Command {niietcm4 driver_info} bank
6210 Show information about flash driver.
6211 @end deffn
6212
6213 @end deffn
6214
6215 @deffn {Flash Driver} nrf5
6216 All members of the nRF51 microcontroller families from Nordic Semiconductor
6217 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0 core.
6218 Also, the nRF52832 microcontroller from Nordic Semiconductor, which include
6219 internal flash and use an ARM Cortex-M4F core.
6220
6221 @example
6222 flash bank $_FLASHNAME nrf5 0 0x00000000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6223 @end example
6224
6225 Some nrf5-specific commands are defined:
6226
6227 @deffn Command {nrf5 mass_erase}
6228 Erases the contents of the code memory and user information
6229 configuration registers as well. It must be noted that this command
6230 works only for chips that do not have factory pre-programmed region 0
6231 code.
6232 @end deffn
6233
6234 @end deffn
6235
6236 @deffn {Flash Driver} ocl
6237 This driver is an implementation of the ``on chip flash loader''
6238 protocol proposed by Pavel Chromy.
6239
6240 It is a minimalistic command-response protocol intended to be used
6241 over a DCC when communicating with an internal or external flash
6242 loader running from RAM. An example implementation for AT91SAM7x is
6243 available in @file{contrib/loaders/flash/at91sam7x/}.
6244
6245 @example
6246 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ocl 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6247 @end example
6248 @end deffn
6249
6250 @deffn {Flash Driver} pic32mx
6251 The PIC32MX microcontrollers are based on the MIPS 4K cores,
6252 and integrate flash memory.
6253
6254 @example
6255 flash bank $_FLASHNAME pix32mx 0x1fc00000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6256 flash bank $_FLASHNAME pix32mx 0x1d000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6257 @end example
6258
6259 @comment numerous *disabled* commands are defined:
6260 @comment - chip_erase ... pointless given flash_erase_address
6261 @comment - lock, unlock ... pointless given protect on/off (yes?)
6262 @comment - pgm_word ... shouldn't bank be deduced from address??
6263 Some pic32mx-specific commands are defined:
6264 @deffn Command {pic32mx pgm_word} address value bank
6265 Programs the specified 32-bit @var{value} at the given @var{address}
6266 in the specified chip @var{bank}.
6267 @end deffn
6268 @deffn Command {pic32mx unlock} bank
6269 Unlock and erase specified chip @var{bank}.
6270 This will remove any Code Protection.
6271 @end deffn
6272 @end deffn
6273
6274 @deffn {Flash Driver} psoc4
6275 All members of the PSoC 41xx/42xx microcontroller family from Cypress
6276 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0 cores.
6277 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
6278 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6279
6280 Note: Erased internal flash reads as 00.
6281 System ROM of PSoC 4 does not implement erase of a flash sector.
6282
6283 @example
6284 flash bank $_FLASHNAME psoc4 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6285 @end example
6286
6287 psoc4-specific commands
6288 @deffn Command {psoc4 flash_autoerase} num (on|off)
6289 Enables or disables autoerase mode for a flash bank.
6290
6291 If flash_autoerase is off, use mass_erase before flash programming.
6292 Flash erase command fails if region to erase is not whole flash memory.
6293
6294 If flash_autoerase is on, a sector is both erased and programmed in one
6295 system ROM call. Flash erase command is ignored.
6296 This mode is suitable for gdb load.
6297
6298 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6299 @end deffn
6300
6301 @deffn Command {psoc4 mass_erase} num
6302 Erases the contents of the flash memory, protection and security lock.
6303
6304 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6305 @end deffn
6306 @end deffn
6307
6308 @deffn {Flash Driver} psoc5lp
6309 All members of the PSoC 5LP microcontroller family from Cypress
6310 include internal program flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
6311 The driver probes for a number of these chips and autoconfigures itself,
6312 apart from the base address.
6313
6314 @example
6315 flash bank $_FLASHNAME psoc5lp 0x00000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6316 @end example
6317
6318 @b{Note:} PSoC 5LP chips can be configured to have ECC enabled or disabled.
6319 @quotation Attention
6320 If flash operations are performed in ECC-disabled mode, they will also affect
6321 the ECC flash region. Erasing a 16k flash sector in the 0x00000000 area will
6322 then also erase the corresponding 2k data bytes in the 0x48000000 area.
6323 Writing to the ECC data bytes in ECC-disabled mode is not implemented.
6324 @end quotation
6325
6326 Commands defined in the @var{psoc5lp} driver:
6327
6328 @deffn Command {psoc5lp mass_erase}
6329 Erases all flash data and ECC/configuration bytes, all flash protection rows,
6330 and all row latches in all flash arrays on the device.
6331 @end deffn
6332 @end deffn
6333
6334 @deffn {Flash Driver} psoc5lp_eeprom
6335 All members of the PSoC 5LP microcontroller family from Cypress
6336 include internal EEPROM and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
6337 The driver probes for a number of these chips and autoconfigures itself,
6338 apart from the base address.
6339
6340 @example
6341 flash bank $_CHIPNAME.eeprom psoc5lp_eeprom 0x40008000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6342 @end example
6343 @end deffn
6344
6345 @deffn {Flash Driver} psoc5lp_nvl
6346 All members of the PSoC 5LP microcontroller family from Cypress
6347 include internal Nonvolatile Latches and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
6348 The driver probes for a number of these chips and autoconfigures itself.
6349
6350 @example
6351 flash bank $_CHIPNAME.nvl psoc5lp_nvl 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6352 @end example
6353
6354 PSoC 5LP chips have multiple NV Latches:
6355
6356 @itemize
6357 @item Device Configuration NV Latch - 4 bytes
6358 @item Write Once (WO) NV Latch - 4 bytes
6359 @end itemize
6360
6361 @b{Note:} This driver only implements the Device Configuration NVL.
6362
6363 The @var{psoc5lp} driver reads the ECC mode from Device Configuration NVL.
6364 @quotation Attention
6365 Switching ECC mode via write to Device Configuration NVL will require a reset
6366 after successful write.
6367 @end quotation
6368 @end deffn
6369
6370 @deffn {Flash Driver} psoc6
6371 Supports PSoC6 (CY8C6xxx) family of Cypress microcontrollers.
6372 PSoC6 is a dual-core device with CM0+ and CM4 cores. Both cores share
6373 the same Flash/RAM/MMIO address space.
6374
6375 Flash in PSoC6 is split into three regions:
6376 @itemize @bullet
6377 @item Main Flash - this is the main storage for user application.
6378 Total size varies among devices, sector size: 256 kBytes, row size:
6379 512 bytes. Supports erase operation on individual rows.
6380 @item Work Flash - intended to be used as storage for user data
6381 (e.g. EEPROM emulation). Total size: 32 KBytes, sector size: 32 KBytes,
6382 row size: 512 bytes.
6383 @item Supervisory Flash - special region which contains device-specific
6384 service data. This region does not support erase operation. Only few rows can
6385 be programmed by the user, most of the rows are read only. Programming
6386 operation will erase row automatically.
6387 @end itemize
6388
6389 All three flash regions are supported by the driver. Flash geometry is detected
6390 automatically by parsing data in SPCIF_GEOMETRY register.
6391
6392 PSoC6 is equipped with NOR Flash so erased Flash reads as 0x00.
6393
6394 @example
6395 flash bank main_flash_cm0 psoc6 0x10000000 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
6396 flash bank work_flash_cm0 psoc6 0x14000000 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
6397 flash bank super_flash_user_cm0 psoc6 0x16000800 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
6398 flash bank super_flash_nar_cm0 psoc6 0x16001A00 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
6399 flash bank super_flash_key_cm0 psoc6 0x16005A00 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
6400 flash bank super_flash_toc2_cm0 psoc6 0x16007C00 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
6401
6402 flash bank main_flash_cm4 psoc6 0x10000000 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
6403 flash bank work_flash_cm4 psoc6 0x14000000 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
6404 flash bank super_flash_user_cm4 psoc6 0x16000800 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
6405 flash bank super_flash_nar_cm4 psoc6 0x16001A00 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
6406 flash bank super_flash_key_cm4 psoc6 0x16005A00 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
6407 flash bank super_flash_toc2_cm4 psoc6 0x16007C00 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
6408 @end example
6409
6410 psoc6-specific commands
6411 @deffn Command {psoc6 reset_halt}
6412 Command can be used to simulate broken Vector Catch from gdbinit or tcl scripts.
6413 When invoked for CM0+ target, it will set break point at application entry point
6414 and issue SYSRESETREQ. This will reset both cores and all peripherals. CM0+ will
6415 reset CM4 during boot anyway so this is safe. On CM4 target, VECTRESET is used
6416 instead of SYSRESETREQ to avoid unwanted reset of CM0+;
6417 @end deffn
6418
6419 @deffn Command {psoc6 mass_erase} num
6420 Erases the contents given flash bank. The @var{num} parameter is a value shown
6421 by @command{flash banks}.
6422 Note: only Main and Work flash regions support Erase operation.
6423 @end deffn
6424 @end deffn
6425
6426 @deffn {Flash Driver} sim3x
6427 All members of the SiM3 microcontroller family from Silicon Laboratories
6428 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores. It supports both JTAG
6429 and SWD interface.
6430 The @var{sim3x} driver tries to probe the device to auto detect the MCU.
6431 If this fails, it will use the @var{size} parameter as the size of flash bank.
6432
6433 @example
6434 flash bank $_FLASHNAME sim3x 0 $_CPUROMSIZE 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6435 @end example
6436
6437 There are 2 commands defined in the @var{sim3x} driver:
6438
6439 @deffn Command {sim3x mass_erase}
6440 Erases the complete flash. This is used to unlock the flash.
6441 And this command is only possible when using the SWD interface.
6442 @end deffn
6443
6444 @deffn Command {sim3x lock}
6445 Lock the flash. To unlock use the @command{sim3x mass_erase} command.
6446 @end deffn
6447 @end deffn
6448
6449 @deffn {Flash Driver} stellaris
6450 All members of the Stellaris LM3Sxxx, LM4x and Tiva C microcontroller
6451 families from Texas Instruments include internal flash. The driver
6452 automatically recognizes a number of these chips using the chip
6453 identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6454
6455 @example
6456 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stellaris 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6457 @end example
6458
6459 @deffn Command {stellaris recover}
6460 Performs the @emph{Recovering a "Locked" Device} procedure to restore
6461 the flash and its associated nonvolatile registers to their factory
6462 default values (erased). This is the only way to remove flash
6463 protection or re-enable debugging if that capability has been
6464 disabled.
6465
6466 Note that the final "power cycle the chip" step in this procedure
6467 must be performed by hand, since OpenOCD can't do it.
6468 @quotation Warning
6469 if more than one Stellaris chip is connected, the procedure is
6470 applied to all of them.
6471 @end quotation
6472 @end deffn
6473 @end deffn
6474
6475 @deffn {Flash Driver} stm32f1x
6476 All members of the STM32F0, STM32F1 and STM32F3 microcontroller families
6477 from STMicroelectronics include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0/M3/M4 cores.
6478 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
6479 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6480
6481 @example
6482 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6483 @end example
6484
6485 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
6486 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
6487 the flash driver.
6488
6489 @example
6490 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6491 @end example
6492
6493 If you have a target with dual flash banks then define the second bank
6494 as per the following example.
6495 @example
6496 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0x08080000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6497 @end example
6498
6499 Some stm32f1x-specific commands are defined:
6500
6501 @deffn Command {stm32f1x lock} num
6502 Locks the entire stm32 device against reading.
6503 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6504 @end deffn
6505
6506 @deffn Command {stm32f1x unlock} num
6507 Unlocks the entire stm32 device for reading. This command will cause
6508 a mass erase of the entire stm32 device if previously locked.
6509 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6510 @end deffn
6511
6512 @deffn Command {stm32f1x mass_erase} num
6513 Mass erases the entire stm32 device.
6514 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6515 @end deffn
6516
6517 @deffn Command {stm32f1x options_read} num
6518 Reads and displays active stm32 option bytes loaded during POR
6519 or upon executing the @command{stm32f1x options_load} command.
6520 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6521 @end deffn
6522
6523 @deffn Command {stm32f1x options_write} num (@option{SWWDG}|@option{HWWDG}) (@option{RSTSTNDBY}|@option{NORSTSTNDBY}) (@option{RSTSTOP}|@option{NORSTSTOP})
6524 Writes the stm32 option byte with the specified values.
6525 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6526 @end deffn
6527
6528 @deffn Command {stm32f1x options_load} num
6529 Generates a special kind of reset to re-load the stm32 option bytes written
6530 by the @command{stm32f1x options_write} or @command{flash protect} commands
6531 without having to power cycle the target. Not applicable to stm32f1x devices.
6532 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6533 @end deffn
6534 @end deffn
6535
6536 @deffn {Flash Driver} stm32f2x
6537 All members of the STM32F2, STM32F4 and STM32F7 microcontroller families from STMicroelectronics
6538 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3/M4/M7 cores.
6539 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
6540 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6541
6542 @example
6543 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f2x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6544 @end example
6545
6546 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
6547 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
6548 the flash driver.
6549
6550 @example
6551 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f2x 0 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6552 @end example
6553
6554 Some stm32f2x-specific commands are defined:
6555
6556 @deffn Command {stm32f2x lock} num
6557 Locks the entire stm32 device.
6558 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6559 @end deffn
6560
6561 @deffn Command {stm32f2x unlock} num
6562 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
6563 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6564 @end deffn
6565
6566 @deffn Command {stm32f2x mass_erase} num
6567 Mass erases the entire stm32f2x device.
6568 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6569 @end deffn
6570
6571 @deffn Command {stm32f2x options_read} num
6572 Reads and displays user options and (where implemented) boot_addr0, boot_addr1, optcr2.
6573 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6574 @end deffn
6575
6576 @deffn Command {stm32f2x options_write} num user_options boot_addr0 boot_addr1
6577 Writes user options and (where implemented) boot_addr0 and boot_addr1 in raw format.
6578 Warning: The meaning of the various bits depends on the device, always check datasheet!
6579 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{user_options} a
6580 12 bit value, consisting of bits 31-28 and 7-0 of FLASH_OPTCR, @var{boot_addr0} and
6581 @var{boot_addr1} two halfwords (of FLASH_OPTCR1).
6582 @end deffn
6583
6584 @deffn Command {stm32f2x optcr2_write} num optcr2
6585 Writes FLASH_OPTCR2 options. Warning: Clearing PCROPi bits requires a full mass erase!
6586 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{optcr2} a 32-bit word.
6587 @end deffn
6588 @end deffn
6589
6590 @deffn {Flash Driver} stm32h7x
6591 All members of the STM32H7 microcontroller families from STMicroelectronics
6592 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M7 core.
6593 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
6594 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6595
6596 @example
6597 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32h7x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6598 @end example
6599
6600 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
6601 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
6602 the flash driver.
6603
6604 @example
6605 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32h7x 0 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6606 @end example
6607
6608 Some stm32h7x-specific commands are defined:
6609
6610 @deffn Command {stm32h7x lock} num
6611 Locks the entire stm32 device.
6612 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6613 @end deffn
6614
6615 @deffn Command {stm32h7x unlock} num
6616 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
6617 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6618 @end deffn
6619
6620 @deffn Command {stm32h7x mass_erase} num
6621 Mass erases the entire stm32h7x device.
6622 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6623 @end deffn
6624 @end deffn
6625
6626 @deffn {Flash Driver} stm32lx
6627 All members of the STM32L microcontroller families from STMicroelectronics
6628 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 and Cortex-M0+ cores.
6629 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
6630 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6631
6632 @example
6633 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32lx 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6634 @end example
6635
6636 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
6637 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
6638 the flash driver. If you use 0 as the bank base address, it tells the
6639 driver to autodetect the bank location assuming you're configuring the
6640 second bank.
6641
6642 @example
6643 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32lx 0x08000000 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6644 @end example
6645
6646 Some stm32lx-specific commands are defined:
6647
6648 @deffn Command {stm32lx lock} num
6649 Locks the entire stm32 device.
6650 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6651 @end deffn
6652
6653 @deffn Command {stm32lx unlock} num
6654 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
6655 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6656 @end deffn
6657
6658 @deffn Command {stm32lx mass_erase} num
6659 Mass erases the entire stm32lx device (all flash banks and EEPROM
6660 data). This is the only way to unlock a protected flash (unless RDP
6661 Level is 2 which can't be unlocked at all).
6662 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6663 @end deffn
6664 @end deffn
6665
6666 @deffn {Flash Driver} stm32l4x
6667 All members of the STM32L4 microcontroller families from STMicroelectronics
6668 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M4 cores.
6669 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
6670 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6671
6672 @example
6673 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32l4x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6674 @end example
6675
6676 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
6677 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
6678 the flash driver.
6679
6680 @example
6681 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32l4x 0x08000000 0x40000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6682 @end example
6683
6684 Some stm32l4x-specific commands are defined:
6685
6686 @deffn Command {stm32l4x lock} num
6687 Locks the entire stm32 device.
6688 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6689 @end deffn
6690
6691 @deffn Command {stm32l4x unlock} num
6692 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
6693 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6694 @end deffn
6695
6696 @deffn Command {stm32l4x mass_erase} num
6697 Mass erases the entire stm32l4x device.
6698 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6699 @end deffn
6700
6701 @deffn Command {stm32l4x option_read} num reg_offset
6702 Reads an option byte register from the stm32l4x device.
6703 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{reg_offset}
6704 is the register offset of the Option byte to read.
6705
6706 For example to read the FLASH_OPTR register:
6707 @example
6708 stm32l4x option_read 0 0x20
6709 # Option Register: <0x40022020> = 0xffeff8aa
6710 @end example
6711
6712 The above example will read out the FLASH_OPTR register which contains the RDP
6713 option byte, Watchdog configuration, BOR level etc.
6714 @end deffn
6715
6716 @deffn Command {stm32l4x option_write} num reg_offset reg_mask
6717 Write an option byte register of the stm32l4x device.
6718 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{reg_offset}
6719 is the register offset of the Option byte to write, and @var{reg_mask} is the mask
6720 to apply when writing the register (only bits with a '1' will be touched).
6721
6722 For example to write the WRP1AR option bytes:
6723 @example
6724 stm32l4x option_write 0 0x28 0x00FF0000 0x00FF00FF
6725 @end example
6726
6727 The above example will write the WRP1AR option register configuring the Write protection
6728 Area A for bank 1. The above example set WRP1AR_END=255, WRP1AR_START=0.
6729 This will effectively write protect all sectors in flash bank 1.
6730 @end deffn
6731
6732 @deffn Command {stm32l4x option_load} num
6733 Forces a re-load of the option byte registers. Will cause a reset of the device.
6734 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6735 @end deffn
6736 @end deffn
6737
6738 @deffn {Flash Driver} str7x
6739 All members of the STR7 microcontroller family from STMicroelectronics
6740 include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
6741 The @var{str7x} driver defines one mandatory parameter, @var{variant},
6742 which is either @code{STR71x}, @code{STR73x} or @code{STR75x}.
6743
6744 @example
6745 flash bank $_FLASHNAME str7x \
6746 0x40000000 0x00040000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME STR71x
6747 @end example
6748
6749 @deffn Command {str7x disable_jtag} bank
6750 Activate the Debug/Readout protection mechanism
6751 for the specified flash bank.
6752 @end deffn
6753 @end deffn
6754
6755 @deffn {Flash Driver} str9x
6756 Most members of the STR9 microcontroller family from STMicroelectronics
6757 include internal flash and use ARM966E cores.
6758 The str9 needs the flash controller to be configured using
6759 the @command{str9x flash_config} command prior to Flash programming.
6760
6761 @example
6762 flash bank $_FLASHNAME str9x 0x40000000 0x00040000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6763 str9x flash_config 0 4 2 0 0x80000
6764 @end example
6765
6766 @deffn Command {str9x flash_config} num bbsr nbbsr bbadr nbbadr
6767 Configures the str9 flash controller.
6768 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6769
6770 @itemize @bullet
6771 @item @var{bbsr} - Boot Bank Size register
6772 @item @var{nbbsr} - Non Boot Bank Size register
6773 @item @var{bbadr} - Boot Bank Start Address register
6774 @item @var{nbbadr} - Boot Bank Start Address register
6775 @end itemize
6776 @end deffn
6777
6778 @end deffn
6779
6780 @deffn {Flash Driver} str9xpec
6781 @cindex str9xpec
6782
6783 Only use this driver for locking/unlocking the device or configuring the option bytes.
6784 Use the standard str9 driver for programming.
6785 Before using the flash commands the turbo mode must be enabled using the
6786 @command{str9xpec enable_turbo} command.
6787
6788 Here is some background info to help
6789 you better understand how this driver works. OpenOCD has two flash drivers for
6790 the str9:
6791 @enumerate
6792 @item
6793 Standard driver @option{str9x} programmed via the str9 core. Normally used for
6794 flash programming as it is faster than the @option{str9xpec} driver.
6795 @item
6796 Direct programming @option{str9xpec} using the flash controller. This is an
6797 ISC compliant (IEEE 1532) tap connected in series with the str9 core. The str9
6798 core does not need to be running to program using this flash driver. Typical use
6799 for this driver is locking/unlocking the target and programming the option bytes.
6800 @end enumerate
6801
6802 Before we run any commands using the @option{str9xpec} driver we must first disable
6803 the str9 core. This example assumes the @option{str9xpec} driver has been
6804 configured for flash bank 0.
6805 @example
6806 # assert srst, we do not want core running
6807 # while accessing str9xpec flash driver
6808 jtag_reset 0 1
6809 # turn off target polling
6810 poll off
6811 # disable str9 core
6812 str9xpec enable_turbo 0
6813 # read option bytes
6814 str9xpec options_read 0
6815 # re-enable str9 core
6816 str9xpec disable_turbo 0
6817 poll on
6818 reset halt
6819 @end example
6820 The above example will read the str9 option bytes.
6821 When performing a unlock remember that you will not be able to halt the str9 - it
6822 has been locked. Halting the core is not required for the @option{str9xpec} driver
6823 as mentioned above, just issue the commands above manually or from a telnet prompt.
6824
6825 Several str9xpec-specific commands are defined:
6826
6827 @deffn Command {str9xpec disable_turbo} num
6828 Restore the str9 into JTAG chain.
6829 @end deffn
6830
6831 @deffn Command {str9xpec enable_turbo} num
6832 Enable turbo mode, will simply remove the str9 from the chain and talk
6833 directly to the embedded flash controller.
6834 @end deffn
6835
6836 @deffn Command {str9xpec lock} num
6837 Lock str9 device. The str9 will only respond to an unlock command that will
6838 erase the device.
6839 @end deffn
6840
6841 @deffn Command {str9xpec part_id} num
6842 Prints the part identifier for bank @var{num}.
6843 @end deffn
6844
6845 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_cmap} num (@option{bank0}|@option{bank1})
6846 Configure str9 boot bank.
6847 @end deffn
6848
6849 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_lvdsel} num (@option{vdd}|@option{vdd_vddq})
6850 Configure str9 lvd source.
6851 @end deffn
6852
6853 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_lvdthd} num (@option{2.4v}|@option{2.7v})
6854 Configure str9 lvd threshold.
6855 @end deffn
6856
6857 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_lvdwarn} bank (@option{vdd}|@option{vdd_vddq})
6858 Configure str9 lvd reset warning source.
6859 @end deffn
6860
6861 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_read} num
6862 Read str9 option bytes.
6863 @end deffn
6864
6865 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_write} num
6866 Write str9 option bytes.
6867 @end deffn
6868
6869 @deffn Command {str9xpec unlock} num
6870 unlock str9 device.
6871 @end deffn
6872
6873 @end deffn
6874
6875 @deffn {Flash Driver} tms470
6876 Most members of the TMS470 microcontroller family from Texas Instruments
6877 include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
6878 This driver doesn't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
6879
6880 Some tms470-specific commands are defined:
6881
6882 @deffn Command {tms470 flash_keyset} key0 key1 key2 key3
6883 Saves programming keys in a register, to enable flash erase and write commands.
6884 @end deffn
6885
6886 @deffn Command {tms470 osc_mhz} clock_mhz
6887 Reports the clock speed, which is used to calculate timings.
6888 @end deffn
6889
6890 @deffn Command {tms470 plldis} (0|1)
6891 Disables (@var{1}) or enables (@var{0}) use of the PLL to speed up
6892 the flash clock.
6893 @end deffn
6894 @end deffn
6895
6896 @deffn {Flash Driver} w600
6897 W60x series Wi-Fi SoC from WinnerMicro
6898 are designed with ARM Cortex-M3 and have 1M Byte QFLASH inside.
6899 The @var{w600} driver uses the @var{target} parameter to select the
6900 correct bank config.
6901
6902 @example
6903 flash bank $_FLASHNAME w600 0x08000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAMEs
6904 @end example
6905 @end deffn
6906
6907 @deffn {Flash Driver} xmc1xxx
6908 All members of the XMC1xxx microcontroller family from Infineon.
6909 This driver does not require the chip and bus width to be specified.
6910 @end deffn
6911
6912 @deffn {Flash Driver} xmc4xxx
6913 All members of the XMC4xxx microcontroller family from Infineon.
6914 This driver does not require the chip and bus width to be specified.
6915
6916 Some xmc4xxx-specific commands are defined:
6917
6918 @deffn Command {xmc4xxx flash_password} bank_id passwd1 passwd2
6919 Saves flash protection passwords which are used to lock the user flash
6920 @end deffn
6921
6922 @deffn Command {xmc4xxx flash_unprotect} bank_id user_level[0-1]
6923 Removes Flash write protection from the selected user bank
6924 @end deffn
6925
6926 @end deffn
6927
6928 @section NAND Flash Commands
6929 @cindex NAND
6930
6931 Compared to NOR or SPI flash, NAND devices are inexpensive
6932 and high density. Today's NAND chips, and multi-chip modules,
6933 commonly hold multiple GigaBytes of data.
6934
6935 NAND chips consist of a number of ``erase blocks'' of a given
6936 size (such as 128 KBytes), each of which is divided into a
6937 number of pages (of perhaps 512 or 2048 bytes each). Each
6938 page of a NAND flash has an ``out of band'' (OOB) area to hold
6939 Error Correcting Code (ECC) and other metadata, usually 16 bytes
6940 of OOB for every 512 bytes of page data.
6941
6942 One key characteristic of NAND flash is that its error rate
6943 is higher than that of NOR flash. In normal operation, that
6944 ECC is used to correct and detect errors. However, NAND
6945 blocks can also wear out and become unusable; those blocks
6946 are then marked "bad". NAND chips are even shipped from the
6947 manufacturer with a few bad blocks. The highest density chips
6948 use a technology (MLC) that wears out more quickly, so ECC
6949 support is increasingly important as a way to detect blocks
6950 that have begun to fail, and help to preserve data integrity
6951 with techniques such as wear leveling.
6952
6953 Software is used to manage the ECC. Some controllers don't
6954 support ECC directly; in those cases, software ECC is used.
6955 Other controllers speed up the ECC calculations with hardware.
6956 Single-bit error correction hardware is routine. Controllers
6957 geared for newer MLC chips may correct 4 or more errors for
6958 every 512 bytes of data.
6959
6960 You will need to make sure that any data you write using
6961 OpenOCD includes the appropriate kind of ECC. For example,
6962 that may mean passing the @code{oob_softecc} flag when
6963 writing NAND data, or ensuring that the correct hardware
6964 ECC mode is used.
6965
6966 The basic steps for using NAND devices include:
6967 @enumerate
6968 @item Declare via the command @command{nand device}
6969 @* Do this in a board-specific configuration file,
6970 passing parameters as needed by the controller.
6971 @item Configure each device using @command{nand probe}.
6972 @* Do this only after the associated target is set up,
6973 such as in its reset-init script or in procures defined
6974 to access that device.
6975 @item Operate on the flash via @command{nand subcommand}
6976 @* Often commands to manipulate the flash are typed by a human, or run
6977 via a script in some automated way. Common task include writing a
6978 boot loader, operating system, or other data needed to initialize or
6979 de-brick a board.
6980 @end enumerate
6981
6982 @b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, the largest NAND
6983 flash fully supported by OpenOCD is 2 GiBytes (16 GiBits).
6984 This is because the variables used to hold offsets and lengths
6985 are only 32 bits wide.
6986 (Larger chips may work in some cases, unless an offset or length
6987 is larger than 0xffffffff, the largest 32-bit unsigned integer.)
6988 Some larger devices will work, since they are actually multi-chip
6989 modules with two smaller chips and individual chipselect lines.
6990
6991 @anchor{nandconfiguration}
6992 @subsection NAND Configuration Commands
6993 @cindex NAND configuration
6994
6995 NAND chips must be declared in configuration scripts,
6996 plus some additional configuration that's done after
6997 OpenOCD has initialized.
6998
6999 @deffn {Config Command} {nand device} name driver target [configparams...]
7000 Declares a NAND device, which can be read and written to
7001 after it has been configured through @command{nand probe}.
7002 In OpenOCD, devices are single chips; this is unlike some
7003 operating systems, which may manage multiple chips as if
7004 they were a single (larger) device.
7005 In some cases, configuring a device will activate extra
7006 commands; see the controller-specific documentation.
7007
7008 @b{NOTE:} This command is not available after OpenOCD
7009 initialization has completed. Use it in board specific
7010 configuration files, not interactively.
7011
7012 @itemize @bullet
7013 @item @var{name} ... may be used to reference the NAND bank
7014 in most other NAND commands. A number is also available.
7015 @item @var{driver} ... identifies the NAND controller driver
7016 associated with the NAND device being declared.
7017 @xref{nanddriverlist,,NAND Driver List}.
7018 @item @var{target} ... names the target used when issuing
7019 commands to the NAND controller.
7020 @comment Actually, it's currently a controller-specific parameter...
7021 @item @var{configparams} ... controllers may support, or require,
7022 additional parameters. See the controller-specific documentation
7023 for more information.
7024 @end itemize
7025 @end deffn
7026
7027 @deffn Command {nand list}
7028 Prints a summary of each device declared
7029 using @command{nand device}, numbered from zero.
7030 Note that un-probed devices show no details.
7031 @example
7032 > nand list
7033 #0: NAND 1GiB 3,3V 8-bit (Micron) pagesize: 2048, buswidth: 8,
7034 blocksize: 131072, blocks: 8192
7035 #1: NAND 1GiB 3,3V 8-bit (Micron) pagesize: 2048, buswidth: 8,
7036 blocksize: 131072, blocks: 8192
7037 >
7038 @end example
7039 @end deffn
7040
7041 @deffn Command {nand probe} num
7042 Probes the specified device to determine key characteristics
7043 like its page and block sizes, and how many blocks it has.
7044 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7045 You must (successfully) probe a device before you can use
7046 it with most other NAND commands.
7047 @end deffn
7048
7049 @subsection Erasing, Reading, Writing to NAND Flash
7050
7051 @deffn Command {nand dump} num filename offset length [oob_option]
7052 @cindex NAND reading
7053 Reads binary data from the NAND device and writes it to the file,
7054 starting at the specified offset.
7055 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7056
7057 Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
7058 on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
7059
7060 The @var{offset} and @var{length} must be exact multiples of the
7061 device's page size. They describe a data region; the OOB data
7062 associated with each such page may also be accessed.
7063
7064 @b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, no error correction
7065 was done on the data that's read, unless raw access was disabled
7066 and the underlying NAND controller driver had a @code{read_page}
7067 method which handled that error correction.
7068
7069 By default, only page data is saved to the specified file.
7070 Use an @var{oob_option} parameter to save OOB data:
7071 @itemize @bullet
7072 @item no oob_* parameter
7073 @*Output file holds only page data; OOB is discarded.
7074 @item @code{oob_raw}
7075 @*Output file interleaves page data and OOB data;
7076 the file will be longer than "length" by the size of the
7077 spare areas associated with each data page.
7078 Note that this kind of "raw" access is different from
7079 what's implied by @command{nand raw_access}, which just
7080 controls whether a hardware-aware access method is used.
7081 @item @code{oob_only}
7082 @*Output file has only raw OOB data, and will
7083 be smaller than "length" since it will contain only the
7084 spare areas associated with each data page.
7085 @end itemize
7086 @end deffn
7087
7088 @deffn Command {nand erase} num [offset length]
7089 @cindex NAND erasing
7090 @cindex NAND programming
7091 Erases blocks on the specified NAND device, starting at the
7092 specified @var{offset} and continuing for @var{length} bytes.
7093 Both of those values must be exact multiples of the device's
7094 block size, and the region they specify must fit entirely in the chip.
7095 If those parameters are not specified,
7096 the whole NAND chip will be erased.
7097 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7098
7099 @b{NOTE:} This command will try to erase bad blocks, when told
7100 to do so, which will probably invalidate the manufacturer's bad
7101 block marker.
7102 For the remainder of the current server session, @command{nand info}
7103 will still report that the block ``is'' bad.
7104 @end deffn
7105
7106 @deffn Command {nand write} num filename offset [option...]
7107 @cindex NAND writing
7108 @cindex NAND programming
7109 Writes binary data from the file into the specified NAND device,
7110 starting at the specified offset. Those pages should already
7111 have been erased; you can't change zero bits to one bits.
7112 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7113
7114 Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
7115 on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
7116
7117 The @var{offset} must be an exact multiple of the device's page size.
7118 All data in the file will be written, assuming it doesn't run
7119 past the end of the device.
7120 Only full pages are written, and any extra space in the last
7121 page will be filled with 0xff bytes. (That includes OOB data,
7122 if that's being written.)
7123
7124 @b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, bad blocks are
7125 ignored. That is, this routine will not skip bad blocks,
7126 but will instead try to write them. This can cause problems.
7127
7128 Provide at most one @var{option} parameter. With some
7129 NAND drivers, the meanings of these parameters may change
7130 if @command{nand raw_access} was used to disable hardware ECC.
7131 @itemize @bullet
7132 @item no oob_* parameter
7133 @*File has only page data, which is written.
7134 If raw access is in use, the OOB area will not be written.
7135 Otherwise, if the underlying NAND controller driver has
7136 a @code{write_page} routine, that routine may write the OOB
7137 with hardware-computed ECC data.
7138 @item @code{oob_only}
7139 @*File has only raw OOB data, which is written to the OOB area.
7140 Each page's data area stays untouched. @i{This can be a dangerous
7141 option}, since it can invalidate the ECC data.
7142 You may need to force raw access to use this mode.
7143 @item @code{oob_raw}
7144 @*File interleaves data and OOB data, both of which are written
7145 If raw access is enabled, the data is written first, then the
7146 un-altered OOB.
7147 Otherwise, if the underlying NAND controller driver has
7148 a @code{write_page} routine, that routine may modify the OOB
7149 before it's written, to include hardware-computed ECC data.
7150 @item @code{oob_softecc}
7151 @*File has only page data, which is written.
7152 The OOB area is filled with 0xff, except for a standard 1-bit
7153 software ECC code stored in conventional locations.
7154 You might need to force raw access to use this mode, to prevent
7155 the underlying driver from applying hardware ECC.
7156 @item @code{oob_softecc_kw}
7157 @*File has only page data, which is written.
7158 The OOB area is filled with 0xff, except for a 4-bit software ECC
7159 specific to the boot ROM in Marvell Kirkwood SoCs.
7160 You might need to force raw access to use this mode, to prevent
7161 the underlying driver from applying hardware ECC.
7162 @end itemize
7163 @end deffn
7164
7165 @deffn Command {nand verify} num filename offset [option...]
7166 @cindex NAND verification
7167 @cindex NAND programming
7168 Verify the binary data in the file has been programmed to the
7169 specified NAND device, starting at the specified offset.
7170 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7171
7172 Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
7173 on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
7174
7175 The @var{offset} must be an exact multiple of the device's page size.
7176 All data in the file will be read and compared to the contents of the
7177 flash, assuming it doesn't run past the end of the device.
7178 As with @command{nand write}, only full pages are verified, so any extra
7179 space in the last page will be filled with 0xff bytes.
7180
7181 The same @var{options} accepted by @command{nand write},
7182 and the file will be processed similarly to produce the buffers that
7183 can be compared against the contents produced from @command{nand dump}.
7184
7185 @b{NOTE:} This will not work when the underlying NAND controller
7186 driver's @code{write_page} routine must update the OOB with a
7187 hardware-computed ECC before the data is written. This limitation may
7188 be removed in a future release.
7189 @end deffn
7190
7191 @subsection Other NAND commands
7192 @cindex NAND other commands
7193
7194 @deffn Command {nand check_bad_blocks} num [offset length]
7195 Checks for manufacturer bad block markers on the specified NAND
7196 device. If no parameters are provided, checks the whole
7197 device; otherwise, starts at the specified @var{offset} and
7198 continues for @var{length} bytes.
7199 Both of those values must be exact multiples of the device's
7200 block size, and the region they specify must fit entirely in the chip.
7201 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7202
7203 @b{NOTE:} Before using this command you should force raw access
7204 with @command{nand raw_access enable} to ensure that the underlying
7205 driver will not try to apply hardware ECC.
7206 @end deffn
7207
7208 @deffn Command {nand info} num
7209 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7210 This prints the one-line summary from "nand list", plus for
7211 devices which have been probed this also prints any known
7212 status for each block.
7213 @end deffn
7214
7215 @deffn Command {nand raw_access} num (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
7216 Sets or clears an flag affecting how page I/O is done.
7217 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7218
7219 This flag is cleared (disabled) by default, but changing that
7220 value won't affect all NAND devices. The key factor is whether
7221 the underlying driver provides @code{read_page} or @code{write_page}
7222 methods. If it doesn't provide those methods, the setting of
7223 this flag is irrelevant; all access is effectively ``raw''.
7224
7225 When those methods exist, they are normally used when reading
7226 data (@command{nand dump} or reading bad block markers) or
7227 writing it (@command{nand write}). However, enabling
7228 raw access (setting the flag) prevents use of those methods,
7229 bypassing hardware ECC logic.
7230 @i{This can be a dangerous option}, since writing blocks
7231 with the wrong ECC data can cause them to be marked as bad.
7232 @end deffn
7233
7234 @anchor{nanddriverlist}
7235 @subsection NAND Driver List
7236 As noted above, the @command{nand device} command allows
7237 driver-specific options and behaviors.
7238 Some controllers also activate controller-specific commands.
7239
7240 @deffn {NAND Driver} at91sam9
7241 This driver handles the NAND controllers found on AT91SAM9 family chips from
7242 Atmel. It takes two extra parameters: address of the NAND chip;
7243 address of the ECC controller.
7244 @example
7245 nand device $NANDFLASH at91sam9 $CHIPNAME 0x40000000 0xfffffe800
7246 @end example
7247 AT91SAM9 chips support single-bit ECC hardware. The @code{write_page} and
7248 @code{read_page} methods are used to utilize the ECC hardware unless they are
7249 disabled by using the @command{nand raw_access} command. There are four
7250 additional commands that are needed to fully configure the AT91SAM9 NAND
7251 controller. Two are optional; most boards use the same wiring for ALE/CLE:
7252 @deffn Command {at91sam9 cle} num addr_line
7253 Configure the address line used for latching commands. The @var{num}
7254 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7255 @end deffn
7256 @deffn Command {at91sam9 ale} num addr_line
7257 Configure the address line used for latching addresses. The @var{num}
7258 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7259 @end deffn
7260
7261 For the next two commands, it is assumed that the pins have already been
7262 properly configured for input or output.
7263 @deffn Command {at91sam9 rdy_busy} num pio_base_addr pin
7264 Configure the RDY/nBUSY input from the NAND device. The @var{num}
7265 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}. @var{pio_base_addr}
7266 is the base address of the PIO controller and @var{pin} is the pin number.
7267 @end deffn
7268 @deffn Command {at91sam9 ce} num pio_base_addr pin
7269 Configure the chip enable input to the NAND device. The @var{num}
7270 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}. @var{pio_base_addr}
7271 is the base address of the PIO controller and @var{pin} is the pin number.
7272 @end deffn
7273 @end deffn
7274
7275 @deffn {NAND Driver} davinci
7276 This driver handles the NAND controllers found on DaVinci family
7277 chips from Texas Instruments.
7278 It takes three extra parameters:
7279 address of the NAND chip;
7280 hardware ECC mode to use (@option{hwecc1},
7281 @option{hwecc4}, @option{hwecc4_infix});
7282 address of the AEMIF controller on this processor.
7283 @example
7284 nand device davinci dm355.arm 0x02000000 hwecc4 0x01e10000
7285 @end example
7286 All DaVinci processors support the single-bit ECC hardware,
7287 and newer ones also support the four-bit ECC hardware.
7288 The @code{write_page} and @code{read_page} methods are used
7289 to implement those ECC modes, unless they are disabled using
7290 the @command{nand raw_access} command.
7291 @end deffn
7292
7293 @deffn {NAND Driver} lpc3180
7294 These controllers require an extra @command{nand device}
7295 parameter: the clock rate used by the controller.
7296 @deffn Command {lpc3180 select} num [mlc|slc]
7297 Configures use of the MLC or SLC controller mode.
7298 MLC implies use of hardware ECC.
7299 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7300 @end deffn
7301
7302 At this writing, this driver includes @code{write_page}
7303 and @code{read_page} methods. Using @command{nand raw_access}
7304 to disable those methods will prevent use of hardware ECC
7305 in the MLC controller mode, but won't change SLC behavior.
7306 @end deffn
7307 @comment current lpc3180 code won't issue 5-byte address cycles
7308
7309 @deffn {NAND Driver} mx3
7310 This driver handles the NAND controller in i.MX31. The mxc driver
7311 should work for this chip as well.
7312 @end deffn
7313
7314 @deffn {NAND Driver} mxc
7315 This driver handles the NAND controller found in Freescale i.MX
7316 chips. It has support for v1 (i.MX27 and i.MX31) and v2 (i.MX35).
7317 The driver takes 3 extra arguments, chip (@option{mx27},
7318 @option{mx31}, @option{mx35}), ecc (@option{noecc}, @option{hwecc})
7319 and optionally if bad block information should be swapped between
7320 main area and spare area (@option{biswap}), defaults to off.
7321 @example
7322 nand device mx35.nand mxc imx35.cpu mx35 hwecc biswap
7323 @end example
7324 @deffn Command {mxc biswap} bank_num [enable|disable]
7325 Turns on/off bad block information swapping from main area,
7326 without parameter query status.
7327 @end deffn
7328 @end deffn
7329
7330 @deffn {NAND Driver} orion
7331 These controllers require an extra @command{nand device}
7332 parameter: the address of the controller.
7333 @example
7334 nand device orion 0xd8000000
7335 @end example
7336 These controllers don't define any specialized commands.
7337 At this writing, their drivers don't include @code{write_page}
7338 or @code{read_page} methods, so @command{nand raw_access} won't
7339 change any behavior.
7340 @end deffn
7341
7342 @deffn {NAND Driver} s3c2410
7343 @deffnx {NAND Driver} s3c2412
7344 @deffnx {NAND Driver} s3c2440
7345 @deffnx {NAND Driver} s3c2443
7346 @deffnx {NAND Driver} s3c6400
7347 These S3C family controllers don't have any special
7348 @command{nand device} options, and don't define any
7349 specialized commands.
7350 At this writing, their drivers don't include @code{write_page}
7351 or @code{read_page} methods, so @command{nand raw_access} won't
7352 change any behavior.
7353 @end deffn
7354
7355 @section mFlash
7356
7357 @subsection mFlash Configuration
7358 @cindex mFlash Configuration
7359
7360 @deffn {Config Command} {mflash bank} soc base RST_pin target
7361 Configures a mflash for @var{soc} host bank at
7362 address @var{base}.
7363 The pin number format depends on the host GPIO naming convention.
7364 Currently, the mflash driver supports s3c2440 and pxa270.
7365
7366 Example for s3c2440 mflash where @var{RST pin} is GPIO B1:
7367
7368 @example
7369 mflash bank $_FLASHNAME s3c2440 0x10000000 1b 0
7370 @end example
7371
7372 Example for pxa270 mflash where @var{RST pin} is GPIO 43:
7373
7374 @example
7375 mflash bank $_FLASHNAME pxa270 0x08000000 43 0
7376 @end example
7377 @end deffn
7378
7379 @subsection mFlash commands
7380 @cindex mFlash commands
7381
7382 @deffn Command {mflash config pll} frequency
7383 Configure mflash PLL.
7384 The @var{frequency} is the mflash input frequency, in Hz.
7385 Issuing this command will erase mflash's whole internal nand and write new pll.
7386 After this command, mflash needs power-on-reset for normal operation.
7387 If pll was newly configured, storage and boot(optional) info also need to be update.
7388 @end deffn
7389
7390 @deffn Command {mflash config boot}
7391 Configure bootable option.
7392 If bootable option is set, mflash offer the first 8 sectors
7393 (4kB) for boot.
7394 @end deffn
7395
7396 @deffn Command {mflash config storage}
7397 Configure storage information.
7398 For the normal storage operation, this information must be
7399 written.
7400 @end deffn
7401
7402 @deffn Command {mflash dump} num filename offset size
7403 Dump @var{size} bytes, starting at @var{offset} bytes from the
7404 beginning of the bank @var{num}, to the file named @var{filename}.
7405 @end deffn
7406
7407 @deffn Command {mflash probe}
7408 Probe mflash.
7409 @end deffn
7410
7411 @deffn Command {mflash write} num filename offset
7412 Write the binary file @var{filename} to mflash bank @var{num}, starting at
7413 @var{offset} bytes from the beginning of the bank.
7414 @end deffn
7415
7416 @node Flash Programming
7417 @chapter Flash Programming
7418
7419 OpenOCD implements numerous ways to program the target flash, whether internal or external.
7420 Programming can be achieved by either using GDB @ref{programmingusinggdb,,Programming using GDB},
7421 or using the commands given in @ref{flashprogrammingcommands,,Flash Programming Commands}.
7422
7423 @*To simplify using the flash commands directly a jimtcl script is available that handles the programming and verify stage.
7424 OpenOCD will program/verify/reset the target and optionally shutdown.
7425
7426 The script is executed as follows and by default the following actions will be performed.
7427 @enumerate
7428 @item 'init' is executed.
7429 @item 'reset init' is called to reset and halt the target, any 'reset init' scripts are executed.
7430 @item @code{flash write_image} is called to erase and write any flash using the filename given.
7431 @item @code{verify_image} is called if @option{verify} parameter is given.
7432 @item @code{reset run} is called if @option{reset} parameter is given.
7433 @item OpenOCD is shutdown if @option{exit} parameter is given.
7434 @end enumerate
7435
7436 An example of usage is given below. @xref{program}.
7437
7438 @example
7439 # program and verify using elf/hex/s19. verify and reset
7440 # are optional parameters
7441 openocd -f board/stm32f3discovery.cfg \
7442 -c "program filename.elf verify reset exit"
7443
7444 # binary files need the flash address passing
7445 openocd -f board/stm32f3discovery.cfg \
7446 -c "program filename.bin exit 0x08000000"
7447 @end example
7448
7449 @node PLD/FPGA Commands
7450 @chapter PLD/FPGA Commands
7451 @cindex PLD
7452 @cindex FPGA
7453
7454 Programmable Logic Devices (PLDs) and the more flexible
7455 Field Programmable Gate Arrays (FPGAs) are both types of programmable hardware.
7456 OpenOCD can support programming them.
7457 Although PLDs are generally restrictive (cells are less functional, and
7458 there are no special purpose cells for memory or computational tasks),
7459 they share the same OpenOCD infrastructure.
7460 Accordingly, both are called PLDs here.
7461
7462 @section PLD/FPGA Configuration and Commands
7463
7464 As it does for JTAG TAPs, debug targets, and flash chips (both NOR and NAND),
7465 OpenOCD maintains a list of PLDs available for use in various commands.
7466 Also, each such PLD requires a driver.
7467
7468 They are referenced by the number shown by the @command{pld devices} command,
7469 and new PLDs are defined by @command{pld device driver_name}.
7470
7471 @deffn {Config Command} {pld device} driver_name tap_name [driver_options]
7472 Defines a new PLD device, supported by driver @var{driver_name},
7473 using the TAP named @var{tap_name}.
7474 The driver may make use of any @var{driver_options} to configure its
7475 behavior.
7476 @end deffn
7477
7478 @deffn {Command} {pld devices}
7479 Lists the PLDs and their numbers.
7480 @end deffn
7481
7482 @deffn {Command} {pld load} num filename
7483 Loads the file @file{filename} into the PLD identified by @var{num}.
7484 The file format must be inferred by the driver.
7485 @end deffn
7486
7487 @section PLD/FPGA Drivers, Options, and Commands
7488
7489 Drivers may support PLD-specific options to the @command{pld device}
7490 definition command, and may also define commands usable only with
7491 that particular type of PLD.
7492
7493 @deffn {FPGA Driver} virtex2 [no_jstart]
7494 Virtex-II is a family of FPGAs sold by Xilinx.
7495 It supports the IEEE 1532 standard for In-System Configuration (ISC).
7496
7497 If @var{no_jstart} is non-zero, the JSTART instruction is not used after
7498 loading the bitstream. While required for Series2, Series3, and Series6, it
7499 breaks bitstream loading on Series7.
7500
7501 @deffn {Command} {virtex2 read_stat} num
7502 Reads and displays the Virtex-II status register (STAT)
7503 for FPGA @var{num}.
7504 @end deffn
7505 @end deffn
7506
7507 @node General Commands
7508 @chapter General Commands
7509 @cindex commands
7510
7511 The commands documented in this chapter here are common commands that
7512 you, as a human, may want to type and see the output of. Configuration type
7513 commands are documented elsewhere.
7514
7515 Intent:
7516 @itemize @bullet
7517 @item @b{Source Of Commands}
7518 @* OpenOCD commands can occur in a configuration script (discussed
7519 elsewhere) or typed manually by a human or supplied programmatically,
7520 or via one of several TCP/IP Ports.
7521
7522 @item @b{From the human}
7523 @* A human should interact with the telnet interface (default port: 4444)
7524 or via GDB (default port 3333).
7525
7526 To issue commands from within a GDB session, use the @option{monitor}
7527 command, e.g. use @option{monitor poll} to issue the @option{poll}
7528 command. All output is relayed through the GDB session.
7529
7530 @item @b{Machine Interface}
7531 The Tcl interface's intent is to be a machine interface. The default Tcl
7532 port is 5555.
7533 @end itemize
7534
7535
7536 @section Server Commands
7537
7538 @deffn {Command} exit
7539 Exits the current telnet session.
7540 @end deffn
7541
7542 @deffn {Command} help [string]
7543 With no parameters, prints help text for all commands.
7544 Otherwise, prints each helptext containing @var{string}.
7545 Not every command provides helptext.
7546
7547 Configuration commands, and commands valid at any time, are
7548 explicitly noted in parenthesis.
7549 In most cases, no such restriction is listed; this indicates commands
7550 which are only available after the configuration stage has completed.
7551 @end deffn
7552
7553 @deffn Command sleep msec [@option{busy}]
7554 Wait for at least @var{msec} milliseconds before resuming.
7555 If @option{busy} is passed, busy-wait instead of sleeping.
7556 (This option is strongly discouraged.)
7557 Useful in connection with script files
7558 (@command{script} command and @command{target_name} configuration).
7559 @end deffn
7560
7561 @deffn Command shutdown [@option{error}]
7562 Close the OpenOCD server, disconnecting all clients (GDB, telnet,
7563 other). If option @option{error} is used, OpenOCD will return a
7564 non-zero exit code to the parent process.
7565
7566 Like any TCL commands, also @command{shutdown} can be redefined, e.g.:
7567 @example
7568 # redefine shutdown
7569 rename shutdown original_shutdown
7570 proc shutdown @{@} @{
7571 puts "This is my implementation of shutdown"
7572 # my own stuff before exit OpenOCD
7573 original_shutdown
7574 @}
7575 @end example
7576 If user types CTRL-C or kills OpenOCD, either the command @command{shutdown}
7577 or its replacement will be automatically executed before OpenOCD exits.
7578 @end deffn
7579
7580 @anchor{debuglevel}
7581 @deffn Command debug_level [n]
7582 @cindex message level
7583 Display debug level.
7584 If @var{n} (from 0..4) is provided, then set it to that level.
7585 This affects the kind of messages sent to the server log.
7586 Level 0 is error messages only;
7587 level 1 adds warnings;
7588 level 2 adds informational messages;
7589 level 3 adds debugging messages;
7590 and level 4 adds verbose low-level debug messages.
7591 The default is level 2, but that can be overridden on
7592 the command line along with the location of that log
7593 file (which is normally the server's standard output).
7594 @xref{Running}.
7595 @end deffn
7596
7597 @deffn Command echo [-n] message
7598 Logs a message at "user" priority.
7599 Output @var{message} to stdout.
7600 Option "-n" suppresses trailing newline.
7601 @example
7602 echo "Downloading kernel -- please wait"
7603 @end example
7604 @end deffn
7605
7606 @deffn Command log_output [filename]
7607 Redirect logging to @var{filename};
7608 the initial log output channel is stderr.
7609 @end deffn
7610
7611 @deffn Command add_script_search_dir [directory]
7612 Add @var{directory} to the file/script search path.
7613 @end deffn
7614
7615 @deffn Command bindto [@var{name}]
7616 Specify hostname or IPv4 address on which to listen for incoming
7617 TCP/IP connections. By default, OpenOCD will listen on the loopback
7618 interface only. If your network environment is safe, @code{bindto
7619 0.0.0.0} can be used to cover all available interfaces.
7620 @end deffn
7621
7622 @anchor{targetstatehandling}
7623 @section Target State handling
7624 @cindex reset
7625 @cindex halt
7626 @cindex target initialization
7627
7628 In this section ``target'' refers to a CPU configured as
7629 shown earlier (@pxref{CPU Configuration}).
7630 These commands, like many, implicitly refer to
7631 a current target which is used to perform the
7632 various operations. The current target may be changed
7633 by using @command{targets} command with the name of the
7634 target which should become current.
7635
7636 @deffn Command reg [(number|name) [(value|'force')]]
7637 Access a single register by @var{number} or by its @var{name}.
7638 The target must generally be halted before access to CPU core
7639 registers is allowed. Depending on the hardware, some other
7640 registers may be accessible while the target is running.
7641
7642 @emph{With no arguments}:
7643 list all available registers for the current target,
7644 showing number, name, size, value, and cache status.
7645 For valid entries, a value is shown; valid entries
7646 which are also dirty (and will be written back later)
7647 are flagged as such.
7648
7649 @emph{With number/name}: display that register's value.
7650 Use @var{force} argument to read directly from the target,
7651 bypassing any internal cache.
7652
7653 @emph{With both number/name and value}: set register's value.
7654 Writes may be held in a writeback cache internal to OpenOCD,
7655 so that setting the value marks the register as dirty instead
7656 of immediately flushing that value. Resuming CPU execution
7657 (including by single stepping) or otherwise activating the
7658 relevant module will flush such values.
7659
7660 Cores may have surprisingly many registers in their
7661 Debug and trace infrastructure:
7662
7663 @example
7664 > reg
7665 ===== ARM registers
7666 (0) r0 (/32): 0x0000D3C2 (dirty)
7667 (1) r1 (/32): 0xFD61F31C
7668 (2) r2 (/32)
7669 ...
7670 (164) ETM_contextid_comparator_mask (/32)
7671 >
7672 @end example
7673 @end deffn
7674
7675 @deffn Command halt [ms]
7676 @deffnx Command wait_halt [ms]
7677 The @command{halt} command first sends a halt request to the target,
7678 which @command{wait_halt} doesn't.
7679 Otherwise these behave the same: wait up to @var{ms} milliseconds,
7680 or 5 seconds if there is no parameter, for the target to halt
7681 (and enter debug mode).
7682 Using 0 as the @var{ms} parameter prevents OpenOCD from waiting.
7683
7684 @quotation Warning
7685 On ARM cores, software using the @emph{wait for interrupt} operation
7686 often blocks the JTAG access needed by a @command{halt} command.
7687 This is because that operation also puts the core into a low
7688 power mode by gating the core clock;
7689 but the core clock is needed to detect JTAG clock transitions.
7690
7691 One partial workaround uses adaptive clocking: when the core is
7692 interrupted the operation completes, then JTAG clocks are accepted
7693 at least until the interrupt handler completes.
7694 However, this workaround is often unusable since the processor, board,
7695 and JTAG adapter must all support adaptive JTAG clocking.
7696 Also, it can't work until an interrupt is issued.
7697
7698 A more complete workaround is to not use that operation while you
7699 work with a JTAG debugger.
7700 Tasking environments generally have idle loops where the body is the
7701 @emph{wait for interrupt} operation.
7702 (On older cores, it is a coprocessor action;
7703 newer cores have a @option{wfi} instruction.)
7704 Such loops can just remove that operation, at the cost of higher
7705 power consumption (because the CPU is needlessly clocked).
7706 @end quotation
7707
7708 @end deffn
7709
7710 @deffn Command resume [address]
7711 Resume the target at its current code position,
7712 or the optional @var{address} if it is provided.
7713 OpenOCD will wait 5 seconds for the target to resume.
7714 @end deffn
7715
7716 @deffn Command step [address]
7717 Single-step the target at its current code position,
7718 or the optional @var{address} if it is provided.
7719 @end deffn
7720
7721 @anchor{resetcommand}
7722 @deffn Command reset
7723 @deffnx Command {reset run}
7724 @deffnx Command {reset halt}
7725 @deffnx Command {reset init}
7726 Perform as hard a reset as possible, using SRST if possible.
7727 @emph{All defined targets will be reset, and target
7728 events will fire during the reset sequence.}
7729
7730 The optional parameter specifies what should
7731 happen after the reset.
7732 If there is no parameter, a @command{reset run} is executed.
7733 The other options will not work on all systems.
7734 @xref{Reset Configuration}.
7735
7736 @itemize @minus
7737 @item @b{run} Let the target run
7738 @item @b{halt} Immediately halt the target
7739 @item @b{init} Immediately halt the target, and execute the reset-init script
7740 @end itemize
7741 @end deffn
7742
7743 @deffn Command soft_reset_halt
7744 Requesting target halt and executing a soft reset. This is often used
7745 when a target cannot be reset and halted. The target, after reset is
7746 released begins to execute code. OpenOCD attempts to stop the CPU and
7747 then sets the program counter back to the reset vector. Unfortunately
7748 the code that was executed may have left the hardware in an unknown
7749 state.
7750 @end deffn
7751
7752 @section I/O Utilities
7753
7754 These commands are available when
7755 OpenOCD is built with @option{--enable-ioutil}.
7756 They are mainly useful on embedded targets,
7757 notably the ZY1000.
7758 Hosts with operating systems have complementary tools.
7759
7760 @emph{Note:} there are several more such commands.
7761
7762 @deffn Command append_file filename [string]*
7763 Appends the @var{string} parameters to
7764 the text file @file{filename}.
7765 Each string except the last one is followed by one space.
7766 The last string is followed by a newline.
7767 @end deffn
7768
7769 @deffn Command cat filename
7770 Reads and displays the text file @file{filename}.
7771 @end deffn
7772
7773 @deffn Command cp src_filename dest_filename
7774 Copies contents from the file @file{src_filename}
7775 into @file{dest_filename}.
7776 @end deffn
7777
7778 @deffn Command ip
7779 @emph{No description provided.}
7780 @end deffn
7781
7782 @deffn Command ls
7783 @emph{No description provided.}
7784 @end deffn
7785
7786 @deffn Command mac
7787 @emph{No description provided.}
7788 @end deffn
7789
7790 @deffn Command meminfo
7791 Display available RAM memory on OpenOCD host.
7792 Used in OpenOCD regression testing scripts.
7793 @end deffn
7794
7795 @deffn Command peek
7796 @emph{No description provided.}
7797 @end deffn
7798
7799 @deffn Command poke
7800 @emph{No description provided.}
7801 @end deffn
7802
7803 @deffn Command rm filename
7804 @c "rm" has both normal and Jim-level versions??
7805 Unlinks the file @file{filename}.
7806 @end deffn
7807
7808 @deffn Command trunc filename
7809 Removes all data in the file @file{filename}.
7810 @end deffn
7811
7812 @anchor{memoryaccess}
7813 @section Memory access commands
7814 @cindex memory access
7815
7816 These commands allow accesses of a specific size to the memory
7817 system. Often these are used to configure the current target in some
7818 special way. For example - one may need to write certain values to the
7819 SDRAM controller to enable SDRAM.
7820
7821 @enumerate
7822 @item Use the @command{targets} (plural) command
7823 to change the current target.
7824 @item In system level scripts these commands are deprecated.
7825 Please use their TARGET object siblings to avoid making assumptions
7826 about what TAP is the current target, or about MMU configuration.
7827 @end enumerate
7828
7829 @deffn Command mdw [phys] addr [count]
7830 @deffnx Command mdh [phys] addr [count]
7831 @deffnx Command mdb [phys] addr [count]
7832 Display contents of address @var{addr}, as
7833 32-bit words (@command{mdw}), 16-bit halfwords (@command{mdh}),
7834 or 8-bit bytes (@command{mdb}).
7835 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
7836 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
7837 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
7838 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
7839 If @var{count} is specified, displays that many units.
7840 (If you want to manipulate the data instead of displaying it,
7841 see the @code{mem2array} primitives.)
7842 @end deffn
7843
7844 @deffn Command mww [phys] addr word
7845 @deffnx Command mwh [phys] addr halfword
7846 @deffnx Command mwb [phys] addr byte
7847 Writes the specified @var{word} (32 bits),
7848 @var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) value,
7849 at the specified address @var{addr}.
7850 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
7851 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
7852 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
7853 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
7854 @end deffn
7855
7856 @anchor{imageaccess}
7857 @section Image loading commands
7858 @cindex image loading
7859 @cindex image dumping
7860
7861 @deffn Command {dump_image} filename address size
7862 Dump @var{size} bytes of target memory starting at @var{address} to the
7863 binary file named @var{filename}.
7864 @end deffn
7865
7866 @deffn Command {fast_load}
7867 Loads an image stored in memory by @command{fast_load_image} to the
7868 current target. Must be preceded by fast_load_image.
7869 @end deffn
7870
7871 @deffn Command {fast_load_image} filename address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}|@option{s19}]
7872 Normally you should be using @command{load_image} or GDB load. However, for
7873 testing purposes or when I/O overhead is significant(OpenOCD running on an embedded
7874 host), storing the image in memory and uploading the image to the target
7875 can be a way to upload e.g. multiple debug sessions when the binary does not change.
7876 Arguments are the same as @command{load_image}, but the image is stored in OpenOCD host
7877 memory, i.e. does not affect target. This approach is also useful when profiling
7878 target programming performance as I/O and target programming can easily be profiled
7879 separately.
7880 @end deffn
7881
7882 @deffn Command {load_image} filename address [[@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}|@option{s19}] @option{min_addr} @option{max_length}]
7883 Load image from file @var{filename} to target memory offset by @var{address} from its load address.
7884 The file format may optionally be specified
7885 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, @option{elf}, or @option{s19}).
7886 In addition the following arguments may be specified:
7887 @var{min_addr} - ignore data below @var{min_addr} (this is w.r.t. to the target's load address + @var{address})
7888 @var{max_length} - maximum number of bytes to load.
7889 @example
7890 proc load_image_bin @{fname foffset address length @} @{
7891 # Load data from fname filename at foffset offset to
7892 # target at address. Load at most length bytes.
7893 load_image $fname [expr $address - $foffset] bin \
7894 $address $length
7895 @}
7896 @end example
7897 @end deffn
7898
7899 @deffn Command {test_image} filename [address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}]]
7900 Displays image section sizes and addresses
7901 as if @var{filename} were loaded into target memory
7902 starting at @var{address} (defaults to zero).
7903 The file format may optionally be specified
7904 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, or @option{elf})
7905 @end deffn
7906
7907 @deffn Command {verify_image} filename address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}]
7908 Verify @var{filename} against target memory starting at @var{address}.
7909 The file format may optionally be specified
7910 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, or @option{elf})
7911 This will first attempt a comparison using a CRC checksum, if this fails it will try a binary compare.
7912 @end deffn
7913
7914 @deffn Command {verify_image_checksum} filename address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}]
7915 Verify @var{filename} against target memory starting at @var{address}.
7916 The file format may optionally be specified
7917 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, or @option{elf})
7918 This perform a comparison using a CRC checksum only
7919 @end deffn
7920
7921
7922 @section Breakpoint and Watchpoint commands
7923 @cindex breakpoint
7924 @cindex watchpoint
7925
7926 CPUs often make debug modules accessible through JTAG, with
7927 hardware support for a handful of code breakpoints and data
7928 watchpoints.
7929 In addition, CPUs almost always support software breakpoints.
7930
7931 @deffn Command {bp} [address len [@option{hw}]]
7932 With no parameters, lists all active breakpoints.
7933 Else sets a breakpoint on code execution starting
7934 at @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
7935 This is a software breakpoint, unless @option{hw} is specified
7936 in which case it will be a hardware breakpoint.
7937
7938 (@xref{arm9vectorcatch,,arm9 vector_catch}, or @pxref{xscalevectorcatch,,xscale vector_catch},
7939 for similar mechanisms that do not consume hardware breakpoints.)
7940 @end deffn
7941
7942 @deffn Command {rbp} address
7943 Remove the breakpoint at @var{address}.
7944 @end deffn
7945
7946 @deffn Command {rwp} address
7947 Remove data watchpoint on @var{address}
7948 @end deffn
7949
7950 @deffn Command {wp} [address len [(@option{r}|@option{w}|@option{a}) [value [mask]]]]
7951 With no parameters, lists all active watchpoints.
7952 Else sets a data watchpoint on data from @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
7953 The watch point is an "access" watchpoint unless
7954 the @option{r} or @option{w} parameter is provided,
7955 defining it as respectively a read or write watchpoint.
7956 If a @var{value} is provided, that value is used when determining if
7957 the watchpoint should trigger. The value may be first be masked
7958 using @var{mask} to mark ``don't care'' fields.
7959 @end deffn
7960
7961 @section Misc Commands
7962
7963 @cindex profiling
7964 @deffn Command {profile} seconds filename [start end]
7965 Profiling samples the CPU's program counter as quickly as possible,
7966 which is useful for non-intrusive stochastic profiling.
7967 Saves up to 10000 samples in @file{filename} using ``gmon.out''
7968 format. Optional @option{start} and @option{end} parameters allow to
7969 limit the address range.
7970 @end deffn
7971
7972 @deffn Command {version}
7973 Displays a string identifying the version of this OpenOCD server.
7974 @end deffn
7975
7976 @deffn Command {virt2phys} virtual_address
7977 Requests the current target to map the specified @var{virtual_address}
7978 to its corresponding physical address, and displays the result.
7979 @end deffn
7980
7981 @node Architecture and Core Commands
7982 @chapter Architecture and Core Commands
7983 @cindex Architecture Specific Commands
7984 @cindex Core Specific Commands
7985
7986 Most CPUs have specialized JTAG operations to support debugging.
7987 OpenOCD packages most such operations in its standard command framework.
7988 Some of those operations don't fit well in that framework, so they are
7989 exposed here as architecture or implementation (core) specific commands.
7990
7991 @anchor{armhardwaretracing}
7992 @section ARM Hardware Tracing
7993 @cindex tracing
7994 @cindex ETM
7995 @cindex ETB
7996
7997 CPUs based on ARM cores may include standard tracing interfaces,
7998 based on an ``Embedded Trace Module'' (ETM) which sends voluminous
7999 address and data bus trace records to a ``Trace Port''.
8000
8001 @itemize
8002 @item
8003 Development-oriented boards will sometimes provide a high speed
8004 trace connector for collecting that data, when the particular CPU
8005 supports such an interface.
8006 (The standard connector is a 38-pin Mictor, with both JTAG
8007 and trace port support.)
8008 Those trace connectors are supported by higher end JTAG adapters
8009 and some logic analyzer modules; frequently those modules can
8010 buffer several megabytes of trace data.
8011 Configuring an ETM coupled to such an external trace port belongs
8012 in the board-specific configuration file.
8013 @item
8014 If the CPU doesn't provide an external interface, it probably
8015 has an ``Embedded Trace Buffer'' (ETB) on the chip, which is a
8016 dedicated SRAM. 4KBytes is one common ETB size.
8017 Configuring an ETM coupled only to an ETB belongs in the CPU-specific
8018 (target) configuration file, since it works the same on all boards.
8019 @end itemize
8020
8021 ETM support in OpenOCD doesn't seem to be widely used yet.
8022
8023 @quotation Issues
8024 ETM support may be buggy, and at least some @command{etm config}
8025 parameters should be detected by asking the ETM for them.
8026
8027 ETM trigger events could also implement a kind of complex
8028 hardware breakpoint, much more powerful than the simple
8029 watchpoint hardware exported by EmbeddedICE modules.
8030 @emph{Such breakpoints can be triggered even when using the
8031 dummy trace port driver}.
8032
8033 It seems like a GDB hookup should be possible,
8034 as well as tracing only during specific states
8035 (perhaps @emph{handling IRQ 23} or @emph{calls foo()}).
8036
8037 There should be GUI tools to manipulate saved trace data and help
8038 analyse it in conjunction with the source code.
8039 It's unclear how much of a common interface is shared
8040 with the current XScale trace support, or should be
8041 shared with eventual Nexus-style trace module support.
8042
8043 At this writing (November 2009) only ARM7, ARM9, and ARM11 support
8044 for ETM modules is available. The code should be able to
8045 work with some newer cores; but not all of them support
8046 this original style of JTAG access.
8047 @end quotation
8048
8049 @subsection ETM Configuration
8050 ETM setup is coupled with the trace port driver configuration.
8051
8052 @deffn {Config Command} {etm config} target width mode clocking driver
8053 Declares the ETM associated with @var{target}, and associates it
8054 with a given trace port @var{driver}. @xref{traceportdrivers,,Trace Port Drivers}.
8055
8056 Several of the parameters must reflect the trace port capabilities,
8057 which are a function of silicon capabilities (exposed later
8058 using @command{etm info}) and of what hardware is connected to
8059 that port (such as an external pod, or ETB).
8060 The @var{width} must be either 4, 8, or 16,
8061 except with ETMv3.0 and newer modules which may also
8062 support 1, 2, 24, 32, 48, and 64 bit widths.
8063 (With those versions, @command{etm info} also shows whether
8064 the selected port width and mode are supported.)
8065
8066 The @var{mode} must be @option{normal}, @option{multiplexed},
8067 or @option{demultiplexed}.
8068 The @var{clocking} must be @option{half} or @option{full}.
8069
8070 @quotation Warning
8071 With ETMv3.0 and newer, the bits set with the @var{mode} and
8072 @var{clocking} parameters both control the mode.
8073 This modified mode does not map to the values supported by
8074 previous ETM modules, so this syntax is subject to change.
8075 @end quotation
8076
8077 @quotation Note
8078 You can see the ETM registers using the @command{reg} command.
8079 Not all possible registers are present in every ETM.
8080 Most of the registers are write-only, and are used to configure
8081 what CPU activities are traced.
8082 @end quotation
8083 @end deffn
8084
8085 @deffn Command {etm info}
8086 Displays information about the current target's ETM.
8087 This includes resource counts from the @code{ETM_CONFIG} register,
8088 as well as silicon capabilities (except on rather old modules).
8089 from the @code{ETM_SYS_CONFIG} register.
8090 @end deffn
8091
8092 @deffn Command {etm status}
8093 Displays status of the current target's ETM and trace port driver:
8094 is the ETM idle, or is it collecting data?
8095 Did trace data overflow?
8096 Was it triggered?
8097 @end deffn
8098
8099 @deffn Command {etm tracemode} [type context_id_bits cycle_accurate branch_output]
8100 Displays what data that ETM will collect.
8101 If arguments are provided, first configures that data.
8102 When the configuration changes, tracing is stopped
8103 and any buffered trace data is invalidated.
8104
8105 @itemize
8106 @item @var{type} ... describing how data accesses are traced,
8107 when they pass any ViewData filtering that that was set up.
8108 The value is one of
8109 @option{none} (save nothing),
8110 @option{data} (save data),
8111 @option{address} (save addresses),
8112 @option{all} (save data and addresses)
8113 @item @var{context_id_bits} ... 0, 8, 16, or 32
8114 @item @var{cycle_accurate} ... @option{enable} or @option{disable}
8115 cycle-accurate instruction tracing.
8116 Before ETMv3, enabling this causes much extra data to be recorded.
8117 @item @var{branch_output} ... @option{enable} or @option{disable}.
8118 Disable this unless you need to try reconstructing the instruction
8119 trace stream without an image of the code.
8120 @end itemize
8121 @end deffn
8122
8123 @deffn Command {etm trigger_debug} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
8124 Displays whether ETM triggering debug entry (like a breakpoint) is
8125 enabled or disabled, after optionally modifying that configuration.
8126 The default behaviour is @option{disable}.
8127 Any change takes effect after the next @command{etm start}.
8128
8129 By using script commands to configure ETM registers, you can make the
8130 processor enter debug state automatically when certain conditions,
8131 more complex than supported by the breakpoint hardware, happen.
8132 @end deffn
8133
8134 @subsection ETM Trace Operation
8135
8136 After setting up the ETM, you can use it to collect data.
8137 That data can be exported to files for later analysis.
8138 It can also be parsed with OpenOCD, for basic sanity checking.
8139
8140 To configure what is being traced, you will need to write
8141 various trace registers using @command{reg ETM_*} commands.
8142 For the definitions of these registers, read ARM publication
8143 @emph{IHI 0014, ``Embedded Trace Macrocell, Architecture Specification''}.
8144 Be aware that most of the relevant registers are write-only,
8145 and that ETM resources are limited. There are only a handful
8146 of address comparators, data comparators, counters, and so on.
8147
8148 Examples of scenarios you might arrange to trace include:
8149
8150 @itemize
8151 @item Code flow within a function, @emph{excluding} subroutines
8152 it calls. Use address range comparators to enable tracing
8153 for instruction access within that function's body.
8154 @item Code flow within a function, @emph{including} subroutines
8155 it calls. Use the sequencer and address comparators to activate
8156 tracing on an ``entered function'' state, then deactivate it by
8157 exiting that state when the function's exit code is invoked.
8158 @item Code flow starting at the fifth invocation of a function,
8159 combining one of the above models with a counter.
8160 @item CPU data accesses to the registers for a particular device,
8161 using address range comparators and the ViewData logic.
8162 @item Such data accesses only during IRQ handling, combining the above
8163 model with sequencer triggers which on entry and exit to the IRQ handler.
8164 @item @emph{... more}
8165 @end itemize
8166
8167 At this writing, September 2009, there are no Tcl utility
8168 procedures to help set up any common tracing scenarios.
8169
8170 @deffn Command {etm analyze}
8171 Reads trace data into memory, if it wasn't already present.
8172 Decodes and prints the data that was collected.
8173 @end deffn
8174
8175 @deffn Command {etm dump} filename
8176 Stores the captured trace data in @file{filename}.
8177 @end deffn
8178
8179 @deffn Command {etm image} filename [base_address] [type]
8180 Opens an image file.
8181 @end deffn
8182
8183 @deffn Command {etm load} filename
8184 Loads captured trace data from @file{filename}.
8185 @end deffn
8186
8187 @deffn Command {etm start}
8188 Starts trace data collection.
8189 @end deffn
8190
8191 @deffn Command {etm stop}
8192 Stops trace data collection.
8193 @end deffn
8194
8195 @anchor{traceportdrivers}
8196 @subsection Trace Port Drivers
8197
8198 To use an ETM trace port it must be associated with a driver.
8199
8200 @deffn {Trace Port Driver} dummy
8201 Use the @option{dummy} driver if you are configuring an ETM that's
8202 not connected to anything (on-chip ETB or off-chip trace connector).
8203 @emph{This driver lets OpenOCD talk to the ETM, but it does not expose
8204 any trace data collection.}
8205 @deffn {Config Command} {etm_dummy config} target
8206 Associates the ETM for @var{target} with a dummy driver.
8207 @end deffn
8208 @end deffn
8209
8210 @deffn {Trace Port Driver} etb
8211 Use the @option{etb} driver if you are configuring an ETM
8212 to use on-chip ETB memory.
8213 @deffn {Config Command} {etb config} target etb_tap
8214 Associates the ETM for @var{target} with the ETB at @var{etb_tap}.
8215 You can see the ETB registers using the @command{reg} command.
8216 @end deffn
8217 @deffn Command {etb trigger_percent} [percent]
8218 This displays, or optionally changes, ETB behavior after the
8219 ETM's configured @emph{trigger} event fires.
8220 It controls how much more trace data is saved after the (single)
8221 trace trigger becomes active.
8222
8223 @itemize
8224 @item The default corresponds to @emph{trace around} usage,
8225 recording 50 percent data before the event and the rest
8226 afterwards.
8227 @item The minimum value of @var{percent} is 2 percent,
8228 recording almost exclusively data before the trigger.
8229 Such extreme @emph{trace before} usage can help figure out
8230 what caused that event to happen.
8231 @item The maximum value of @var{percent} is 100 percent,
8232 recording data almost exclusively after the event.
8233 This extreme @emph{trace after} usage might help sort out
8234 how the event caused trouble.
8235 @end itemize
8236 @c REVISIT allow "break" too -- enter debug mode.
8237 @end deffn
8238
8239 @end deffn
8240
8241 @deffn {Trace Port Driver} oocd_trace
8242 This driver isn't available unless OpenOCD was explicitly configured
8243 with the @option{--enable-oocd_trace} option. You probably don't want
8244 to configure it unless you've built the appropriate prototype hardware;
8245 it's @emph{proof-of-concept} software.
8246
8247 Use the @option{oocd_trace} driver if you are configuring an ETM that's
8248 connected to an off-chip trace connector.
8249
8250 @deffn {Config Command} {oocd_trace config} target tty
8251 Associates the ETM for @var{target} with a trace driver which
8252 collects data through the serial port @var{tty}.
8253 @end deffn
8254
8255 @deffn Command {oocd_trace resync}
8256 Re-synchronizes with the capture clock.
8257 @end deffn
8258
8259 @deffn Command {oocd_trace status}
8260 Reports whether the capture clock is locked or not.
8261 @end deffn
8262 @end deffn
8263
8264 @anchor{armcrosstrigger}
8265 @section ARM Cross-Trigger Interface
8266 @cindex CTI
8267
8268 The ARM Cross-Trigger Interface (CTI) is a generic CoreSight component
8269 that connects event sources like tracing components or CPU cores with each
8270 other through a common trigger matrix (CTM). For ARMv8 architecture, a
8271 CTI is mandatory for core run control and each core has an individual
8272 CTI instance attached to it. OpenOCD has limited support for CTI using
8273 the @emph{cti} group of commands.
8274
8275 @deffn Command {cti create} cti_name @option{-dap} dap_name @option{-ap-num} apn @option{-ctibase} base_address
8276 Creates a CTI instance @var{cti_name} on the DAP instance @var{dap_name} on MEM-AP
8277 @var{apn}. The @var{base_address} must match the base address of the CTI
8278 on the respective MEM-AP. All arguments are mandatory. This creates a
8279 new command @command{$cti_name} which is used for various purposes
8280 including additional configuration.
8281 @end deffn
8282
8283 @deffn Command {$cti_name enable} @option{on|off}
8284 Enable (@option{on}) or disable (@option{off}) the CTI.
8285 @end deffn
8286
8287 @deffn Command {$cti_name dump}
8288 Displays a register dump of the CTI.
8289 @end deffn
8290
8291 @deffn Command {$cti_name write } @var{reg_name} @var{value}
8292 Write @var{value} to the CTI register with the symbolic name @var{reg_name}.
8293 @end deffn
8294
8295 @deffn Command {$cti_name read} @var{reg_name}
8296 Print the value read from the CTI register with the symbolic name @var{reg_name}.
8297 @end deffn
8298
8299 @deffn Command {$cti_name testmode} @option{on|off}
8300 Enable (@option{on}) or disable (@option{off}) the integration test mode
8301 of the CTI.
8302 @end deffn
8303
8304 @deffn Command {cti names}
8305 Prints a list of names of all CTI objects created. This command is mainly
8306 useful in TCL scripting.
8307 @end deffn
8308
8309 @section Generic ARM
8310 @cindex ARM
8311
8312 These commands should be available on all ARM processors.
8313 They are available in addition to other core-specific
8314 commands that may be available.
8315
8316 @deffn Command {arm core_state} [@option{arm}|@option{thumb}]
8317 Displays the core_state, optionally changing it to process
8318 either @option{arm} or @option{thumb} instructions.
8319 The target may later be resumed in the currently set core_state.
8320 (Processors may also support the Jazelle state, but
8321 that is not currently supported in OpenOCD.)
8322 @end deffn
8323
8324 @deffn Command {arm disassemble} address [count [@option{thumb}]]
8325 @cindex disassemble
8326 Disassembles @var{count} instructions starting at @var{address}.
8327 If @var{count} is not specified, a single instruction is disassembled.
8328 If @option{thumb} is specified, or the low bit of the address is set,
8329 Thumb2 (mixed 16/32-bit) instructions are used;
8330 else ARM (32-bit) instructions are used.
8331 (Processors may also support the Jazelle state, but
8332 those instructions are not currently understood by OpenOCD.)
8333
8334 Note that all Thumb instructions are Thumb2 instructions,
8335 so older processors (without Thumb2 support) will still
8336 see correct disassembly of Thumb code.
8337 Also, ThumbEE opcodes are the same as Thumb2,
8338 with a handful of exceptions.
8339 ThumbEE disassembly currently has no explicit support.
8340 @end deffn
8341
8342 @deffn Command {arm mcr} pX op1 CRn CRm op2 value
8343 Write @var{value} to a coprocessor @var{pX} register
8344 passing parameters @var{CRn},
8345 @var{CRm}, opcodes @var{opc1} and @var{opc2},
8346 and using the MCR instruction.
8347 (Parameter sequence matches the ARM instruction, but omits
8348 an ARM register.)
8349 @end deffn
8350
8351 @deffn Command {arm mrc} pX coproc op1 CRn CRm op2
8352 Read a coprocessor @var{pX} register passing parameters @var{CRn},
8353 @var{CRm}, opcodes @var{opc1} and @var{opc2},
8354 and the MRC instruction.
8355 Returns the result so it can be manipulated by Jim scripts.
8356 (Parameter sequence matches the ARM instruction, but omits
8357 an ARM register.)
8358 @end deffn
8359
8360 @deffn Command {arm reg}
8361 Display a table of all banked core registers, fetching the current value from every
8362 core mode if necessary.
8363 @end deffn
8364
8365 @deffn Command {arm semihosting} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8366 @cindex ARM semihosting
8367 Display status of semihosting, after optionally changing that status.
8368
8369 Semihosting allows for code executing on an ARM target to use the
8370 I/O facilities on the host computer i.e. the system where OpenOCD
8371 is running. The target application must be linked against a library
8372 implementing the ARM semihosting convention that forwards operation
8373 requests by using a special SVC instruction that is trapped at the
8374 Supervisor Call vector by OpenOCD.
8375 @end deffn
8376
8377 @deffn Command {arm semihosting_cmdline} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8378 @cindex ARM semihosting
8379 Set the command line to be passed to the debugger.
8380
8381 @example
8382 arm semihosting_cmdline argv0 argv1 argv2 ...
8383 @end example
8384
8385 This option lets one set the command line arguments to be passed to
8386 the program. The first argument (argv0) is the program name in a
8387 standard C environment (argv[0]). Depending on the program (not much
8388 programs look at argv[0]), argv0 is ignored and can be any string.
8389 @end deffn
8390
8391 @deffn Command {arm semihosting_fileio} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8392 @cindex ARM semihosting
8393 Display status of semihosting fileio, after optionally changing that
8394 status.
8395
8396 Enabling this option forwards semihosting I/O to GDB process using the
8397 File-I/O remote protocol extension. This is especially useful for
8398 interacting with remote files or displaying console messages in the
8399 debugger.
8400 @end deffn
8401
8402 @deffn Command {arm semihosting_resexit} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8403 @cindex ARM semihosting
8404 Enable resumable SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT.
8405
8406 When SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT is called outside a debug session,
8407 things are simple, the openocd process calls exit() and passes
8408 the value returned by the target.
8409
8410 When SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT is called during a debug session,
8411 by default execution returns to the debugger, leaving the
8412 debugger in a HALT state, similar to the state entered when
8413 encountering a break.
8414
8415 In some use cases, it is useful to have SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT
8416 return normally, as any semihosting call, and do not break
8417 to the debugger.
8418 The standard allows this to happen, but the condition
8419 to trigger it is a bit obscure ("by performing an RDI_Execute
8420 request or equivalent").
8421
8422 To make the SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT call return normally, enable
8423 this option (default: disabled).
8424 @end deffn
8425
8426 @section ARMv4 and ARMv5 Architecture
8427 @cindex ARMv4
8428 @cindex ARMv5
8429
8430 The ARMv4 and ARMv5 architectures are widely used in embedded systems,
8431 and introduced core parts of the instruction set in use today.
8432 That includes the Thumb instruction set, introduced in the ARMv4T
8433 variant.
8434
8435 @subsection ARM7 and ARM9 specific commands
8436 @cindex ARM7
8437 @cindex ARM9
8438
8439 These commands are specific to ARM7 and ARM9 cores, like ARM7TDMI, ARM720T,
8440 ARM9TDMI, ARM920T or ARM926EJ-S.
8441 They are available in addition to the ARM commands,
8442 and any other core-specific commands that may be available.
8443
8444 @deffn Command {arm7_9 dbgrq} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8445 Displays the value of the flag controlling use of the
8446 the EmbeddedIce DBGRQ signal to force entry into debug mode,
8447 instead of breakpoints.
8448 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
8449
8450 This should be
8451 safe for all but ARM7TDMI-S cores (like NXP LPC).
8452 This feature is enabled by default on most ARM9 cores,
8453 including ARM9TDMI, ARM920T, and ARM926EJ-S.
8454 @end deffn
8455
8456 @deffn Command {arm7_9 dcc_downloads} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8457 @cindex DCC
8458 Displays the value of the flag controlling use of the debug communications
8459 channel (DCC) to write larger (>128 byte) amounts of memory.
8460 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
8461
8462 DCC downloads offer a huge speed increase, but might be
8463 unsafe, especially with targets running at very low speeds. This command was introduced
8464 with OpenOCD rev. 60, and requires a few bytes of working area.
8465 @end deffn
8466
8467 @deffn Command {arm7_9 fast_memory_access} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8468 Displays the value of the flag controlling use of memory writes and reads
8469 that don't check completion of the operation.
8470 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
8471
8472 This provides a huge speed increase, especially with USB JTAG
8473 cables (FT2232), but might be unsafe if used with targets running at very low
8474 speeds, like the 32kHz startup clock of an AT91RM9200.
8475 @end deffn
8476
8477 @subsection ARM720T specific commands
8478 @cindex ARM720T
8479
8480 These commands are available to ARM720T based CPUs,
8481 which are implementations of the ARMv4T architecture
8482 based on the ARM7TDMI-S integer core.
8483 They are available in addition to the ARM and ARM7/ARM9 commands.
8484
8485 @deffn Command {arm720t cp15} opcode [value]
8486 @emph{DEPRECATED -- avoid using this.
8487 Use the @command{arm mrc} or @command{arm mcr} commands instead.}
8488
8489 Display cp15 register returned by the ARM instruction @var{opcode};
8490 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
8491 The @var{opcode} should be the value of either an MRC or MCR instruction.
8492 @end deffn
8493
8494 @subsection ARM9 specific commands
8495 @cindex ARM9
8496
8497 ARM9-family cores are built around ARM9TDMI or ARM9E (including ARM9EJS)
8498 integer processors.
8499 Such cores include the ARM920T, ARM926EJ-S, and ARM966.
8500
8501 @c 9-june-2009: tried this on arm920t, it didn't work.
8502 @c no-params always lists nothing caught, and that's how it acts.
8503 @c 23-oct-2009: doesn't work _consistently_ ... as if the ICE
8504 @c versions have different rules about when they commit writes.
8505
8506 @anchor{arm9vectorcatch}
8507 @deffn Command {arm9 vector_catch} [@option{all}|@option{none}|list]
8508 @cindex vector_catch
8509 Vector Catch hardware provides a sort of dedicated breakpoint
8510 for hardware events such as reset, interrupt, and abort.
8511 You can use this to conserve normal breakpoint resources,
8512 so long as you're not concerned with code that branches directly
8513 to those hardware vectors.
8514
8515 This always finishes by listing the current configuration.
8516 If parameters are provided, it first reconfigures the
8517 vector catch hardware to intercept
8518 @option{all} of the hardware vectors,
8519 @option{none} of them,
8520 or a list with one or more of the following:
8521 @option{reset} @option{undef} @option{swi} @option{pabt} @option{dabt}
8522 @option{irq} @option{fiq}.
8523 @end deffn
8524
8525 @subsection ARM920T specific commands
8526 @cindex ARM920T
8527
8528 These commands are available to ARM920T based CPUs,
8529 which are implementations of the ARMv4T architecture
8530 built using the ARM9TDMI integer core.
8531 They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
8532 and ARM9 commands.
8533
8534 @deffn Command {arm920t cache_info}
8535 Print information about the caches found. This allows to see whether your target
8536 is an ARM920T (2x16kByte cache) or ARM922T (2x8kByte cache).
8537 @end deffn
8538
8539 @deffn Command {arm920t cp15} regnum [value]
8540 Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
8541 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
8542 This uses "physical access" and the register number is as
8543 shown in bits 38..33 of table 9-9 in the ARM920T TRM.
8544 (Not all registers can be written.)
8545 @end deffn
8546
8547 @deffn Command {arm920t cp15i} opcode [value [address]]
8548 @emph{DEPRECATED -- avoid using this.
8549 Use the @command{arm mrc} or @command{arm mcr} commands instead.}
8550
8551 Interpreted access using ARM instruction @var{opcode}, which should
8552 be the value of either an MRC or MCR instruction
8553 (as shown tables 9-11, 9-12, and 9-13 in the ARM920T TRM).
8554 If no @var{value} is provided, the result is displayed.
8555 Else if that value is written using the specified @var{address},
8556 or using zero if no other address is provided.
8557 @end deffn
8558
8559 @deffn Command {arm920t read_cache} filename
8560 Dump the content of ICache and DCache to a file named @file{filename}.
8561 @end deffn
8562
8563 @deffn Command {arm920t read_mmu} filename
8564 Dump the content of the ITLB and DTLB to a file named @file{filename}.
8565 @end deffn
8566
8567 @subsection ARM926ej-s specific commands
8568 @cindex ARM926ej-s
8569
8570 These commands are available to ARM926ej-s based CPUs,
8571 which are implementations of the ARMv5TEJ architecture
8572 based on the ARM9EJ-S integer core.
8573 They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
8574 and ARM9 commands.
8575
8576 The Feroceon cores also support these commands, although
8577 they are not built from ARM926ej-s designs.
8578
8579 @deffn Command {arm926ejs cache_info}
8580 Print information about the caches found.
8581 @end deffn
8582
8583 @subsection ARM966E specific commands
8584 @cindex ARM966E
8585
8586 These commands are available to ARM966 based CPUs,
8587 which are implementations of the ARMv5TE architecture.
8588 They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
8589 and ARM9 commands.
8590
8591 @deffn Command {arm966e cp15} regnum [value]
8592 Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
8593 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
8594 The six bit @var{regnum} values are bits 37..32 from table 7-2 of the
8595 ARM966E-S TRM.
8596 There is no current control over bits 31..30 from that table,
8597 as required for BIST support.
8598 @end deffn
8599
8600 @subsection XScale specific commands
8601 @cindex XScale
8602
8603 Some notes about the debug implementation on the XScale CPUs:
8604
8605 The XScale CPU provides a special debug-only mini-instruction cache
8606 (mini-IC) in which exception vectors and target-resident debug handler
8607 code are placed by OpenOCD. In order to get access to the CPU, OpenOCD
8608 must point vector 0 (the reset vector) to the entry of the debug
8609 handler. However, this means that the complete first cacheline in the
8610 mini-IC is marked valid, which makes the CPU fetch all exception
8611 handlers from the mini-IC, ignoring the code in RAM.
8612
8613 To address this situation, OpenOCD provides the @code{xscale
8614 vector_table} command, which allows the user to explicitly write
8615 individual entries to either the high or low vector table stored in
8616 the mini-IC.
8617
8618 It is recommended to place a pc-relative indirect branch in the vector
8619 table, and put the branch destination somewhere in memory. Doing so
8620 makes sure the code in the vector table stays constant regardless of
8621 code layout in memory:
8622 @example
8623 _vectors:
8624 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
8625 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
8626 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
8627 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
8628 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
8629 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
8630 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
8631 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
8632 .org 0x100
8633 .long real_reset_vector
8634 .long real_ui_handler
8635 .long real_swi_handler
8636 .long real_pf_abort
8637 .long real_data_abort
8638 .long 0 /* unused */
8639 .long real_irq_handler
8640 .long real_fiq_handler
8641 @end example
8642
8643 Alternatively, you may choose to keep some or all of the mini-IC
8644 vector table entries synced with those written to memory by your
8645 system software. The mini-IC can not be modified while the processor
8646 is executing, but for each vector table entry not previously defined
8647 using the @code{xscale vector_table} command, OpenOCD will copy the
8648 value from memory to the mini-IC every time execution resumes from a
8649 halt. This is done for both high and low vector tables (although the
8650 table not in use may not be mapped to valid memory, and in this case
8651 that copy operation will silently fail). This means that you will
8652 need to briefly halt execution at some strategic point during system
8653 start-up; e.g., after the software has initialized the vector table,
8654 but before exceptions are enabled. A breakpoint can be used to
8655 accomplish this once the appropriate location in the start-up code has
8656 been identified. A watchpoint over the vector table region is helpful
8657 in finding the location if you're not sure. Note that the same
8658 situation exists any time the vector table is modified by the system
8659 software.
8660
8661 The debug handler must be placed somewhere in the address space using
8662 the @code{xscale debug_handler} command. The allowed locations for the
8663 debug handler are either (0x800 - 0x1fef800) or (0xfe000800 -
8664 0xfffff800). The default value is 0xfe000800.
8665
8666 XScale has resources to support two hardware breakpoints and two
8667 watchpoints. However, the following restrictions on watchpoint
8668 functionality apply: (1) the value and mask arguments to the @code{wp}
8669 command are not supported, (2) the watchpoint length must be a
8670 power of two and not less than four, and can not be greater than the
8671 watchpoint address, and (3) a watchpoint with a length greater than
8672 four consumes all the watchpoint hardware resources. This means that
8673 at any one time, you can have enabled either two watchpoints with a
8674 length of four, or one watchpoint with a length greater than four.
8675
8676 These commands are available to XScale based CPUs,
8677 which are implementations of the ARMv5TE architecture.
8678
8679 @deffn Command {xscale analyze_trace}
8680 Displays the contents of the trace buffer.
8681 @end deffn
8682
8683 @deffn Command {xscale cache_clean_address} address
8684 Changes the address used when cleaning the data cache.
8685 @end deffn
8686
8687 @deffn Command {xscale cache_info}
8688 Displays information about the CPU caches.
8689 @end deffn
8690
8691 @deffn Command {xscale cp15} regnum [value]
8692 Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
8693 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
8694 @end deffn
8695
8696 @deffn Command {xscale debug_handler} target address
8697 Changes the address used for the specified target's debug handler.
8698 @end deffn
8699
8700 @deffn Command {xscale dcache} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8701 Enables or disable the CPU's data cache.
8702 @end deffn
8703
8704 @deffn Command {xscale dump_trace} filename
8705 Dumps the raw contents of the trace buffer to @file{filename}.
8706 @end deffn
8707
8708 @deffn Command {xscale icache} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8709 Enables or disable the CPU's instruction cache.
8710 @end deffn
8711
8712 @deffn Command {xscale mmu} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8713 Enables or disable the CPU's memory management unit.
8714 @end deffn
8715
8716 @deffn Command {xscale trace_buffer} [@option{enable}|@option{disable} [@option{fill} [n] | @option{wrap}]]
8717 Displays the trace buffer status, after optionally
8718 enabling or disabling the trace buffer
8719 and modifying how it is emptied.
8720 @end deffn
8721
8722 @deffn Command {xscale trace_image} filename [offset [type]]
8723 Opens a trace image from @file{filename}, optionally rebasing
8724 its segment addresses by @var{offset}.
8725 The image @var{type} may be one of
8726 @option{bin} (binary), @option{ihex} (Intel hex),
8727 @option{elf} (ELF file), @option{s19} (Motorola s19),
8728 @option{mem}, or @option{builder}.
8729 @end deffn
8730
8731 @anchor{xscalevectorcatch}
8732 @deffn Command {xscale vector_catch} [mask]
8733 @cindex vector_catch
8734 Display a bitmask showing the hardware vectors to catch.
8735 If the optional parameter is provided, first set the bitmask to that value.
8736
8737 The mask bits correspond with bit 16..23 in the DCSR:
8738 @example
8739 0x01 Trap Reset
8740 0x02 Trap Undefined Instructions
8741 0x04 Trap Software Interrupt
8742 0x08 Trap Prefetch Abort
8743 0x10 Trap Data Abort
8744 0x20 reserved
8745 0x40 Trap IRQ
8746 0x80 Trap FIQ
8747 @end example
8748 @end deffn
8749
8750 @deffn Command {xscale vector_table} [(@option{low}|@option{high}) index value]
8751 @cindex vector_table
8752
8753 Set an entry in the mini-IC vector table. There are two tables: one for
8754 low vectors (at 0x00000000), and one for high vectors (0xFFFF0000), each
8755 holding the 8 exception vectors. @var{index} can be 1-7, because vector 0
8756 points to the debug handler entry and can not be overwritten.
8757 @var{value} holds the 32-bit opcode that is placed in the mini-IC.
8758
8759 Without arguments, the current settings are displayed.
8760
8761 @end deffn
8762
8763 @section ARMv6 Architecture
8764 @cindex ARMv6
8765
8766 @subsection ARM11 specific commands
8767 @cindex ARM11
8768
8769 @deffn Command {arm11 memwrite burst} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8770 Displays the value of the memwrite burst-enable flag,
8771 which is enabled by default.
8772 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
8773 Burst writes are only used for memory writes larger than 1 word.
8774 They improve performance by assuming that the CPU has read each data
8775 word over JTAG and completed its write before the next word arrives,
8776 instead of polling for a status flag to verify that completion.
8777 This is usually safe, because JTAG runs much slower than the CPU.
8778 @end deffn
8779
8780 @deffn Command {arm11 memwrite error_fatal} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8781 Displays the value of the memwrite error_fatal flag,
8782 which is enabled by default.
8783 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
8784 When set, certain memory write errors cause earlier transfer termination.
8785 @end deffn
8786
8787 @deffn Command {arm11 step_irq_enable} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8788 Displays the value of the flag controlling whether
8789 IRQs are enabled during single stepping;
8790 they are disabled by default.
8791 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that.
8792 @end deffn
8793
8794 @deffn Command {arm11 vcr} [value]
8795 @cindex vector_catch
8796 Displays the value of the @emph{Vector Catch Register (VCR)},
8797 coprocessor 14 register 7.
8798 If @var{value} is defined, first assigns that.
8799
8800 Vector Catch hardware provides dedicated breakpoints
8801 for certain hardware events.
8802 The specific bit values are core-specific (as in fact is using
8803 coprocessor 14 register 7 itself) but all current ARM11
8804 cores @emph{except the ARM1176} use the same six bits.
8805 @end deffn
8806
8807 @section ARMv7 and ARMv8 Architecture
8808 @cindex ARMv7
8809 @cindex ARMv8
8810
8811 @subsection ARMv7-A specific commands
8812 @cindex Cortex-A
8813
8814 @deffn Command {cortex_a cache_info}
8815 display information about target caches
8816 @end deffn
8817
8818 @deffn Command {cortex_a dacrfixup [@option{on}|@option{off}]}
8819 Work around issues with software breakpoints when the program text is
8820 mapped read-only by the operating system. This option sets the CP15 DACR
8821 to "all-manager" to bypass MMU permission checks on memory access.
8822 Defaults to 'off'.
8823 @end deffn
8824
8825 @deffn Command {cortex_a dbginit}
8826 Initialize core debug
8827 Enables debug by unlocking the Software Lock and clearing sticky powerdown indications
8828 @end deffn
8829
8830 @deffn Command {cortex_a smp_off}
8831 Disable SMP mode
8832 @end deffn
8833
8834 @deffn Command {cortex_a smp_on}
8835 Enable SMP mode
8836 @end deffn
8837
8838 @deffn Command {cortex_a smp_gdb} [core_id]
8839 Display/set the current core displayed in GDB
8840 @end deffn
8841
8842 @deffn Command {cortex_a maskisr} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
8843 Selects whether interrupts will be processed when single stepping
8844 @end deffn
8845
8846 @deffn Command {cache_config l2x} [base way]
8847 configure l2x cache
8848 @end deffn
8849
8850 @deffn Command {cortex_a mmu dump} [@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{addr} address [@option{num_entries}]]
8851 Dump the MMU translation table from TTB0 or TTB1 register, or from physical
8852 memory location @var{address}. When dumping the table from @var{address}, print at most
8853 @var{num_entries} page table entries. @var{num_entries} is optional, if omitted, the maximum
8854 possible (4096) entries are printed.
8855 @end deffn
8856
8857 @subsection ARMv7-R specific commands
8858 @cindex Cortex-R
8859
8860 @deffn Command {cortex_r dbginit}
8861 Initialize core debug
8862 Enables debug by unlocking the Software Lock and clearing sticky powerdown indications
8863 @end deffn
8864
8865 @deffn Command {cortex_r maskisr} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
8866 Selects whether interrupts will be processed when single stepping
8867 @end deffn
8868
8869
8870 @subsection ARMv7-M specific commands
8871 @cindex tracing
8872 @cindex SWO
8873 @cindex SWV
8874 @cindex TPIU
8875 @cindex ITM
8876 @cindex ETM
8877
8878 @deffn Command {tpiu config} (@option{disable} | ((@option{external} | @option{internal (@var{filename} | -)}) @
8879 (@option{sync @var{port_width}} | ((@option{manchester} | @option{uart}) @var{formatter_enable})) @
8880 @var{TRACECLKIN_freq} [@var{trace_freq}]))
8881
8882 ARMv7-M architecture provides several modules to generate debugging
8883 information internally (ITM, DWT and ETM). Their output is directed
8884 through TPIU to be captured externally either on an SWO pin (this
8885 configuration is called SWV) or on a synchronous parallel trace port.
8886
8887 This command configures the TPIU module of the target and, if internal
8888 capture mode is selected, starts to capture trace output by using the
8889 debugger adapter features.
8890
8891 Some targets require additional actions to be performed in the
8892 @b{trace-config} handler for trace port to be activated.
8893
8894 Command options:
8895 @itemize @minus
8896 @item @option{disable} disable TPIU handling;
8897 @item @option{external} configure TPIU to let user capture trace
8898 output externally (with an additional UART or logic analyzer hardware);
8899 @item @option{internal @var{filename}} configure TPIU and debug adapter to
8900 gather trace data and append it to @var{filename} (which can be
8901 either a regular file or a named pipe);
8902 @item @option{internal -} configure TPIU and debug adapter to
8903 gather trace data, but not write to any file. Useful in conjunction with the @command{tcl_trace} command;
8904 @item @option{sync @var{port_width}} use synchronous parallel trace output
8905 mode, and set port width to @var{port_width};
8906 @item @option{manchester} use asynchronous SWO mode with Manchester
8907 coding;
8908 @item @option{uart} use asynchronous SWO mode with NRZ (same as
8909 regular UART 8N1) coding;
8910 @item @var{formatter_enable} is @option{on} or @option{off} to enable
8911 or disable TPIU formatter which needs to be used when both ITM and ETM
8912 data is to be output via SWO;
8913 @item @var{TRACECLKIN_freq} this should be specified to match target's
8914 current TRACECLKIN frequency (usually the same as HCLK);
8915 @item @var{trace_freq} trace port frequency. Can be omitted in
8916 internal mode to let the adapter driver select the maximum supported
8917 rate automatically.
8918 @end itemize
8919
8920 Example usage:
8921 @enumerate
8922 @item STM32L152 board is programmed with an application that configures
8923 PLL to provide core clock with 24MHz frequency; to use ITM output it's
8924 enough to:
8925 @example
8926 #include <libopencm3/cm3/itm.h>
8927 ...
8928 ITM_STIM8(0) = c;
8929 ...
8930 @end example
8931 (the most obvious way is to use the first stimulus port for printf,
8932 for that this ITM_STIM8 assignment can be used inside _write(); to make it
8933 blocking to avoid data loss, add @code{while (!(ITM_STIM8(0) &
8934 ITM_STIM_FIFOREADY));});
8935 @item An FT2232H UART is connected to the SWO pin of the board;
8936 @item Commands to configure UART for 12MHz baud rate:
8937 @example
8938 $ setserial /dev/ttyUSB1 spd_cust divisor 5
8939 $ stty -F /dev/ttyUSB1 38400
8940 @end example
8941 (FT2232H's base frequency is 60MHz, spd_cust allows to alias 38400
8942 baud with our custom divisor to get 12MHz)
8943 @item @code{itmdump -f /dev/ttyUSB1 -d1}
8944 @item OpenOCD invocation line:
8945 @example
8946 openocd -f interface/stlink.cfg \
8947 -c "transport select hla_swd" \
8948 -f target/stm32l1.cfg \
8949 -c "tpiu config external uart off 24000000 12000000"
8950 @end example
8951 @end enumerate
8952 @end deffn
8953
8954 @deffn Command {itm port} @var{port} (@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{on}|@option{off})
8955 Enable or disable trace output for ITM stimulus @var{port} (counting
8956 from 0). Port 0 is enabled on target creation automatically.
8957 @end deffn
8958
8959 @deffn Command {itm ports} (@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{on}|@option{off})
8960 Enable or disable trace output for all ITM stimulus ports.
8961 @end deffn
8962
8963 @subsection Cortex-M specific commands
8964 @cindex Cortex-M
8965
8966 @deffn Command {cortex_m maskisr} (@option{auto}|@option{on}|@option{off})
8967 Control masking (disabling) interrupts during target step/resume.
8968
8969 The @option{auto} option handles interrupts during stepping in a way that they
8970 get served but don't disturb the program flow. The step command first allows
8971 pending interrupt handlers to execute, then disables interrupts and steps over
8972 the next instruction where the core was halted. After the step interrupts
8973 are enabled again. If the interrupt handlers don't complete within 500ms,
8974 the step command leaves with the core running.
8975
8976 Note that a free hardware (FPB) breakpoint is required for the @option{auto}
8977 option. If no breakpoint is available at the time of the step, then the step
8978 is taken with interrupts enabled, i.e. the same way the @option{off} option
8979 does.
8980
8981 Default is @option{auto}.
8982 @end deffn
8983
8984 @deffn Command {cortex_m vector_catch} [@option{all}|@option{none}|list]
8985 @cindex vector_catch
8986 Vector Catch hardware provides dedicated breakpoints
8987 for certain hardware events.
8988
8989 Parameters request interception of
8990 @option{all} of these hardware event vectors,
8991 @option{none} of them,
8992 or one or more of the following:
8993 @option{hard_err} for a HardFault exception;
8994 @option{mm_err} for a MemManage exception;
8995 @option{bus_err} for a BusFault exception;
8996 @option{irq_err},
8997 @option{state_err},
8998 @option{chk_err}, or
8999 @option{nocp_err} for various UsageFault exceptions; or
9000 @option{reset}.
9001 If NVIC setup code does not enable them,
9002 MemManage, BusFault, and UsageFault exceptions
9003 are mapped to HardFault.
9004 UsageFault checks for
9005 divide-by-zero and unaligned access
9006 must also be explicitly enabled.
9007
9008 This finishes by listing the current vector catch configuration.
9009 @end deffn
9010
9011 @deffn Command {cortex_m reset_config} (@option{sysresetreq}|@option{vectreset})
9012 Control reset handling if hardware srst is not fitted
9013 @xref{reset_config,,reset_config}.
9014
9015 @itemize @minus
9016 @item @option{sysresetreq} use AIRCR SYSRESETREQ to reset system.
9017 @item @option{vectreset} use AIRCR VECTRESET to reset system (default).
9018 @end itemize
9019
9020 Using @option{vectreset} is a safe option for Cortex-M3, M4 and M7 cores.
9021 This however has the disadvantage of only resetting the core, all peripherals
9022 are unaffected. A solution would be to use a @code{reset-init} event handler
9023 to manually reset the peripherals.
9024 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
9025
9026 Cortex-M0, M0+ and M1 do not support @option{vectreset}, use @option{sysresetreq}
9027 instead.
9028 @end deffn
9029
9030 @subsection ARMv8-A specific commands
9031 @cindex ARMv8-A
9032 @cindex aarch64
9033
9034 @deffn Command {aarch64 cache_info}
9035 Display information about target caches
9036 @end deffn
9037
9038 @deffn Command {aarch64 dbginit}
9039 This command enables debugging by clearing the OS Lock and sticky power-down and reset
9040 indications. It also establishes the expected, basic cross-trigger configuration the aarch64
9041 target code relies on. In a configuration file, the command would typically be called from a
9042 @code{reset-end} or @code{reset-deassert-post} handler, to re-enable debugging after a system reset.
9043 However, normally it is not necessary to use the command at all.
9044 @end deffn
9045
9046 @deffn Command {aarch64 smp_on|smp_off}
9047 Enable and disable SMP handling. The state of SMP handling influences the way targets in an SMP group
9048 are handled by the run control. With SMP handling enabled, issuing halt or resume to one core will trigger
9049 halting or resuming of all cores in the group. The command @code{target smp} defines which targets are in the SMP
9050 group. With SMP handling disabled, all targets need to be treated individually.
9051 @end deffn
9052
9053 @deffn Command {aarch64 maskisr} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
9054 Selects whether interrupts will be processed when single stepping. The default configuration is
9055 @option{on}.
9056 @end deffn
9057
9058 @section EnSilica eSi-RISC Architecture
9059
9060 eSi-RISC is a highly configurable microprocessor architecture for embedded systems
9061 provided by EnSilica. (See: @url{http://www.ensilica.com/risc-ip/}.)
9062
9063 @subsection eSi-RISC Configuration
9064
9065 @deffn Command {esirisc cache_arch} (@option{harvard}|@option{von_neumann})
9066 Configure the caching architecture. Targets with the @code{UNIFIED_ADDRESS_SPACE}
9067 option disabled employ a Harvard architecture. By default, @option{von_neumann} is assumed.
9068 @end deffn
9069
9070 @deffn Command {esirisc hwdc} (@option{all}|@option{none}|mask ...)
9071 Configure hardware debug control. The HWDC register controls which exceptions return
9072 control back to the debugger. Possible masks are @option{all}, @option{none},
9073 @option{reset}, @option{interrupt}, @option{syscall}, @option{error}, and @option{debug}.
9074 By default, @option{reset}, @option{error}, and @option{debug} are enabled.
9075 @end deffn
9076
9077 @subsection eSi-RISC Operation
9078
9079 @deffn Command {esirisc flush_caches}
9080 Flush instruction and data caches. This command requires that the target is halted
9081 when the command is issued and configured with an instruction or data cache.
9082 @end deffn
9083
9084 @subsection eSi-Trace Configuration
9085
9086 eSi-RISC targets may be configured with support for instruction tracing. Trace
9087 data may be written to an in-memory buffer or FIFO. If a FIFO is configured, DMA
9088 is typically employed to move trace data off-device using a high-speed
9089 peripheral (eg. SPI). Collected trace data is encoded in one of three different
9090 formats. At a minimum, @command{esirisc trace buffer} or @command{esirisc trace
9091 fifo} must be issued along with @command{esirisc trace format} before trace data
9092 can be collected.
9093
9094 OpenOCD provides rudimentary analysis of collected trace data. If more detail is
9095 needed, collected trace data can be dumped to a file and processed by external
9096 tooling.
9097
9098 @quotation Issues
9099 OpenOCD is unable to process trace data sent to a FIFO. A potential workaround
9100 for this issue is to configure DMA to copy trace data to an in-memory buffer,
9101 which can then be passed to the @command{esirisc trace analyze} and
9102 @command{esirisc trace dump} commands.
9103
9104 It is possible to corrupt trace data when using a FIFO if the peripheral
9105 responsible for draining data from the FIFO is not fast enough. This can be
9106 managed by enabling flow control, however this can impact timing-sensitive
9107 software operation on the CPU.
9108 @end quotation
9109
9110 @deffn Command {esirisc trace buffer} address size [@option{wrap}]
9111 Configure trace buffer using the provided address and size. If the @option{wrap}
9112 option is specified, trace collection will continue once the end of the buffer
9113 is reached. By default, wrap is disabled.
9114 @end deffn
9115
9116 @deffn Command {esirisc trace fifo} address
9117 Configure trace FIFO using the provided address.
9118 @end deffn
9119
9120 @deffn Command {esirisc trace flow_control} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
9121 Enable or disable stalling the CPU to collect trace data. By default, flow
9122 control is disabled.
9123 @end deffn
9124
9125 @deffn Command {esirisc trace format} (@option{full}|@option{branch}|@option{icache}) pc_bits
9126 Configure trace format and number of PC bits to be captured. @option{pc_bits}
9127 must be within 1 and 31 as the LSB is not collected. If external tooling is used
9128 to analyze collected trace data, these values must match.
9129
9130 Supported trace formats:
9131 @itemize
9132 @item @option{full} capture full trace data, allowing execution history and
9133 timing to be determined.
9134 @item @option{branch} capture taken branch instructions and branch target
9135 addresses.
9136 @item @option{icache} capture instruction cache misses.
9137 @end itemize
9138 @end deffn
9139
9140 @deffn Command {esirisc trace trigger start} (@option{condition}) [start_data start_mask]
9141 Configure trigger start condition using the provided start data and mask. A
9142 brief description of each condition is provided below; for more detail on how
9143 these values are used, see the eSi-RISC Architecture Manual.
9144
9145 Supported conditions:
9146 @itemize
9147 @item @option{none} manual tracing (see @command{esirisc trace start}).
9148 @item @option{pc} start tracing if the PC matches start data and mask.
9149 @item @option{load} start tracing if the effective address of a load
9150 instruction matches start data and mask.
9151 @item @option{store} start tracing if the effective address of a store
9152 instruction matches start data and mask.
9153 @item @option{exception} start tracing if the EID of an exception matches start
9154 data and mask.
9155 @item @option{eret} start tracing when an @code{ERET} instruction is executed.
9156 @item @option{wait} start tracing when a @code{WAIT} instruction is executed.
9157 @item @option{stop} start tracing when a @code{STOP} instruction is executed.
9158 @item @option{high} start tracing when an external signal is a logical high.
9159 @item @option{low} start tracing when an external signal is a logical low.
9160 @end itemize
9161 @end deffn
9162
9163 @deffn Command {esirisc trace trigger stop} (@option{condition}) [stop_data stop_mask]
9164 Configure trigger stop condition using the provided stop data and mask. A brief
9165 description of each condition is provided below; for more detail on how these
9166 values are used, see the eSi-RISC Architecture Manual.
9167
9168 Supported conditions:
9169 @itemize
9170 @item @option{none} manual tracing (see @command{esirisc trace stop}).
9171 @item @option{pc} stop tracing if the PC matches stop data and mask.
9172 @item @option{load} stop tracing if the effective address of a load
9173 instruction matches stop data and mask.
9174 @item @option{store} stop tracing if the effective address of a store
9175 instruction matches stop data and mask.
9176 @item @option{exception} stop tracing if the EID of an exception matches stop
9177 data and mask.
9178 @item @option{eret} stop tracing when an @code{ERET} instruction is executed.
9179 @item @option{wait} stop tracing when a @code{WAIT} instruction is executed.
9180 @item @option{stop} stop tracing when a @code{STOP} instruction is executed.
9181 @end itemize
9182 @end deffn
9183
9184 @deffn Command {esirisc trace trigger delay} (@option{trigger}) [cycles]
9185 Configure trigger start/stop delay in clock cycles.
9186
9187 Supported triggers:
9188 @itemize
9189 @item @option{none} no delay to start or stop collection.
9190 @item @option{start} delay @option{cycles} after trigger to start collection.
9191 @item @option{stop} delay @option{cycles} after trigger to stop collection.
9192 @item @option{both} delay @option{cycles} after both triggers to start or stop
9193 collection.
9194 @end itemize
9195 @end deffn
9196
9197 @subsection eSi-Trace Operation
9198
9199 @deffn Command {esirisc trace init}
9200 Initialize trace collection. This command must be called any time the
9201 configuration changes. If an trace buffer has been configured, the contents will
9202 be overwritten when trace collection starts.
9203 @end deffn
9204
9205 @deffn Command {esirisc trace info}
9206 Display trace configuration.
9207 @end deffn
9208
9209 @deffn Command {esirisc trace status}
9210 Display trace collection status.
9211 @end deffn
9212
9213 @deffn Command {esirisc trace start}
9214 Start manual trace collection.
9215 @end deffn
9216
9217 @deffn Command {esirisc trace stop}
9218 Stop manual trace collection.
9219 @end deffn
9220
9221 @deffn Command {esirisc trace analyze} [address size]
9222 Analyze collected trace data. This command may only be used if a trace buffer
9223 has been configured. If a trace FIFO has been configured, trace data must be
9224 copied to an in-memory buffer identified by the @option{address} and
9225 @option{size} options using DMA.
9226 @end deffn
9227
9228 @deffn Command {esirisc trace dump} [address size] @file{filename}
9229 Dump collected trace data to file. This command may only be used if a trace
9230 buffer has been configured. If a trace FIFO has been configured, trace data must
9231 be copied to an in-memory buffer identified by the @option{address} and
9232 @option{size} options using DMA.
9233 @end deffn
9234
9235 @section Intel Architecture
9236
9237 Intel Quark X10xx is the first product in the Quark family of SoCs. It is an IA-32
9238 (Pentium x86 ISA) compatible SoC. The core CPU in the X10xx is codenamed Lakemont.
9239 Lakemont version 1 (LMT1) is used in X10xx. The CPU TAP (Lakemont TAP) is used for
9240 software debug and the CLTAP is used for SoC level operations.
9241 Useful docs are here: https://communities.intel.com/community/makers/documentation
9242 @itemize
9243 @item Intel Quark SoC X1000 OpenOCD/GDB/Eclipse App Note (web search for doc num 330015)
9244 @item Intel Quark SoC X1000 Debug Operations User Guide (web search for doc num 329866)
9245 @item Intel Quark SoC X1000 Datasheet (web search for doc num 329676)
9246 @end itemize
9247
9248 @subsection x86 32-bit specific commands
9249 The three main address spaces for x86 are memory, I/O and configuration space.
9250 These commands allow a user to read and write to the 64Kbyte I/O address space.
9251
9252 @deffn Command {x86_32 idw} address
9253 Display the contents of a 32-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
9254 @end deffn
9255
9256 @deffn Command {x86_32 idh} address
9257 Display the contents of a 16-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
9258 @end deffn
9259
9260 @deffn Command {x86_32 idb} address
9261 Display the contents of a 8-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
9262 @end deffn
9263
9264 @deffn Command {x86_32 iww} address
9265 Write the contents of a 32-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
9266 @end deffn
9267
9268 @deffn Command {x86_32 iwh} address
9269 Write the contents of a 16-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
9270 @end deffn
9271
9272 @deffn Command {x86_32 iwb} address
9273 Write the contents of a 8-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
9274 @end deffn
9275
9276 @section OpenRISC Architecture
9277
9278 The OpenRISC CPU is a soft core. It is used in a programmable SoC which can be
9279 configured with any of the TAP / Debug Unit available.
9280
9281 @subsection TAP and Debug Unit selection commands
9282 @deffn Command {tap_select} (@option{vjtag}|@option{mohor}|@option{xilinx_bscan})
9283 Select between the Altera Virtual JTAG , Xilinx Virtual JTAG and Mohor TAP.
9284 @end deffn
9285 @deffn Command {du_select} (@option{adv}|@option{mohor}) [option]
9286 Select between the Advanced Debug Interface and the classic one.
9287
9288 An option can be passed as a second argument to the debug unit.
9289
9290 When using the Advanced Debug Interface, option = 1 means the RTL core is
9291 configured with ADBG_USE_HISPEED = 1. This configuration skips status checking
9292 between bytes while doing read or write bursts.
9293 @end deffn
9294
9295 @subsection Registers commands
9296 @deffn Command {addreg} [name] [address] [feature] [reg_group]
9297 Add a new register in the cpu register list. This register will be
9298 included in the generated target descriptor file.
9299
9300 @strong{[feature]} must be "org.gnu.gdb.or1k.group[0..10]".
9301
9302 @strong{[reg_group]} can be anything. The default register list defines "system",
9303 "dmmu", "immu", "dcache", "icache", "mac", "debug", "perf", "power", "pic"
9304 and "timer" groups.
9305
9306 @emph{example:}
9307 @example
9308 addreg rtest 0x1234 org.gnu.gdb.or1k.group0 system
9309 @end example
9310
9311
9312 @end deffn
9313 @deffn Command {readgroup} (@option{group})
9314 Display all registers in @emph{group}.
9315
9316 @emph{group} can be "system",
9317 "dmmu", "immu", "dcache", "icache", "mac", "debug", "perf", "power", "pic",
9318 "timer" or any new group created with addreg command.
9319 @end deffn
9320
9321 @section RISC-V Architecture
9322
9323 @uref{http://riscv.org/, RISC-V} is a free and open ISA. OpenOCD supports JTAG
9324 debug of RV32 and RV64 cores in heterogeneous multicore systems of up to 32
9325 harts. (It's possible to increase this limit to 1024 by changing
9326 RISCV_MAX_HARTS in riscv.h.) OpenOCD primarily supports 0.13 of the RISC-V
9327 Debug Specification, but there is also support for legacy targets that
9328 implement version 0.11.
9329
9330 @subsection RISC-V Terminology
9331
9332 A @emph{hart} is a hardware thread. A hart may share resources (eg. FPU) with
9333 another hart, or may be a separate core. RISC-V treats those the same, and
9334 OpenOCD exposes each hart as a separate core.
9335
9336 @subsection RISC-V Debug Configuration Commands
9337
9338 @deffn Command {riscv expose_csrs} n0[-m0][,n1[-m1]]...
9339 Configure a list of inclusive ranges for CSRs to expose in addition to the
9340 standard ones. This must be executed before `init`.
9341
9342 By default OpenOCD attempts to expose only CSRs that are mentioned in a spec,
9343 and then only if the corresponding extension appears to be implemented. This
9344 command can be used if OpenOCD gets this wrong, or a target implements custom
9345 CSRs.
9346 @end deffn
9347
9348 @deffn Command {riscv set_command_timeout_sec} [seconds]
9349 Set the wall-clock timeout (in seconds) for individual commands. The default
9350 should work fine for all but the slowest targets (eg. simulators).
9351 @end deffn
9352
9353 @deffn Command {riscv set_reset_timeout_sec} [seconds]
9354 Set the maximum time to wait for a hart to come out of reset after reset is
9355 deasserted.
9356 @end deffn
9357
9358 @deffn Command {riscv set_scratch_ram} none|[address]
9359 Set the address of 16 bytes of scratch RAM the debugger can use, or 'none'.
9360 This is used to access 64-bit floating point registers on 32-bit targets.
9361 @end deffn
9362
9363 @deffn Command {riscv set_prefer_sba} on|off
9364 When on, prefer to use System Bus Access to access memory. When off, prefer to
9365 use the Program Buffer to access memory.
9366 @end deffn
9367
9368 @subsection RISC-V Authentication Commands
9369
9370 The following commands can be used to authenticate to a RISC-V system. Eg. a
9371 trivial challenge-response protocol could be implemented as follows in a
9372 configuration file, immediately following @command{init}:
9373 @example
9374 set challenge [ocd_riscv authdata_read]
9375 riscv authdata_write [expr $challenge + 1]
9376 @end example
9377
9378 @deffn Command {riscv authdata_read}
9379 Return the 32-bit value read from authdata. Note that to get read value back in
9380 a TCL script, it needs to be invoked as @command{ocd_riscv authdata_read}.
9381 @end deffn
9382
9383 @deffn Command {riscv authdata_write} value
9384 Write the 32-bit value to authdata.
9385 @end deffn
9386
9387 @subsection RISC-V DMI Commands
9388
9389 The following commands allow direct access to the Debug Module Interface, which
9390 can be used to interact with custom debug features.
9391
9392 @deffn Command {riscv dmi_read}
9393 Perform a 32-bit DMI read at address, returning the value. Note that to get
9394 read value back in a TCL script, it needs to be invoked as @command{ocd_riscv
9395 dmi_read}.
9396 @end deffn
9397
9398 @deffn Command {riscv dmi_write} address value
9399 Perform a 32-bit DMI write of value at address.
9400 @end deffn
9401
9402 @anchor{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing}
9403 @section Software Debug Messages and Tracing
9404 @cindex Linux-ARM DCC support
9405 @cindex tracing
9406 @cindex libdcc
9407 @cindex DCC
9408 OpenOCD can process certain requests from target software, when
9409 the target uses appropriate libraries.
9410 The most powerful mechanism is semihosting, but there is also
9411 a lighter weight mechanism using only the DCC channel.
9412
9413 Currently @command{target_request debugmsgs}
9414 is supported only for @option{arm7_9} and @option{cortex_m} cores.
9415 These messages are received as part of target polling, so
9416 you need to have @command{poll on} active to receive them.
9417 They are intrusive in that they will affect program execution
9418 times. If that is a problem, @pxref{armhardwaretracing,,ARM Hardware Tracing}.
9419
9420 See @file{libdcc} in the contrib dir for more details.
9421 In addition to sending strings, characters, and
9422 arrays of various size integers from the target,
9423 @file{libdcc} also exports a software trace point mechanism.
9424 The target being debugged may
9425 issue trace messages which include a 24-bit @dfn{trace point} number.
9426 Trace point support includes two distinct mechanisms,
9427 each supported by a command:
9428
9429 @itemize
9430 @item @emph{History} ... A circular buffer of trace points
9431 can be set up, and then displayed at any time.
9432 This tracks where code has been, which can be invaluable in
9433 finding out how some fault was triggered.
9434
9435 The buffer may overflow, since it collects records continuously.
9436 It may be useful to use some of the 24 bits to represent a
9437 particular event, and other bits to hold data.
9438
9439 @item @emph{Counting} ... An array of counters can be set up,
9440 and then displayed at any time.
9441 This can help establish code coverage and identify hot spots.
9442
9443 The array of counters is directly indexed by the trace point
9444 number, so trace points with higher numbers are not counted.
9445 @end itemize
9446
9447 Linux-ARM kernels have a ``Kernel low-level debugging
9448 via EmbeddedICE DCC channel'' option (CONFIG_DEBUG_ICEDCC,
9449 depends on CONFIG_DEBUG_LL) which uses this mechanism to
9450 deliver messages before a serial console can be activated.
9451 This is not the same format used by @file{libdcc}.
9452 Other software, such as the U-Boot boot loader, sometimes
9453 does the same thing.
9454
9455 @deffn Command {target_request debugmsgs} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}|@option{charmsg}]
9456 Displays current handling of target DCC message requests.
9457 These messages may be sent to the debugger while the target is running.
9458 The optional @option{enable} and @option{charmsg} parameters
9459 both enable the messages, while @option{disable} disables them.
9460
9461 With @option{charmsg} the DCC words each contain one character,
9462 as used by Linux with CONFIG_DEBUG_ICEDCC;
9463 otherwise the libdcc format is used.
9464 @end deffn
9465
9466 @deffn Command {trace history} [@option{clear}|count]
9467 With no parameter, displays all the trace points that have triggered
9468 in the order they triggered.
9469 With the parameter @option{clear}, erases all current trace history records.
9470 With a @var{count} parameter, allocates space for that many
9471 history records.
9472 @end deffn
9473
9474 @deffn Command {trace point} [@option{clear}|identifier]
9475 With no parameter, displays all trace point identifiers and how many times
9476 they have been triggered.
9477 With the parameter @option{clear}, erases all current trace point counters.
9478 With a numeric @var{identifier} parameter, creates a new a trace point counter
9479 and associates it with that identifier.
9480
9481 @emph{Important:} The identifier and the trace point number
9482 are not related except by this command.
9483 These trace point numbers always start at zero (from server startup,
9484 or after @command{trace point clear}) and count up from there.
9485 @end deffn
9486
9487
9488 @node JTAG Commands
9489 @chapter JTAG Commands
9490 @cindex JTAG Commands
9491 Most general purpose JTAG commands have been presented earlier.
9492 (@xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}, @ref{Reset Configuration}, and @ref{TAP Declaration}.)
9493 Lower level JTAG commands, as presented here,
9494 may be needed to work with targets which require special
9495 attention during operations such as reset or initialization.
9496
9497 To use these commands you will need to understand some
9498 of the basics of JTAG, including:
9499
9500 @itemize @bullet
9501 @item A JTAG scan chain consists of a sequence of individual TAP
9502 devices such as a CPUs.
9503 @item Control operations involve moving each TAP through the same
9504 standard state machine (in parallel)
9505 using their shared TMS and clock signals.
9506 @item Data transfer involves shifting data through the chain of
9507 instruction or data registers of each TAP, writing new register values
9508 while the reading previous ones.
9509 @item Data register sizes are a function of the instruction active in
9510 a given TAP, while instruction register sizes are fixed for each TAP.
9511 All TAPs support a BYPASS instruction with a single bit data register.
9512 @item The way OpenOCD differentiates between TAP devices is by
9513 shifting different instructions into (and out of) their instruction
9514 registers.
9515 @end itemize
9516
9517 @section Low Level JTAG Commands
9518
9519 These commands are used by developers who need to access
9520 JTAG instruction or data registers, possibly controlling
9521 the order of TAP state transitions.
9522 If you're not debugging OpenOCD internals, or bringing up a
9523 new JTAG adapter or a new type of TAP device (like a CPU or
9524 JTAG router), you probably won't need to use these commands.
9525 In a debug session that doesn't use JTAG for its transport protocol,
9526 these commands are not available.
9527
9528 @deffn Command {drscan} tap [numbits value]+ [@option{-endstate} tap_state]
9529 Loads the data register of @var{tap} with a series of bit fields
9530 that specify the entire register.
9531 Each field is @var{numbits} bits long with
9532 a numeric @var{value} (hexadecimal encouraged).
9533 The return value holds the original value of each
9534 of those fields.
9535
9536 For example, a 38 bit number might be specified as one
9537 field of 32 bits then one of 6 bits.
9538 @emph{For portability, never pass fields which are more
9539 than 32 bits long. Many OpenOCD implementations do not
9540 support 64-bit (or larger) integer values.}
9541
9542 All TAPs other than @var{tap} must be in BYPASS mode.
9543 The single bit in their data registers does not matter.
9544
9545 When @var{tap_state} is specified, the JTAG state machine is left
9546 in that state.
9547 For example @sc{drpause} might be specified, so that more
9548 instructions can be issued before re-entering the @sc{run/idle} state.
9549 If the end state is not specified, the @sc{run/idle} state is entered.
9550
9551 @quotation Warning
9552 OpenOCD does not record information about data register lengths,
9553 so @emph{it is important that you get the bit field lengths right}.
9554 Remember that different JTAG instructions refer to different
9555 data registers, which may have different lengths.
9556 Moreover, those lengths may not be fixed;
9557 the SCAN_N instruction can change the length of
9558 the register accessed by the INTEST instruction
9559 (by connecting a different scan chain).
9560 @end quotation
9561 @end deffn
9562
9563 @deffn Command {flush_count}
9564 Returns the number of times the JTAG queue has been flushed.
9565 This may be used for performance tuning.
9566
9567 For example, flushing a queue over USB involves a
9568 minimum latency, often several milliseconds, which does
9569 not change with the amount of data which is written.
9570 You may be able to identify performance problems by finding
9571 tasks which waste bandwidth by flushing small transfers too often,
9572 instead of batching them into larger operations.
9573 @end deffn
9574
9575 @deffn Command {irscan} [tap instruction]+ [@option{-endstate} tap_state]
9576 For each @var{tap} listed, loads the instruction register
9577 with its associated numeric @var{instruction}.
9578 (The number of bits in that instruction may be displayed
9579 using the @command{scan_chain} command.)
9580 For other TAPs, a BYPASS instruction is loaded.
9581
9582 When @var{tap_state} is specified, the JTAG state machine is left
9583 in that state.
9584 For example @sc{irpause} might be specified, so the data register
9585 can be loaded before re-entering the @sc{run/idle} state.
9586 If the end state is not specified, the @sc{run/idle} state is entered.
9587
9588 @quotation Note
9589 OpenOCD currently supports only a single field for instruction
9590 register values, unlike data register values.
9591 For TAPs where the instruction register length is more than 32 bits,
9592 portable scripts currently must issue only BYPASS instructions.
9593 @end quotation
9594 @end deffn
9595
9596 @deffn Command {jtag_reset} trst srst
9597 Set values of reset signals.
9598 The @var{trst} and @var{srst} parameter values may be
9599 @option{0}, indicating that reset is inactive (pulled or driven high),
9600 or @option{1}, indicating it is active (pulled or driven low).
9601 The @command{reset_config} command should already have been used
9602 to configure how the board and JTAG adapter treat these two
9603 signals, and to say if either signal is even present.
9604 @xref{Reset Configuration}.
9605
9606 Note that TRST is specially handled.
9607 It actually signifies JTAG's @sc{reset} state.
9608 So if the board doesn't support the optional TRST signal,
9609 or it doesn't support it along with the specified SRST value,
9610 JTAG reset is triggered with TMS and TCK signals
9611 instead of the TRST signal.
9612 And no matter how that JTAG reset is triggered, once
9613 the scan chain enters @sc{reset} with TRST inactive,
9614 TAP @code{post-reset} events are delivered to all TAPs
9615 with handlers for that event.
9616 @end deffn
9617
9618 @deffn Command {pathmove} start_state [next_state ...]
9619 Start by moving to @var{start_state}, which
9620 must be one of the @emph{stable} states.
9621 Unless it is the only state given, this will often be the
9622 current state, so that no TCK transitions are needed.
9623 Then, in a series of single state transitions
9624 (conforming to the JTAG state machine) shift to
9625 each @var{next_state} in sequence, one per TCK cycle.
9626 The final state must also be stable.
9627 @end deffn
9628
9629 @deffn Command {runtest} @var{num_cycles}
9630 Move to the @sc{run/idle} state, and execute at least
9631 @var{num_cycles} of the JTAG clock (TCK).
9632 Instructions often need some time
9633 to execute before they take effect.
9634 @end deffn
9635
9636 @c tms_sequence (short|long)
9637 @c ... temporary, debug-only, other than USBprog bug workaround...
9638
9639 @deffn Command {verify_ircapture} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
9640 Verify values captured during @sc{ircapture} and returned
9641 during IR scans. Default is enabled, but this can be
9642 overridden by @command{verify_jtag}.
9643 This flag is ignored when validating JTAG chain configuration.
9644 @end deffn
9645
9646 @deffn Command {verify_jtag} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
9647 Enables verification of DR and IR scans, to help detect
9648 programming errors. For IR scans, @command{verify_ircapture}
9649 must also be enabled.
9650 Default is enabled.
9651 @end deffn
9652
9653 @section TAP state names
9654 @cindex TAP state names
9655
9656 The @var{tap_state} names used by OpenOCD in the @command{drscan},
9657 @command{irscan}, and @command{pathmove} commands are the same
9658 as those used in SVF boundary scan documents, except that
9659 SVF uses @sc{idle} instead of @sc{run/idle}.
9660
9661 @itemize @bullet
9662 @item @b{RESET} ... @emph{stable} (with TMS high);
9663 acts as if TRST were pulsed
9664 @item @b{RUN/IDLE} ... @emph{stable}; don't assume this always means IDLE
9665 @item @b{DRSELECT}
9666 @item @b{DRCAPTURE}
9667 @item @b{DRSHIFT} ... @emph{stable}; TDI/TDO shifting
9668 through the data register
9669 @item @b{DREXIT1}
9670 @item @b{DRPAUSE} ... @emph{stable}; data register ready
9671 for update or more shifting
9672 @item @b{DREXIT2}
9673 @item @b{DRUPDATE}
9674 @item @b{IRSELECT}
9675 @item @b{IRCAPTURE}
9676 @item @b{IRSHIFT} ... @emph{stable}; TDI/TDO shifting
9677 through the instruction register
9678 @item @b{IREXIT1}
9679 @item @b{IRPAUSE} ... @emph{stable}; instruction register ready
9680 for update or more shifting
9681 @item @b{IREXIT2}
9682 @item @b{IRUPDATE}
9683 @end itemize
9684
9685 Note that only six of those states are fully ``stable'' in the
9686 face of TMS fixed (low except for @sc{reset})
9687 and a free-running JTAG clock. For all the
9688 others, the next TCK transition changes to a new state.
9689
9690 @itemize @bullet
9691 @item From @sc{drshift} and @sc{irshift}, clock transitions will
9692 produce side effects by changing register contents. The values
9693 to be latched in upcoming @sc{drupdate} or @sc{irupdate} states
9694 may not be as expected.
9695 @item @sc{run/idle}, @sc{drpause}, and @sc{irpause} are reasonable
9696 choices after @command{drscan} or @command{irscan} commands,
9697 since they are free of JTAG side effects.
9698 @item @sc{run/idle} may have side effects that appear at non-JTAG
9699 levels, such as advancing the ARM9E-S instruction pipeline.
9700 Consult the documentation for the TAP(s) you are working with.
9701 @end itemize
9702
9703 @node Boundary Scan Commands
9704 @chapter Boundary Scan Commands
9705
9706 One of the original purposes of JTAG was to support
9707 boundary scan based hardware testing.
9708 Although its primary focus is to support On-Chip Debugging,
9709 OpenOCD also includes some boundary scan commands.
9710
9711 @section SVF: Serial Vector Format
9712 @cindex Serial Vector Format
9713 @cindex SVF
9714
9715 The Serial Vector Format, better known as @dfn{SVF}, is a
9716 way to represent JTAG test patterns in text files.
9717 In a debug session using JTAG for its transport protocol,
9718 OpenOCD supports running such test files.
9719
9720 @deffn Command {svf} @file{filename} [@option{-tap @var{tapname}}] [@option{[-]quiet}] @
9721 [@option{[-]nil}] [@option{[-]progress}] [@option{[-]ignore_error}]
9722 This issues a JTAG reset (Test-Logic-Reset) and then
9723 runs the SVF script from @file{filename}.
9724
9725 Arguments can be specified in any order; the optional dash doesn't
9726 affect their semantics.
9727
9728 Command options:
9729 @itemize @minus
9730 @item @option{-tap @var{tapname}} ignore IR and DR headers and footers
9731 specified by the SVF file with HIR, TIR, HDR and TDR commands;
9732 instead, calculate them automatically according to the current JTAG
9733 chain configuration, targeting @var{tapname};
9734 @item @option{[-]quiet} do not log every command before execution;
9735 @item @option{[-]nil} ``dry run'', i.e., do not perform any operations
9736 on the real interface;
9737 @item @option{[-]progress} enable progress indication;
9738 @item @option{[-]ignore_error} continue execution despite TDO check
9739 errors.
9740 @end itemize
9741 @end deffn
9742
9743 @section XSVF: Xilinx Serial Vector Format
9744 @cindex Xilinx Serial Vector Format
9745 @cindex XSVF
9746
9747 The Xilinx Serial Vector Format, better known as @dfn{XSVF}, is a
9748 binary representation of SVF which is optimized for use with
9749 Xilinx devices.
9750 In a debug session using JTAG for its transport protocol,
9751 OpenOCD supports running such test files.
9752
9753 @quotation Important
9754 Not all XSVF commands are supported.
9755 @end quotation
9756
9757 @deffn Command {xsvf} (tapname|@option{plain}) filename [@option{virt2}] [@option{quiet}]
9758 This issues a JTAG reset (Test-Logic-Reset) and then
9759 runs the XSVF script from @file{filename}.
9760 When a @var{tapname} is specified, the commands are directed at
9761 that TAP.
9762 When @option{virt2} is specified, the @sc{xruntest} command counts
9763 are interpreted as TCK cycles instead of microseconds.
9764 Unless the @option{quiet} option is specified,
9765 messages are logged for comments and some retries.
9766 @end deffn
9767
9768 The OpenOCD sources also include two utility scripts
9769 for working with XSVF; they are not currently installed
9770 after building the software.
9771 You may find them useful:
9772
9773 @itemize
9774 @item @emph{svf2xsvf} ... converts SVF files into the extended XSVF
9775 syntax understood by the @command{xsvf} command; see notes below.
9776 @item @emph{xsvfdump} ... converts XSVF files into a text output format;
9777 understands the OpenOCD extensions.
9778 @end itemize
9779
9780 The input format accepts a handful of non-standard extensions.
9781 These include three opcodes corresponding to SVF extensions
9782 from Lattice Semiconductor (LCOUNT, LDELAY, LDSR), and
9783 two opcodes supporting a more accurate translation of SVF
9784 (XTRST, XWAITSTATE).
9785 If @emph{xsvfdump} shows a file is using those opcodes, it
9786 probably will not be usable with other XSVF tools.
9787
9788
9789 @node Utility Commands
9790 @chapter Utility Commands
9791 @cindex Utility Commands
9792
9793 @section RAM testing
9794 @cindex RAM testing
9795
9796 There is often a need to stress-test random access memory (RAM) for
9797 errors. OpenOCD comes with a Tcl implementation of well-known memory
9798 testing procedures allowing the detection of all sorts of issues with
9799 electrical wiring, defective chips, PCB layout and other common
9800 hardware problems.
9801
9802 To use them, you usually need to initialise your RAM controller first;
9803 consult your SoC's documentation to get the recommended list of
9804 register operations and translate them to the corresponding
9805 @command{mww}/@command{mwb} commands.
9806
9807 Load the memory testing functions with
9808
9809 @example
9810 source [find tools/memtest.tcl]
9811 @end example
9812
9813 to get access to the following facilities:
9814
9815 @deffn Command {memTestDataBus} address
9816 Test the data bus wiring in a memory region by performing a walking
9817 1's test at a fixed address within that region.
9818 @end deffn
9819
9820 @deffn Command {memTestAddressBus} baseaddress size
9821 Perform a walking 1's test on the relevant bits of the address and
9822 check for aliasing. This test will find single-bit address failures
9823 such as stuck-high, stuck-low, and shorted pins.
9824 @end deffn
9825
9826 @deffn Command {memTestDevice} baseaddress size
9827 Test the integrity of a physical memory device by performing an
9828 increment/decrement test over the entire region. In the process every
9829 storage bit in the device is tested as zero and as one.
9830 @end deffn
9831
9832 @deffn Command {runAllMemTests} baseaddress size
9833 Run all of the above tests over a specified memory region.
9834 @end deffn
9835
9836 @section Firmware recovery helpers
9837 @cindex Firmware recovery
9838
9839 OpenOCD includes an easy-to-use script to facilitate mass-market
9840 devices recovery with JTAG.
9841
9842 For quickstart instructions run:
9843 @example
9844 openocd -f tools/firmware-recovery.tcl -c firmware_help
9845 @end example
9846
9847 @node TFTP
9848 @chapter TFTP
9849 @cindex TFTP
9850 If OpenOCD runs on an embedded host (as ZY1000 does), then TFTP can
9851 be used to access files on PCs (either the developer's PC or some other PC).
9852
9853 The way this works on the ZY1000 is to prefix a filename by
9854 "/tftp/ip/" and append the TFTP path on the TFTP
9855 server (tftpd). For example,
9856
9857 @example
9858 load_image /tftp/10.0.0.96/c:\temp\abc.elf
9859 @end example
9860
9861 will load c:\temp\abc.elf from the developer pc (10.0.0.96) into memory as
9862 if the file was hosted on the embedded host.
9863
9864 In order to achieve decent performance, you must choose a TFTP server
9865 that supports a packet size bigger than the default packet size (512 bytes). There
9866 are numerous TFTP servers out there (free and commercial) and you will have to do
9867 a bit of googling to find something that fits your requirements.
9868
9869 @node GDB and OpenOCD
9870 @chapter GDB and OpenOCD
9871 @cindex GDB
9872 OpenOCD complies with the remote gdbserver protocol and, as such, can be used
9873 to debug remote targets.
9874 Setting up GDB to work with OpenOCD can involve several components:
9875
9876 @itemize
9877 @item The OpenOCD server support for GDB may need to be configured.
9878 @xref{gdbconfiguration,,GDB Configuration}.
9879 @item GDB's support for OpenOCD may need configuration,
9880 as shown in this chapter.
9881 @item If you have a GUI environment like Eclipse,
9882 that also will probably need to be configured.
9883 @end itemize
9884
9885 Of course, the version of GDB you use will need to be one which has
9886 been built to know about the target CPU you're using. It's probably
9887 part of the tool chain you're using. For example, if you are doing
9888 cross-development for ARM on an x86 PC, instead of using the native
9889 x86 @command{gdb} command you might use @command{arm-none-eabi-gdb}
9890 if that's the tool chain used to compile your code.
9891
9892 @section Connecting to GDB
9893 @cindex Connecting to GDB
9894 Use GDB 6.7 or newer with OpenOCD if you run into trouble. For
9895 instance GDB 6.3 has a known bug that produces bogus memory access
9896 errors, which has since been fixed; see
9897 @url{http://osdir.com/ml/gdb.bugs.discuss/2004-12/msg00018.html}
9898
9899 OpenOCD can communicate with GDB in two ways:
9900
9901 @enumerate
9902 @item
9903 A socket (TCP/IP) connection is typically started as follows:
9904 @example
9905 target remote localhost:3333
9906 @end example
9907 This would cause GDB to connect to the gdbserver on the local pc using port 3333.
9908
9909 It is also possible to use the GDB extended remote protocol as follows:
9910 @example
9911 target extended-remote localhost:3333
9912 @end example
9913 @item
9914 A pipe connection is typically started as follows:
9915 @example
9916 target remote | openocd -c "gdb_port pipe; log_output openocd.log"
9917 @end example
9918 This would cause GDB to run OpenOCD and communicate using pipes (stdin/stdout).
9919 Using this method has the advantage of GDB starting/stopping OpenOCD for the debug
9920 session. log_output sends the log output to a file to ensure that the pipe is
9921 not saturated when using higher debug level outputs.
9922 @end enumerate
9923
9924 To list the available OpenOCD commands type @command{monitor help} on the
9925 GDB command line.
9926
9927 @section Sample GDB session startup
9928
9929 With the remote protocol, GDB sessions start a little differently
9930 than they do when you're debugging locally.
9931 Here's an example showing how to start a debug session with a
9932 small ARM program.
9933 In this case the program was linked to be loaded into SRAM on a Cortex-M3.
9934 Most programs would be written into flash (address 0) and run from there.
9935
9936 @example
9937 $ arm-none-eabi-gdb example.elf
9938 (gdb) target remote localhost:3333
9939 Remote debugging using localhost:3333
9940 ...
9941 (gdb) monitor reset halt
9942 ...
9943 (gdb) load
9944 Loading section .vectors, size 0x100 lma 0x20000000
9945 Loading section .text, size 0x5a0 lma 0x20000100
9946 Loading section .data, size 0x18 lma 0x200006a0
9947 Start address 0x2000061c, load size 1720
9948 Transfer rate: 22 KB/sec, 573 bytes/write.
9949 (gdb) continue
9950 Continuing.
9951 ...
9952 @end example
9953
9954 You could then interrupt the GDB session to make the program break,
9955 type @command{where} to show the stack, @command{list} to show the
9956 code around the program counter, @command{step} through code,
9957 set breakpoints or watchpoints, and so on.
9958
9959 @section Configuring GDB for OpenOCD
9960
9961 OpenOCD supports the gdb @option{qSupported} packet, this enables information
9962 to be sent by the GDB remote server (i.e. OpenOCD) to GDB. Typical information includes
9963 packet size and the device's memory map.
9964 You do not need to configure the packet size by hand,
9965 and the relevant parts of the memory map should be automatically
9966 set up when you declare (NOR) flash banks.
9967
9968 However, there are other things which GDB can't currently query.
9969 You may need to set those up by hand.
9970 As OpenOCD starts up, you will often see a line reporting
9971 something like:
9972
9973 @example
9974 Info : lm3s.cpu: hardware has 6 breakpoints, 4 watchpoints
9975 @end example
9976
9977 You can pass that information to GDB with these commands:
9978
9979 @example
9980 set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit 6
9981 set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit 4
9982 @end example
9983
9984 With that particular hardware (Cortex-M3) the hardware breakpoints
9985 only work for code running from flash memory. Most other ARM systems
9986 do not have such restrictions.
9987
9988 Rather than typing such commands interactively, you may prefer to
9989 save them in a file and have GDB execute them as it starts, perhaps
9990 using a @file{.gdbinit} in your project directory or starting GDB
9991 using @command{gdb -x filename}.
9992
9993 @section Programming using GDB
9994 @cindex Programming using GDB
9995 @anchor{programmingusinggdb}
9996
9997 By default the target memory map is sent to GDB. This can be disabled by
9998 the following OpenOCD configuration option:
9999 @example
10000 gdb_memory_map disable
10001 @end example
10002 For this to function correctly a valid flash configuration must also be set
10003 in OpenOCD. For faster performance you should also configure a valid
10004 working area.
10005
10006 Informing GDB of the memory map of the target will enable GDB to protect any
10007 flash areas of the target and use hardware breakpoints by default. This means
10008 that the OpenOCD option @command{gdb_breakpoint_override} is not required when
10009 using a memory map. @xref{gdbbreakpointoverride,,gdb_breakpoint_override}.
10010
10011 To view the configured memory map in GDB, use the GDB command @option{info mem}.
10012 All other unassigned addresses within GDB are treated as RAM.
10013
10014 GDB 6.8 and higher set any memory area not in the memory map as inaccessible.
10015 This can be changed to the old behaviour by using the following GDB command
10016 @example
10017 set mem inaccessible-by-default off
10018 @end example
10019
10020 If @command{gdb_flash_program enable} is also used, GDB will be able to
10021 program any flash memory using the vFlash interface.
10022
10023 GDB will look at the target memory map when a load command is given, if any
10024 areas to be programmed lie within the target flash area the vFlash packets
10025 will be used.
10026
10027 If the target needs configuring before GDB programming, set target
10028 event gdb-flash-erase-start:
10029 @example
10030 $_TARGETNAME configure -event gdb-flash-erase-start BODY
10031 @end example
10032 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}, for other GDB programming related events.
10033
10034 To verify any flash programming the GDB command @option{compare-sections}
10035 can be used.
10036
10037 @section Using GDB as a non-intrusive memory inspector
10038 @cindex Using GDB as a non-intrusive memory inspector
10039 @anchor{gdbmeminspect}
10040
10041 If your project controls more than a blinking LED, let's say a heavy industrial
10042 robot or an experimental nuclear reactor, stopping the controlling process
10043 just because you want to attach GDB is not a good option.
10044
10045 OpenOCD does not support GDB non-stop mode (might be implemented in the future).
10046 Though there is a possible setup where the target does not get stopped
10047 and GDB treats it as it were running.
10048 If the target supports background access to memory while it is running,
10049 you can use GDB in this mode to inspect memory (mainly global variables)
10050 without any intrusion of the target process.
10051
10052 Remove default setting of gdb-attach event. @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
10053 Place following command after target configuration:
10054 @example
10055 $_TARGETNAME configure -event gdb-attach @{@}
10056 @end example
10057
10058 If any of installed flash banks does not support probe on running target,
10059 switch off gdb_memory_map:
10060 @example
10061 gdb_memory_map disable
10062 @end example
10063
10064 Ensure GDB is configured without interrupt-on-connect.
10065 Some GDB versions set it by default, some does not.
10066 @example
10067 set remote interrupt-on-connect off
10068 @end example
10069
10070 If you switched gdb_memory_map off, you may want to setup GDB memory map
10071 manually or issue @command{set mem inaccessible-by-default off}
10072
10073 Now you can issue GDB command @command{target remote ...} and inspect memory
10074 of a running target. Do not use GDB commands @command{continue},
10075 @command{step} or @command{next} as they synchronize GDB with your target
10076 and GDB would require stopping the target to get the prompt back.
10077
10078 Do not use this mode under an IDE like Eclipse as it caches values of
10079 previously shown varibles.
10080
10081 @anchor{usingopenocdsmpwithgdb}
10082 @section Using OpenOCD SMP with GDB
10083 @cindex SMP
10084 For SMP support following GDB serial protocol packet have been defined :
10085 @itemize @bullet
10086 @item j - smp status request
10087 @item J - smp set request
10088 @end itemize
10089
10090 OpenOCD implements :
10091 @itemize @bullet
10092 @item @option{jc} packet for reading core id displayed by
10093 GDB connection. Reply is @option{XXXXXXXX} (8 hex digits giving core id) or
10094 @option{E01} for target not smp.
10095 @item @option{JcXXXXXXXX} (8 hex digits) packet for setting core id displayed at next GDB continue
10096 (core id -1 is reserved for returning to normal resume mode). Reply @option{E01}
10097 for target not smp or @option{OK} on success.
10098 @end itemize
10099
10100 Handling of this packet within GDB can be done :
10101 @itemize @bullet
10102 @item by the creation of an internal variable (i.e @option{_core}) by mean
10103 of function allocate_computed_value allowing following GDB command.
10104 @example
10105 set $_core 1
10106 #Jc01 packet is sent
10107 print $_core
10108 #jc packet is sent and result is affected in $
10109 @end example
10110
10111 @item by the usage of GDB maintenance command as described in following example (2 cpus in SMP with
10112 core id 0 and 1 @pxref{definecputargetsworkinginsmp,,Define CPU targets working in SMP}).
10113
10114 @example
10115 # toggle0 : force display of coreid 0
10116 define toggle0
10117 maint packet Jc0
10118 continue
10119 main packet Jc-1
10120 end
10121 # toggle1 : force display of coreid 1
10122 define toggle1
10123 maint packet Jc1
10124 continue
10125 main packet Jc-1
10126 end
10127 @end example
10128 @end itemize
10129
10130 @section RTOS Support
10131 @cindex RTOS Support
10132 @anchor{gdbrtossupport}
10133
10134 OpenOCD includes RTOS support, this will however need enabling as it defaults to disabled.
10135 It can be enabled by passing @option{-rtos} arg to the target. @xref{rtostype,,RTOS Type}.
10136
10137 @xref{Threads, Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads,
10138 Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads, gdb, GDB manual}, for details about relevant
10139 GDB commands.
10140
10141 @* An example setup is below:
10142
10143 @example
10144 $_TARGETNAME configure -rtos auto
10145 @end example
10146
10147 This will attempt to auto detect the RTOS within your application.
10148
10149 Currently supported rtos's include:
10150 @itemize @bullet
10151 @item @option{eCos}
10152 @item @option{ThreadX}
10153 @item @option{FreeRTOS}
10154 @item @option{linux}
10155 @item @option{ChibiOS}
10156 @item @option{embKernel}
10157 @item @option{mqx}
10158 @item @option{uCOS-III}
10159 @item @option{nuttx}
10160 @end itemize
10161
10162 @quotation Note
10163 Before an RTOS can be detected, it must export certain symbols; otherwise, it cannot
10164 be used by OpenOCD. Below is a list of the required symbols for each supported RTOS.
10165 @end quotation
10166
10167 @table @code
10168 @item eCos symbols
10169 Cyg_Thread::thread_list, Cyg_Scheduler_Base::current_thread.
10170 @item ThreadX symbols
10171 _tx_thread_current_ptr, _tx_thread_created_ptr, _tx_thread_created_count.
10172 @item FreeRTOS symbols
10173 @c The following is taken from recent texinfo to provide compatibility
10174 @c with ancient versions that do not support @raggedright
10175 @tex
10176 \begingroup
10177 \rightskip0pt plus2em \spaceskip.3333em \xspaceskip.5em\relax
10178 pxCurrentTCB, pxReadyTasksLists, xDelayedTaskList1, xDelayedTaskList2,
10179 pxDelayedTaskList, pxOverflowDelayedTaskList, xPendingReadyList,
10180 uxCurrentNumberOfTasks, uxTopUsedPriority.
10181 \par
10182 \endgroup
10183 @end tex
10184 @item linux symbols
10185 init_task.
10186 @item ChibiOS symbols
10187 rlist, ch_debug, chSysInit.
10188 @item embKernel symbols
10189 Rtos::sCurrentTask, Rtos::sListReady, Rtos::sListSleep,
10190 Rtos::sListSuspended, Rtos::sMaxPriorities, Rtos::sCurrentTaskCount.
10191 @item mqx symbols
10192 _mqx_kernel_data, MQX_init_struct.
10193 @item uC/OS-III symbols
10194 OSRunning, OSTCBCurPtr, OSTaskDbgListPtr, OSTaskQty
10195 @item nuttx symbols
10196 g_readytorun, g_tasklisttable
10197 @end table
10198
10199 For most RTOS supported the above symbols will be exported by default. However for
10200 some, eg. FreeRTOS and uC/OS-III, extra steps must be taken.
10201
10202 These RTOSes may require additional OpenOCD-specific file to be linked
10203 along with the project:
10204
10205 @table @code
10206 @item FreeRTOS
10207 contrib/rtos-helpers/FreeRTOS-openocd.c
10208 @item uC/OS-III
10209 contrib/rtos-helpers/uCOS-III-openocd.c
10210 @end table
10211
10212 @node Tcl Scripting API
10213 @chapter Tcl Scripting API
10214 @cindex Tcl Scripting API
10215 @cindex Tcl scripts
10216 @section API rules
10217
10218 Tcl commands are stateless; e.g. the @command{telnet} command has
10219 a concept of currently active target, the Tcl API proc's take this sort
10220 of state information as an argument to each proc.
10221
10222 There are three main types of return values: single value, name value
10223 pair list and lists.
10224
10225 Name value pair. The proc 'foo' below returns a name/value pair
10226 list.
10227
10228 @example
10229 > set foo(me) Duane
10230 > set foo(you) Oyvind
10231 > set foo(mouse) Micky
10232 > set foo(duck) Donald
10233 @end example
10234
10235 If one does this:
10236
10237 @example
10238 > set foo
10239 @end example
10240
10241 The result is:
10242
10243 @example
10244 me Duane you Oyvind mouse Micky duck Donald
10245 @end example
10246
10247 Thus, to get the names of the associative array is easy:
10248
10249 @verbatim
10250 foreach { name value } [set foo] {
10251 puts "Name: $name, Value: $value"
10252 }
10253 @end verbatim
10254
10255 Lists returned should be relatively small. Otherwise, a range
10256 should be passed in to the proc in question.
10257
10258 @section Internal low-level Commands
10259
10260 By "low-level," we mean commands that a human would typically not
10261 invoke directly.
10262
10263 Some low-level commands need to be prefixed with "ocd_"; e.g.
10264 @command{ocd_flash_banks}
10265 is the low-level API upon which @command{flash banks} is implemented.
10266
10267 @itemize @bullet
10268 @item @b{mem2array} <@var{varname}> <@var{width}> <@var{addr}> <@var{nelems}>
10269
10270 Read memory and return as a Tcl array for script processing
10271 @item @b{array2mem} <@var{varname}> <@var{width}> <@var{addr}> <@var{nelems}>
10272
10273 Convert a Tcl array to memory locations and write the values
10274 @item @b{ocd_flash_banks} <@var{driver}> <@var{base}> <@var{size}> <@var{chip_width}> <@var{bus_width}> <@var{target}> [@option{driver options} ...]
10275
10276 Return information about the flash banks
10277
10278 @item @b{capture} <@var{command}>
10279
10280 Run <@var{command}> and return full log output that was produced during
10281 its execution. Example:
10282
10283 @example
10284 > capture "reset init"
10285 @end example
10286
10287 @end itemize
10288
10289 OpenOCD commands can consist of two words, e.g. "flash banks". The
10290 @file{startup.tcl} "unknown" proc will translate this into a Tcl proc
10291 called "flash_banks".
10292
10293 @section OpenOCD specific Global Variables
10294
10295 Real Tcl has ::tcl_platform(), and platform::identify, and many other
10296 variables. JimTCL, as implemented in OpenOCD creates $ocd_HOSTOS which
10297 holds one of the following values:
10298
10299 @itemize @bullet
10300 @item @b{cygwin} Running under Cygwin
10301 @item @b{darwin} Darwin (Mac-OS) is the underlying operating system.
10302 @item @b{freebsd} Running under FreeBSD
10303 @item @b{openbsd} Running under OpenBSD
10304 @item @b{netbsd} Running under NetBSD
10305 @item @b{linux} Linux is the underlying operating system
10306 @item @b{mingw32} Running under MingW32
10307 @item @b{winxx} Built using Microsoft Visual Studio
10308 @item @b{ecos} Running under eCos
10309 @item @b{other} Unknown, none of the above.
10310 @end itemize
10311
10312 Note: 'winxx' was chosen because today (March-2009) no distinction is made between Win32 and Win64.
10313
10314 @quotation Note
10315 We should add support for a variable like Tcl variable
10316 @code{tcl_platform(platform)}, it should be called
10317 @code{jim_platform} (because it
10318 is jim, not real tcl).
10319 @end quotation
10320
10321 @section Tcl RPC server
10322 @cindex RPC
10323
10324 OpenOCD provides a simple RPC server that allows to run arbitrary Tcl
10325 commands and receive the results.
10326
10327 To access it, your application needs to connect to a configured TCP port
10328 (see @command{tcl_port}). Then it can pass any string to the
10329 interpreter terminating it with @code{0x1a} and wait for the return
10330 value (it will be terminated with @code{0x1a} as well). This can be
10331 repeated as many times as desired without reopening the connection.
10332
10333 Remember that most of the OpenOCD commands need to be prefixed with
10334 @code{ocd_} to get the results back. Sometimes you might also need the
10335 @command{capture} command.
10336
10337 See @file{contrib/rpc_examples/} for specific client implementations.
10338
10339 @section Tcl RPC server notifications
10340 @cindex RPC Notifications
10341
10342 Notifications are sent asynchronously to other commands being executed over
10343 the RPC server, so the port must be polled continuously.
10344
10345 Target event, state and reset notifications are emitted as Tcl associative arrays
10346 in the following format.
10347
10348 @verbatim
10349 type target_event event [event-name]
10350 type target_state state [state-name]
10351 type target_reset mode [reset-mode]
10352 @end verbatim
10353
10354 @deffn {Command} tcl_notifications [on/off]
10355 Toggle output of target notifications to the current Tcl RPC server.
10356 Only available from the Tcl RPC server.
10357 Defaults to off.
10358
10359 @end deffn
10360
10361 @section Tcl RPC server trace output
10362 @cindex RPC trace output
10363
10364 Trace data is sent asynchronously to other commands being executed over
10365 the RPC server, so the port must be polled continuously.
10366
10367 Target trace data is emitted as a Tcl associative array in the following format.
10368
10369 @verbatim
10370 type target_trace data [trace-data-hex-encoded]
10371 @end verbatim
10372
10373 @deffn {Command} tcl_trace [on/off]
10374 Toggle output of target trace data to the current Tcl RPC server.
10375 Only available from the Tcl RPC server.
10376 Defaults to off.
10377
10378 See an example application here:
10379 @url{https://github.com/apmorton/OpenOcdTraceUtil} [OpenOcdTraceUtil]
10380
10381 @end deffn
10382
10383 @node FAQ
10384 @chapter FAQ
10385 @cindex faq
10386 @enumerate
10387 @anchor{faqrtck}
10388 @item @b{RTCK, also known as: Adaptive Clocking - What is it?}
10389 @cindex RTCK
10390 @cindex adaptive clocking
10391 @*
10392
10393 In digital circuit design it is often referred to as ``clock
10394 synchronisation'' the JTAG interface uses one clock (TCK or TCLK)
10395 operating at some speed, your CPU target is operating at another.
10396 The two clocks are not synchronised, they are ``asynchronous''
10397
10398 In order for the two to work together they must be synchronised
10399 well enough to work; JTAG can't go ten times faster than the CPU,
10400 for example. There are 2 basic options:
10401 @enumerate
10402 @item
10403 Use a special "adaptive clocking" circuit to change the JTAG
10404 clock rate to match what the CPU currently supports.
10405 @item
10406 The JTAG clock must be fixed at some speed that's enough slower than
10407 the CPU clock that all TMS and TDI transitions can be detected.
10408 @end enumerate
10409
10410 @b{Does this really matter?} For some chips and some situations, this
10411 is a non-issue, like a 500MHz ARM926 with a 5 MHz JTAG link;
10412 the CPU has no difficulty keeping up with JTAG.
10413 Startup sequences are often problematic though, as are other
10414 situations where the CPU clock rate changes (perhaps to save
10415 power).
10416
10417 For example, Atmel AT91SAM chips start operation from reset with
10418 a 32kHz system clock. Boot firmware may activate the main oscillator
10419 and PLL before switching to a faster clock (perhaps that 500 MHz
10420 ARM926 scenario).
10421 If you're using JTAG to debug that startup sequence, you must slow
10422 the JTAG clock to sometimes 1 to 4kHz. After startup completes,
10423 JTAG can use a faster clock.
10424
10425 Consider also debugging a 500MHz ARM926 hand held battery powered
10426 device that enters a low power ``deep sleep'' mode, at 32kHz CPU
10427 clock, between keystrokes unless it has work to do. When would
10428 that 5 MHz JTAG clock be usable?
10429
10430 @b{Solution #1 - A special circuit}
10431
10432 In order to make use of this,
10433 your CPU, board, and JTAG adapter must all support the RTCK
10434 feature. Not all of them support this; keep reading!
10435
10436 The RTCK ("Return TCK") signal in some ARM chips is used to help with
10437 this problem. ARM has a good description of the problem described at
10438 this link: @url{http://www.arm.com/support/faqdev/4170.html} [checked
10439 28/nov/2008]. Link title: ``How does the JTAG synchronisation logic
10440 work? / how does adaptive clocking work?''.
10441
10442 The nice thing about adaptive clocking is that ``battery powered hand
10443 held device example'' - the adaptiveness works perfectly all the
10444 time. One can set a break point or halt the system in the deep power
10445 down code, slow step out until the system speeds up.
10446
10447 Note that adaptive clocking may also need to work at the board level,
10448 when a board-level scan chain has multiple chips.
10449 Parallel clock voting schemes are good way to implement this,
10450 both within and between chips, and can easily be implemented
10451 with a CPLD.
10452 It's not difficult to have logic fan a module's input TCK signal out
10453 to each TAP in the scan chain, and then wait until each TAP's RTCK comes
10454 back with the right polarity before changing the output RTCK signal.
10455 Texas Instruments makes some clock voting logic available
10456 for free (with no support) in VHDL form; see
10457 @url{http://tiexpressdsp.com/index.php/Adaptive_Clocking}
10458
10459 @b{Solution #2 - Always works - but may be slower}
10460
10461 Often this is a perfectly acceptable solution.
10462
10463 In most simple terms: Often the JTAG clock must be 1/10 to 1/12 of
10464 the target clock speed. But what that ``magic division'' is varies
10465 depending on the chips on your board.
10466 @b{ARM rule of thumb} Most ARM based systems require an 6:1 division;
10467 ARM11 cores use an 8:1 division.
10468 @b{Xilinx rule of thumb} is 1/12 the clock speed.
10469
10470 Note: most full speed FT2232 based JTAG adapters are limited to a
10471 maximum of 6MHz. The ones using USB high speed chips (FT2232H)
10472 often support faster clock rates (and adaptive clocking).
10473
10474 You can still debug the 'low power' situations - you just need to
10475 either use a fixed and very slow JTAG clock rate ... or else
10476 manually adjust the clock speed at every step. (Adjusting is painful
10477 and tedious, and is not always practical.)
10478
10479 It is however easy to ``code your way around it'' - i.e.: Cheat a little,
10480 have a special debug mode in your application that does a ``high power
10481 sleep''. If you are careful - 98% of your problems can be debugged
10482 this way.
10483
10484 Note that on ARM you may need to avoid using the @emph{wait for interrupt}
10485 operation in your idle loops even if you don't otherwise change the CPU
10486 clock rate.
10487 That operation gates the CPU clock, and thus the JTAG clock; which
10488 prevents JTAG access. One consequence is not being able to @command{halt}
10489 cores which are executing that @emph{wait for interrupt} operation.
10490
10491 To set the JTAG frequency use the command:
10492
10493 @example
10494 # Example: 1.234MHz
10495 adapter_khz 1234
10496 @end example
10497
10498
10499 @item @b{Win32 Pathnames} Why don't backslashes work in Windows paths?
10500
10501 OpenOCD uses Tcl and a backslash is an escape char. Use @{ and @}
10502 around Windows filenames.
10503
10504 @example
10505 > echo \a
10506
10507 > echo @{\a@}
10508 \a
10509 > echo "\a"
10510
10511 >
10512 @end example
10513
10514
10515 @item @b{Missing: cygwin1.dll} OpenOCD complains about a missing cygwin1.dll.
10516
10517 Make sure you have Cygwin installed, or at least a version of OpenOCD that
10518 claims to come with all the necessary DLLs. When using Cygwin, try launching
10519 OpenOCD from the Cygwin shell.
10520
10521 @item @b{Breakpoint Issue} I'm trying to set a breakpoint using GDB (or a front-end like Insight or
10522 Eclipse), but OpenOCD complains that "Info: arm7_9_common.c:213
10523 arm7_9_add_breakpoint(): sw breakpoint requested, but software breakpoints not enabled".
10524
10525 GDB issues software breakpoints when a normal breakpoint is requested, or to implement
10526 source-line single-stepping. On ARMv4T systems, like ARM7TDMI, ARM720T or ARM920T,
10527 software breakpoints consume one of the two available hardware breakpoints.
10528
10529 @item @b{LPC2000 Flash} When erasing or writing LPC2000 on-chip flash, the operation fails at random.
10530
10531 Make sure the core frequency specified in the @option{flash lpc2000} line matches the
10532 clock at the time you're programming the flash. If you've specified the crystal's
10533 frequency, make sure the PLL is disabled. If you've specified the full core speed
10534 (e.g. 60MHz), make sure the PLL is enabled.
10535
10536 @item @b{Amontec Chameleon} When debugging using an Amontec Chameleon in its JTAG Accelerator configuration,
10537 I keep getting "Error: amt_jtagaccel.c:184 amt_wait_scan_busy(): amt_jtagaccel timed
10538 out while waiting for end of scan, rtck was disabled".
10539
10540 Make sure your PC's parallel port operates in EPP mode. You might have to try several
10541 settings in your PC BIOS (ECP, EPP, and different versions of those).
10542
10543 @item @b{Data Aborts} When debugging with OpenOCD and GDB (plain GDB, Insight, or Eclipse),
10544 I get lots of "Error: arm7_9_common.c:1771 arm7_9_read_memory():
10545 memory read caused data abort".
10546
10547 The errors are non-fatal, and are the result of GDB trying to trace stack frames
10548 beyond the last valid frame. It might be possible to prevent this by setting up
10549 a proper "initial" stack frame, if you happen to know what exactly has to
10550 be done, feel free to add this here.
10551
10552 @b{Simple:} In your startup code - push 8 registers of zeros onto the
10553 stack before calling main(). What GDB is doing is ``climbing'' the run
10554 time stack by reading various values on the stack using the standard
10555 call frame for the target. GDB keeps going - until one of 2 things
10556 happen @b{#1} an invalid frame is found, or @b{#2} some huge number of
10557 stackframes have been processed. By pushing zeros on the stack, GDB
10558 gracefully stops.
10559
10560 @b{Debugging Interrupt Service Routines} - In your ISR before you call
10561 your C code, do the same - artificially push some zeros onto the stack,
10562 remember to pop them off when the ISR is done.
10563
10564 @b{Also note:} If you have a multi-threaded operating system, they
10565 often do not @b{in the intrest of saving memory} waste these few
10566 bytes. Painful...
10567
10568
10569 @item @b{JTAG Reset Config} I get the following message in the OpenOCD console (or log file):
10570 "Warning: arm7_9_common.c:679 arm7_9_assert_reset(): srst resets test logic, too".
10571
10572 This warning doesn't indicate any serious problem, as long as you don't want to
10573 debug your core right out of reset. Your .cfg file specified @option{jtag_reset
10574 trst_and_srst srst_pulls_trst} to tell OpenOCD that either your board,
10575 your debugger or your target uC (e.g. LPC2000) can't assert the two reset signals
10576 independently. With this setup, it's not possible to halt the core right out of
10577 reset, everything else should work fine.
10578
10579 @item @b{USB Power} When using OpenOCD in conjunction with Amontec JTAGkey and the Yagarto
10580 toolchain (Eclipse, arm-elf-gcc, arm-elf-gdb), the debugging seems to be
10581 unstable. When single-stepping over large blocks of code, GDB and OpenOCD
10582 quit with an error message. Is there a stability issue with OpenOCD?
10583
10584 No, this is not a stability issue concerning OpenOCD. Most users have solved
10585 this issue by simply using a self-powered USB hub, which they connect their
10586 Amontec JTAGkey to. Apparently, some computers do not provide a USB power
10587 supply stable enough for the Amontec JTAGkey to be operated.
10588
10589 @b{Laptops running on battery have this problem too...}
10590
10591 @item @b{GDB Disconnects} When using the Amontec JTAGkey, sometimes OpenOCD crashes with the following
10592 error message: "Error: gdb_server.c:101 gdb_get_char(): read: 10054".
10593 What does that mean and what might be the reason for this?
10594
10595 Error code 10054 corresponds to WSAECONNRESET, which means that the debugger (GDB)
10596 has closed the connection to OpenOCD. This might be a GDB issue.
10597
10598 @item @b{LPC2000 Flash} In the configuration file in the section where flash device configurations
10599 are described, there is a parameter for specifying the clock frequency
10600 for LPC2000 internal flash devices (e.g. @option{flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2000
10601 0x0 0x40000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME lpc2000_v1 14746 calc_checksum}), which must be
10602 specified in kilohertz. However, I do have a quartz crystal of a
10603 frequency that contains fractions of kilohertz (e.g. 14,745,600 Hz,
10604 i.e. 14,745.600 kHz). Is it possible to specify real numbers for the
10605 clock frequency?
10606
10607 No. The clock frequency specified here must be given as an integral number.
10608 However, this clock frequency is used by the In-Application-Programming (IAP)
10609 routines of the LPC2000 family only, which seems to be very tolerant concerning
10610 the given clock frequency, so a slight difference between the specified clock
10611 frequency and the actual clock frequency will not cause any trouble.
10612
10613 @item @b{Command Order} Do I have to keep a specific order for the commands in the configuration file?
10614
10615 Well, yes and no. Commands can be given in arbitrary order, yet the
10616 devices listed for the JTAG scan chain must be given in the right
10617 order (jtag newdevice), with the device closest to the TDO-Pin being
10618 listed first. In general, whenever objects of the same type exist
10619 which require an index number, then these objects must be given in the
10620 right order (jtag newtap, targets and flash banks - a target
10621 references a jtag newtap and a flash bank references a target).
10622
10623 You can use the ``scan_chain'' command to verify and display the tap order.
10624
10625 Also, some commands can't execute until after @command{init} has been
10626 processed. Such commands include @command{nand probe} and everything
10627 else that needs to write to controller registers, perhaps for setting
10628 up DRAM and loading it with code.
10629
10630 @anchor{faqtaporder}
10631 @item @b{JTAG TAP Order} Do I have to declare the TAPS in some
10632 particular order?
10633
10634 Yes; whenever you have more than one, you must declare them in
10635 the same order used by the hardware.
10636
10637 Many newer devices have multiple JTAG TAPs. For example:
10638 STMicroelectronics STM32 chips have two TAPs, a ``boundary scan TAP'' and
10639 ``Cortex-M3'' TAP. Example: The STM32 reference manual, Document ID:
10640 RM0008, Section 26.5, Figure 259, page 651/681, the ``TDI'' pin is
10641 connected to the boundary scan TAP, which then connects to the
10642 Cortex-M3 TAP, which then connects to the TDO pin.
10643
10644 Thus, the proper order for the STM32 chip is: (1) The Cortex-M3, then
10645 (2) The boundary scan TAP. If your board includes an additional JTAG
10646 chip in the scan chain (for example a Xilinx CPLD or FPGA) you could
10647 place it before or after the STM32 chip in the chain. For example:
10648
10649 @itemize @bullet
10650 @item OpenOCD_TDI(output) -> STM32 TDI Pin (BS Input)
10651 @item STM32 BS TDO (output) -> STM32 Cortex-M3 TDI (input)
10652 @item STM32 Cortex-M3 TDO (output) -> SM32 TDO Pin
10653 @item STM32 TDO Pin (output) -> Xilinx TDI Pin (input)
10654 @item Xilinx TDO Pin -> OpenOCD TDO (input)
10655 @end itemize
10656
10657 The ``jtag device'' commands would thus be in the order shown below. Note:
10658
10659 @itemize @bullet
10660 @item jtag newtap Xilinx tap -irlen ...
10661 @item jtag newtap stm32 cpu -irlen ...
10662 @item jtag newtap stm32 bs -irlen ...
10663 @item # Create the debug target and say where it is
10664 @item target create stm32.cpu -chain-position stm32.cpu ...
10665 @end itemize
10666
10667
10668 @item @b{SYSCOMP} Sometimes my debugging session terminates with an error. When I look into the
10669 log file, I can see these error messages: Error: arm7_9_common.c:561
10670 arm7_9_execute_sys_speed(): timeout waiting for SYSCOMP
10671
10672 TODO.
10673
10674 @end enumerate
10675
10676 @node Tcl Crash Course
10677 @chapter Tcl Crash Course
10678 @cindex Tcl
10679
10680 Not everyone knows Tcl - this is not intended to be a replacement for
10681 learning Tcl, the intent of this chapter is to give you some idea of
10682 how the Tcl scripts work.
10683
10684 This chapter is written with two audiences in mind. (1) OpenOCD users
10685 who need to understand a bit more of how Jim-Tcl works so they can do
10686 something useful, and (2) those that want to add a new command to
10687 OpenOCD.
10688
10689 @section Tcl Rule #1
10690 There is a famous joke, it goes like this:
10691 @enumerate
10692 @item Rule #1: The wife is always correct
10693 @item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
10694 @end enumerate
10695
10696 The Tcl equal is this:
10697
10698 @enumerate
10699 @item Rule #1: Everything is a string
10700 @item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
10701 @end enumerate
10702
10703 As in the famous joke, the consequences of Rule #1 are profound. Once
10704 you understand Rule #1, you will understand Tcl.
10705
10706 @section Tcl Rule #1b
10707 There is a second pair of rules.
10708 @enumerate
10709 @item Rule #1: Control flow does not exist. Only commands
10710 @* For example: the classic FOR loop or IF statement is not a control
10711 flow item, they are commands, there is no such thing as control flow
10712 in Tcl.
10713 @item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
10714 @* Actually what happens is this: There are commands that by
10715 convention, act like control flow key words in other languages. One of
10716 those commands is the word ``for'', another command is ``if''.
10717 @end enumerate
10718
10719 @section Per Rule #1 - All Results are strings
10720 Every Tcl command results in a string. The word ``result'' is used
10721 deliberately. No result is just an empty string. Remember: @i{Rule #1 -
10722 Everything is a string}
10723
10724 @section Tcl Quoting Operators
10725 In life of a Tcl script, there are two important periods of time, the
10726 difference is subtle.
10727 @enumerate
10728 @item Parse Time
10729 @item Evaluation Time
10730 @end enumerate
10731
10732 The two key items here are how ``quoted things'' work in Tcl. Tcl has
10733 three primary quoting constructs, the [square-brackets] the
10734 @{curly-braces@} and ``double-quotes''
10735
10736 By now you should know $VARIABLES always start with a $DOLLAR
10737 sign. BTW: To set a variable, you actually use the command ``set'', as
10738 in ``set VARNAME VALUE'' much like the ancient BASIC language ``let x
10739 = 1'' statement, but without the equal sign.
10740
10741 @itemize @bullet
10742 @item @b{[square-brackets]}
10743 @* @b{[square-brackets]} are command substitutions. It operates much
10744 like Unix Shell `back-ticks`. The result of a [square-bracket]
10745 operation is exactly 1 string. @i{Remember Rule #1 - Everything is a
10746 string}. These two statements are roughly identical:
10747 @example
10748 # bash example
10749 X=`date`
10750 echo "The Date is: $X"
10751 # Tcl example
10752 set X [date]
10753 puts "The Date is: $X"
10754 @end example
10755 @item @b{``double-quoted-things''}
10756 @* @b{``double-quoted-things''} are just simply quoted
10757 text. $VARIABLES and [square-brackets] are expanded in place - the
10758 result however is exactly 1 string. @i{Remember Rule #1 - Everything
10759 is a string}
10760 @example
10761 set x "Dinner"
10762 puts "It is now \"[date]\", $x is in 1 hour"
10763 @end example
10764 @item @b{@{Curly-Braces@}}
10765 @*@b{@{Curly-Braces@}} are magic: $VARIABLES and [square-brackets] are
10766 parsed, but are NOT expanded or executed. @{Curly-Braces@} are like
10767 'single-quote' operators in BASH shell scripts, with the added
10768 feature: @{curly-braces@} can be nested, single quotes can not. @{@{@{this is
10769 nested 3 times@}@}@} NOTE: [date] is a bad example;
10770 at this writing, Jim/OpenOCD does not have a date command.
10771 @end itemize
10772
10773 @section Consequences of Rule 1/2/3/4
10774
10775 The consequences of Rule 1 are profound.
10776
10777 @subsection Tokenisation & Execution.
10778
10779 Of course, whitespace, blank lines and #comment lines are handled in
10780 the normal way.
10781
10782 As a script is parsed, each (multi) line in the script file is
10783 tokenised and according to the quoting rules. After tokenisation, that
10784 line is immediately executed.
10785
10786 Multi line statements end with one or more ``still-open''
10787 @{curly-braces@} which - eventually - closes a few lines later.
10788
10789 @subsection Command Execution
10790
10791 Remember earlier: There are no ``control flow''
10792 statements in Tcl. Instead there are COMMANDS that simply act like
10793 control flow operators.
10794
10795 Commands are executed like this:
10796
10797 @enumerate
10798 @item Parse the next line into (argc) and (argv[]).
10799 @item Look up (argv[0]) in a table and call its function.
10800 @item Repeat until End Of File.
10801 @end enumerate
10802
10803 It sort of works like this:
10804 @example
10805 for(;;)@{
10806 ReadAndParse( &argc, &argv );
10807
10808 cmdPtr = LookupCommand( argv[0] );
10809
10810 (*cmdPtr->Execute)( argc, argv );
10811 @}
10812 @end example
10813
10814 When the command ``proc'' is parsed (which creates a procedure
10815 function) it gets 3 parameters on the command line. @b{1} the name of
10816 the proc (function), @b{2} the list of parameters, and @b{3} the body
10817 of the function. Not the choice of words: LIST and BODY. The PROC
10818 command stores these items in a table somewhere so it can be found by
10819 ``LookupCommand()''
10820
10821 @subsection The FOR command
10822
10823 The most interesting command to look at is the FOR command. In Tcl,
10824 the FOR command is normally implemented in C. Remember, FOR is a
10825 command just like any other command.
10826
10827 When the ascii text containing the FOR command is parsed, the parser
10828 produces 5 parameter strings, @i{(If in doubt: Refer to Rule #1)} they
10829 are:
10830
10831 @enumerate 0
10832 @item The ascii text 'for'
10833 @item The start text
10834 @item The test expression
10835 @item The next text
10836 @item The body text
10837 @end enumerate
10838
10839 Sort of reminds you of ``main( int argc, char **argv )'' does it not?
10840 Remember @i{Rule #1 - Everything is a string.} The key point is this:
10841 Often many of those parameters are in @{curly-braces@} - thus the
10842 variables inside are not expanded or replaced until later.
10843
10844 Remember that every Tcl command looks like the classic ``main( argc,
10845 argv )'' function in C. In JimTCL - they actually look like this:
10846
10847 @example
10848 int
10849 MyCommand( Jim_Interp *interp,
10850 int *argc,
10851 Jim_Obj * const *argvs );
10852 @end example
10853
10854 Real Tcl is nearly identical. Although the newer versions have
10855 introduced a byte-code parser and interpreter, but at the core, it
10856 still operates in the same basic way.
10857
10858 @subsection FOR command implementation
10859
10860 To understand Tcl it is perhaps most helpful to see the FOR
10861 command. Remember, it is a COMMAND not a control flow structure.
10862
10863 In Tcl there are two underlying C helper functions.
10864
10865 Remember Rule #1 - You are a string.
10866
10867 The @b{first} helper parses and executes commands found in an ascii
10868 string. Commands can be separated by semicolons, or newlines. While
10869 parsing, variables are expanded via the quoting rules.
10870
10871 The @b{second} helper evaluates an ascii string as a numerical
10872 expression and returns a value.
10873
10874 Here is an example of how the @b{FOR} command could be
10875 implemented. The pseudo code below does not show error handling.
10876 @example
10877 void Execute_AsciiString( void *interp, const char *string );
10878
10879 int Evaluate_AsciiExpression( void *interp, const char *string );
10880
10881 int
10882 MyForCommand( void *interp,
10883 int argc,
10884 char **argv )
10885 @{
10886 if( argc != 5 )@{
10887 SetResult( interp, "WRONG number of parameters");
10888 return ERROR;
10889 @}
10890
10891 // argv[0] = the ascii string just like C
10892
10893 // Execute the start statement.
10894 Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[1] );
10895
10896 // Top of loop test
10897 for(;;)@{
10898 i = Evaluate_AsciiExpression(interp, argv[2]);
10899 if( i == 0 )
10900 break;
10901
10902 // Execute the body
10903 Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[3] );
10904
10905 // Execute the LOOP part
10906 Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[4] );
10907 @}
10908
10909 // Return no error
10910 SetResult( interp, "" );
10911 return SUCCESS;
10912 @}
10913 @end example
10914
10915 Every other command IF, WHILE, FORMAT, PUTS, EXPR, everything works
10916 in the same basic way.
10917
10918 @section OpenOCD Tcl Usage
10919
10920 @subsection source and find commands
10921 @b{Where:} In many configuration files
10922 @* Example: @b{ source [find FILENAME] }
10923 @*Remember the parsing rules
10924 @enumerate
10925 @item The @command{find} command is in square brackets,
10926 and is executed with the parameter FILENAME. It should find and return
10927 the full path to a file with that name; it uses an internal search path.
10928 The RESULT is a string, which is substituted into the command line in
10929 place of the bracketed @command{find} command.
10930 (Don't try to use a FILENAME which includes the "#" character.
10931 That character begins Tcl comments.)
10932 @item The @command{source} command is executed with the resulting filename;
10933 it reads a file and executes as a script.
10934 @end enumerate
10935 @subsection format command
10936 @b{Where:} Generally occurs in numerous places.
10937 @* Tcl has no command like @b{printf()}, instead it has @b{format}, which is really more like
10938 @b{sprintf()}.
10939 @b{Example}
10940 @example
10941 set x 6
10942 set y 7
10943 puts [format "The answer: %d" [expr $x * $y]]
10944 @end example
10945 @enumerate
10946 @item The SET command creates 2 variables, X and Y.
10947 @item The double [nested] EXPR command performs math
10948 @* The EXPR command produces numerical result as a string.
10949 @* Refer to Rule #1
10950 @item The format command is executed, producing a single string
10951 @* Refer to Rule #1.
10952 @item The PUTS command outputs the text.
10953 @end enumerate
10954 @subsection Body or Inlined Text
10955 @b{Where:} Various TARGET scripts.
10956 @example
10957 #1 Good
10958 proc someproc @{@} @{
10959 ... multiple lines of stuff ...
10960 @}
10961 $_TARGETNAME configure -event FOO someproc
10962 #2 Good - no variables
10963 $_TARGETNAME configure -event foo "this ; that;"
10964 #3 Good Curly Braces
10965 $_TARGETNAME configure -event FOO @{
10966 puts "Time: [date]"
10967 @}
10968 #4 DANGER DANGER DANGER
10969 $_TARGETNAME configure -event foo "puts \"Time: [date]\""
10970 @end example
10971 @enumerate
10972 @item The $_TARGETNAME is an OpenOCD variable convention.
10973 @*@b{$_TARGETNAME} represents the last target created, the value changes
10974 each time a new target is created. Remember the parsing rules. When
10975 the ascii text is parsed, the @b{$_TARGETNAME} becomes a simple string,
10976 the name of the target which happens to be a TARGET (object)
10977 command.
10978 @item The 2nd parameter to the @option{-event} parameter is a TCBODY
10979 @*There are 4 examples:
10980 @enumerate
10981 @item The TCLBODY is a simple string that happens to be a proc name
10982 @item The TCLBODY is several simple commands separated by semicolons
10983 @item The TCLBODY is a multi-line @{curly-brace@} quoted string
10984 @item The TCLBODY is a string with variables that get expanded.
10985 @end enumerate
10986
10987 In the end, when the target event FOO occurs the TCLBODY is
10988 evaluated. Method @b{#1} and @b{#2} are functionally identical. For
10989 Method @b{#3} and @b{#4} it is more interesting. What is the TCLBODY?
10990
10991 Remember the parsing rules. In case #3, @{curly-braces@} mean the
10992 $VARS and [square-brackets] are expanded later, when the EVENT occurs,
10993 and the text is evaluated. In case #4, they are replaced before the
10994 ``Target Object Command'' is executed. This occurs at the same time
10995 $_TARGETNAME is replaced. In case #4 the date will never
10996 change. @{BTW: [date] is a bad example; at this writing,
10997 Jim/OpenOCD does not have a date command@}
10998 @end enumerate
10999 @subsection Global Variables
11000 @b{Where:} You might discover this when writing your own procs @* In
11001 simple terms: Inside a PROC, if you need to access a global variable
11002 you must say so. See also ``upvar''. Example:
11003 @example
11004 proc myproc @{ @} @{
11005 set y 0 #Local variable Y
11006 global x #Global variable X
11007 puts [format "X=%d, Y=%d" $x $y]
11008 @}
11009 @end example
11010 @section Other Tcl Hacks
11011 @b{Dynamic variable creation}
11012 @example
11013 # Dynamically create a bunch of variables.
11014 for @{ set x 0 @} @{ $x < 32 @} @{ set x [expr $x + 1]@} @{
11015 # Create var name
11016 set vn [format "BIT%d" $x]
11017 # Make it a global
11018 global $vn
11019 # Set it.
11020 set $vn [expr (1 << $x)]
11021 @}
11022 @end example
11023 @b{Dynamic proc/command creation}
11024 @example
11025 # One "X" function - 5 uart functions.
11026 foreach who @{A B C D E@}
11027 proc [format "show_uart%c" $who] @{ @} "show_UARTx $who"
11028 @}
11029 @end example
11030
11031 @include fdl.texi
11032
11033 @node OpenOCD Concept Index
11034 @comment DO NOT use the plain word ``Index'', reason: CYGWIN filename
11035 @comment case issue with ``Index.html'' and ``index.html''
11036 @comment Occurs when creating ``--html --no-split'' output
11037 @comment This fix is based on: http://sourceware.org/ml/binutils/2006-05/msg00215.html
11038 @unnumbered OpenOCD Concept Index
11039
11040 @printindex cp
11041
11042 @node Command and Driver Index
11043 @unnumbered Command and Driver Index
11044 @printindex fn
11045
11046 @bye

Linking to existing account procedure

If you already have an account and want to add another login method you MUST first sign in with your existing account and then change URL to read https://review.openocd.org/login/?link to get to this page again but this time it'll work for linking. Thank you.

SSH host keys fingerprints

1024 SHA256:YKx8b7u5ZWdcbp7/4AeXNaqElP49m6QrwfXaqQGJAOk gerrit-code-review@openocd.zylin.com (DSA)
384 SHA256:jHIbSQa4REvwCFG4cq5LBlBLxmxSqelQPem/EXIrxjk gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ECDSA)
521 SHA256:UAOPYkU9Fjtcao0Ul/Rrlnj/OsQvt+pgdYSZ4jOYdgs gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ECDSA)
256 SHA256:A13M5QlnozFOvTllybRZH6vm7iSt0XLxbA48yfc2yfY gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ECDSA)
256 SHA256:spYMBqEYoAOtK7yZBrcwE8ZpYt6b68Cfh9yEVetvbXg gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ED25519)
+--[ED25519 256]--+
|=..              |
|+o..   .         |
|*.o   . .        |
|+B . . .         |
|Bo. = o S        |
|Oo.+ + =         |
|oB=.* = . o      |
| =+=.+   + E     |
|. .=o   . o      |
+----[SHA256]-----+
2048 SHA256:0Onrb7/PHjpo6iVZ7xQX2riKN83FJ3KGU0TvI0TaFG4 gerrit-code-review@openocd.zylin.com (RSA)